Consolidated financial statements
Transcription
Consolidated financial statements
Content 20 years ......................................................................................................................................................................5 Integrated reporting year two....................................................................................................................................6 Dear shareholders......................................................................................................................................................8 Overview.....................................................................................................................................................................11 Group highlights................................................................................................................................................11 Mission & Values...............................................................................................................................................14 Significant events in the reporting period...............................................................................................................16 MAG - Company profile and sustainability..............................................................................................................18 Company profile................................................................................................................................................18 Corporate responsibility....................................................................................................................................28 Ownership status.......................................................................................................................................................48 Development phase...................................................................................................................................................49 Social sustainability........................................................................................................................................64 Sustainable innovation......................................................................................................................................77 Annual report..............................................................................................................................................................81 Director’s report.........................................................................................................................................................84 Group performance...........................................................................................................................................84 Alternative (“NON IFRS”) performance ratios...................................................................................................90 Development of new products...........................................................................................................................97 Corporate governance disclosure ....................................................................................................................102 Events after the reporting date..........................................................................................................................105 Outlook..............................................................................................................................................................105 Proposal of the board of directors to rhe shareholders.....................................................................................106 Consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 semptember 2015 .....................................109 Consolidated financial statements...........................................................................................................................110 Statement of financial position (1/2)..................................................................................................................110 Statement of financial position (2/2)..................................................................................................................112 Statement of comprehensive income................................................................................................................114 Statement of cash flows....................................................................................................................................116 Statement of changes in equity ........................................................................................................................118 Notes to the consolidated financial statements ....................................................................................................121 1.Overview.....................................................................................................................................................122 2. Basis of preparation....................................................................................................................................123 3. Basis of consolidation..................................................................................................................................125 4. Main accounting policy................................................................................................................................130 5. Significant matters.......................................................................................................................................139 6. Notes to the statement of financial position.................................................................................................145 7. Notes to the statement of comprehensive income...................................................................................... 154 8. Assets classified as held for sale and directly associated liabilities............................................................ 160 9. Reconciliation of the parent’s profit for the year and equity with consolidated figures................................ 160 Separate financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 semptember 2015.............................................165 Financial statements .................................................................................................................................................168 Statement of financial position (1/2)..................................................................................................................168 Statement of financial position (2/2)..................................................................................................................170 Statement of comprehensive income................................................................................................................172 Statement of cash flows....................................................................................................................................174 Statement of changes in equity.........................................................................................................................176 Notes to the separate financial statements ............................................................................................................179 1.Overview.....................................................................................................................................................180 2. Basis of preparation....................................................................................................................................181 3. Main accounting policies.............................................................................................................................185 4. Significant matters.......................................................................................................................................194 5. Notes to the statement of financial position.................................................................................................199 6. Notes to the statement of comprehensive income...................................................................................... 209 7. Assets classified as held for sale and directly associated liabilities............................................................ 215 M en must always earn what they inherit from their fathers in order to properly call it their own Ciò che l’uomo ha ereditato dai suoi padri deve sempre riguadagnarselo con i propri sforzi per possederlo saldamente Benedetto Croce 20 years 2015 is above all a year of anniversaries, which share courage and spirit of adventure. The first twenty years of MAG’s business project and the 100th anniversary of the incorporation of Società Idrovolanti Alta Italia, whose Borgomanero factory still hosts the Group’s headquarters. The first anniversary celebrates the beginning of a contemporary, forward-looking project which draws on solid industrial experience, such as SIAI, stories of people and aerospace companies, technologies and the Italian influence around the world. This anniversary represents a link between the past and the future, a legacy that provides encouragement and moral strength, a roadmap which, while incorporating continuity with the past, looks to the long-term future with vision and pragmatism. The different stages of this path measure one’s achievements, maintain the historical memory and encourage new activities while firmly continuing the legacy. Foto gentilmente concessa da AVIANI EDITORE Integrated reporting year two 2015 is the second year in a row that the Mecaer Aviation Group’s annual report has been prepared as an integrated report, where the mandatory financial data are integrated with strategic, organisational and business information to better delineate the features of the group, in terms of the sustainability of its business model, while also providing information on the economic and social impact. Taken in 2013/2014, this decision takes the group step by step towards increasingly sophisticated reporting, confirming the relationship between financial and non-financial performance and offering the most comprehensive view possible of the group’s business. Accordingly, combining and subsequently reorganising the information was deemed essential and effective in order to highlight the various perspectives of the stakeholders directly and indirectly involved in MAG’s business project. The evolution of reporting formats and methods has its roots in the development of the company’s culture which is driven not only by increasingly stringent compliance requirements, but also by an increased awareness of the importance of social responsibility in its various forms. It is no coincidence that the historical legacy of the doctrinal debates over the trade-off between individual and corporate responsibility in general, has highlighted accountability and company controls as complementary to the scope of legislation. Christopher D. Stone lucidly entitled a brilliant empirical and anticipatory analysis of financial fraud and corporate political influence commissioned by the National Science Foundation Where the Laws Ends1. The group’s governance system has evolved over time on a voluntary basis, applying the best practices defined by regulated markets gradually and in proportion to the company’s size and its stage of maturity. 1 Christopher D. Stone, “Where The Law Ends: The Social Control of Corporate Behaviour”, Harper 6 Row, 1975. Research funded by the US National Science Foundation with the support of the Foundation’s Law and Social Science Program and carried out with the participation of the Faculty of Law of the University of Southern California. 6 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Corporate governance likewise developed in step with the process of developing an identity and is today substantially in line with models featuring a certain degree of complexity. The implementation of an internal control and risk management system pursuant to Legislative decree no. 262/2005 began in recent months. The aim is to move towards an integrated compliance regime where regulatory compliance stems from a highly integrated and interconnected view of compliance risks and ensures correct, transparent internal reporting and reporting to stakeholders in general. This report includes the environmental indicators identified in accordance with the recommendations issued by the IIRC2. They have been systematically monitored in the group’s main sites since 2014/15. As shown by the indicators themselves, although the group’s industrial activities are not significantly dangerous for the environment, the group’s sensitivity to the internal and external perception of this critical issue resulted in the introduction of these indicators which also represent a useful self-diagnosis tool and are important to achieve the environmental certifications slated for 2016. Indeed, accountability is also a legislative duty vis-à-vis the various compliance regimes, a stance that stresses the cultural and aspirational component and the pursuit of socially acceptable behaviour. With respect to methodology, certain clearly identified sections in the first part of this report include information that the group has provided on a voluntary basis with reference to the principles and recommendations issued by the IIRC and the regulatory standards currently being defined at EU level3. The 2015 Annual Report also includes the Director’s report, the Consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 semptember 2015 and the Separate financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 semptember 2015. The term integrated is also representative of the group’s offer which is based on the integration between products and services as well as on a combination of both consolidated and highly innovative technologies. Furthermore, the aerospace production industry in which the group operates is characterised by very distinctive trends that require special reporting in order to put events and decisions into context and best represent their contribution to creating value. In general, the main issues are intensive investments and economic cycles which, for most of the segments in which the group is active, cover a medium/long-term, sometimes a very long-term, time frame. In this scenario, the stakeholders’ perspective (i.e., those that have an interest at stake in the company and share risks) adds a multi-dimensional element to long-term strategies, combining an understanding of the contribution to the creation of value and the implication of control. 2 International Integrated Reporting Council. 3 Directive 2014/95/EU of the European Parliament and of the Council of 22 October 2014 amending Directive 2013/34/EU as regards disclosure of non-financial information. MAG | Annual Report 2015 7 Dear shareholders The year that just ended has been another positive year, with economic and financial performance that can be regarded as more than satisfactory. Several factors contributed to such results, starting by the investments performed in 2014 for the purpose of improving the industrial operations and by the development of the new-born Aircraft Services business unit, which is at an early stage, but it is expected to play a very important role in the nearest future. Also, some economic favorable circumstances, like the exchange rate of the main currencies the Group operates with, the US and the Canadian dollar against the Euro, have contributed to the overall result. From a merely quantitative stand point, the economic and financial results of the year can be summarized as follows: ◊ Net earnings € 6.3 million, + 167% compared to 2014, ◊ EBITDA € 16.2 million, +30% compared to 2014, ◊ Production Revenue € 133 million, in line with 2014, ◊ Sales € 123 million, - 6% compared to 2014, in line with the budget for the year; 2014 was still affected by the residual activity on the AW101 VVIP program, ◊ Net Financial Position € 27,8 million, compared to the € 32,5 million of 2014. The Canadian subsidiary has for the first time recorded a net profit (CAD 1.4 million), further to a EBITDA of some CAD 3,6 million, a turning point that sounds of compensation for the sacrifices undertaken and the investments borne as well as of confirmation for the strategies pursued and for the industrial plans that had envisaged such outcome. Beyond the figures, here are some remarkable events that I feel the need to highlight: ◊ the award of new contracts, as the ITP for the landing system of the Alenia Aermacchi M345 trainer aircraft, the framework agreement with Airbus Helicopters for the Stylence special cabin interior, the contract for the first AW189 VIP interior, some important commercial agreements concerning the industrial support for the NH500 and AB412 aircrafts which are likely to ensure stability to the MRO ope- 8 MAG | Annual Report 2015 rations of the Aircraft Services, ◊ the delivery of the first AW139 VIP interior realized in the US Hagerstown facility, ◊ the achievement of important STC’s, for the Bell 429 VIP as well as for the AH145 EMS ◊ The positive resolution of some pending claims toward customers During the year we have fine-tuned our strategy and defined our medium and long term targets which call for a remarkable growth in volumes, also by acquisitions, in order to increasingly achieve a world-wide basis and to reduce the predominance of Finmeccanica as a percentage of total sales . The achievement of such goals will be made possible by the already acquired backlog, which includes programs currently are under development. They currently do not generate sales, but they will definitely be the driving force in the years to come. technologies in the field of the creation and control of Comfort conditions: noise-vibration reduction, environmental optimization and cabin management. B) With regard to the Aircraft Services business unit, we shall try to replicate the strategy pursued in the helicopter segment, exploiting the owned competencies of the cabin comfort, externally acquiring the skills in aircraft management, which the Company does not yet possess. In conclusion, I would reaffirm the final statement of my last year message to you, shareholders, that « also thanks to the competence and dedication of our human resources, a key factor of our success, the business opportunities of this past year have made the Group stronger and more prepared to take on the new challenges of the years to come» For that purpose we intend to strengthen the Aircraft Services in North America, to extend and develop the presence of all our Divisions in the fixed-wings sector. Today the fixed-wings segment barely represents 15 % of our revenue, while its potential market is of a much larger size, when compared to that of the rotor-wings. Claudio Brun Managing Director More specifically, the distinctive elements of this growth strategy, will be the following. A) As regards the Integrated Aircraft Systems business unit, ◊ the landing systems, whose sales are currently higher for the fixed-wings rather than for the rotorwings, will organically continue to grow, benefitting from the strong cooperation with UTAS and the launch in production of the new programs already achieved either for rotorcrafts or for trainers and VLJ’s, ◊ the growth of the flight control systems will be focused on the hydraulic and EMA actuation and eventually strengthened by a possible acquisition, ◊ the Cabin Comfort will be enhanced and valued by developing and acquiring competencies and MAG | Annual Report 2015 9 Overview Group highlights The structure of the MAG group at the reporting date is summarised below. It has not changed since the previous year except for the increase in the investment in SAT – Società Aeroporto del Tronto S.p.A. (“SAT”) which rose from 93.3% to 93.9%. The only non-controlling interests relate to local public authorities4. Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. (Italy) 100,0 % Mecaer America Inc. (Canada) 100,0 % Mecaer Aviation Group Inc. (USA) 93,9 % Società Aeroporto del Tronto S.p.A. (Italy) In accordance with the group’s organisational and business model, the companies substantially report to the following two main operating segments or Strategic Business Units (“SBU”) which can be divided into three divisions: ◊ Integrated Aircraft Systems – focused on the sale of products (systems, sub-systems and parts) mainly for Original Equipment Manufacturers (“OEM”); ◊ Aircraft Services – focused on aircraft management and the supply of related services. Two divisions report to the first SBU. ◊ Actuation and Landing Systems (“ALS”), ◊ Cabin Comfort Systems (“CCS”). The second SBU represents the Aircraft Services (“AS”) division. Each SBU, comprised of the relevant divisions, has its own range of products and services. 4 Ascoli Piceno municipal authorities, which holds 6.1% of the company at the 2015 reporting date. Integrated Aircraft Systems Actuation and Landing Systems Division (ALS) Aircraft Services Cabin Comfort Systems Division (CCS) Aircraft Services Division (AS) The following graphs give a summary of the main financial and non-financial performance indicators, which have been selected to paint an overall picture of the group in its entirety (in millions of Euros, units or percentages %) Revenue5 Workers7 800 200 600 150 Mln. Euro 400 100 200 50 0 2012 0 2012 2013 2014 2015 2013 Temporary Workers 2014 2015 Employees Yeovil AW101 project (closed) EBITDA6 Research and evelopment8 20 14 Mln. Euro 12 15 10 8 Mln. Euro 10 5 6 4 2 0 0 2012 2013 15 2014 2015 2012 2013 2014 2015 The section on the group’s performance of operations and financial position includes information on the performance of the main group companies (see Highlights of main consolidated companies), while the notes to the consolidated financial statements include equity information on the main group companies (see 3.1 Consolidation methods and scope). % val. prod. 10 5 0 2012 2013 2014 2015 5 Revenue includes that relating to the AW101 interiors project in the three years in which the project was active. 6 Adjusted EBITDA; for the definition see Director’s report, Alternative (“NON IFRS”) performance ratios. 7 Temporary workers include those hired under temporary employment contracts pursuant to Italian law and jobshoppers that worked at the operating site in Yeovil (UK) (for additional information see also Human resources and safety in the workplace). 8 The data refer to total spending for applied research and development, including the amount funded directly by the group and the amount covered by revenue from customers or grants/assistance. Image courtesy of AVIANI EDITORE Mission & Values L everaging our background as an OEM, we combine technology with design and style to be the partner of choice and the problem solver for our customers in the helicopter, trainer and b&ga market. I inative and Essential be imaginative Our history shows that it is possible to be our very best with sacrifice, creativity and lofty aspirations. deliver on the promise We believe that long-lasting results go hand-in-hand with long-term relationships based on trust that we have forged with people, be they our employees, customers or other stakeholders. business integrity We are convinced that it is absolutely necessary for any project within our organisation to act with honesty and integrity. S o customers see us as the best solution, we must provide the highest technical expertise and the most reliable product quality at competitive prices value our people It is a top priority for us to support our people and to encourage their continuous training and professional growth in a transparent, cooperative and accessible working environment. In line with its characteristics, size and history, MAG has always gathered and processed information on its sustainability, initially intuitively and now in a more structured manner. The main steps taken in its commitment to sustainability are M ost importantly, to remain successful, we must consistently deliver on our promises, since our reputation is fundamental for our future growth 2006/2007 2008/2009 2011/2012 Implementation of the Organisational and control model pursuant to Legislative Decree N. 231/2001 Implementation of MAG group’s Corporate Governance model Publication and circulation of MAG group’s Code of Conduct 2013/2014 2014/2015 Preparation of the first MAG group’s Integrated Report Beginning of the implementation of the Compliance model pursuant to Ligislative Decree N. 262/2005 Significant events in the reporting period OCTOBER 2014 OCTOBER 2014 NOVEMBER 2014 Completion of the second phase (800 metres) of the airstrip asphalt Setting and appointment of MAG’s Executive Committee KAI UAV first flight using MAG’s landing system NOVEMBER 2014 DECEMBER 2014 DECEMBER 2014 AW169 Control Rods FFC certification STC for INAER HEMS KIT Contract for industrial support to Italy’s Air Force NH500 aircraft JANUARY 2015 JANUARY 2015 ITP award M345 Alenia Aermacchi landing system Beginning of V280 Bell Helicopter experimental activities FEBRUARY 2015 Delivery of the first 429WLG Bell Helicopter with MAG landing system APRIL 2015 APRIL 2015 MAY 2015 MACH3 Certification from Quebec Government First AW139 VIP interior at MAG Inc.’s site in Hagerstown MD (USA) Delivery of the first 525 Bell Helicopter interior KIT MAY 2015 JUNE 2015 JUNE 2015 International Yacht and Aviation Award - Private jet Belvedere concept H160 first flith with FFC and MAG’s landing system International Paris Airshow Le Bourget - partecipation with Piedmont region cluster FEBRUARY 2015 JULY 2015 JULY 2015 AUGUST 2015 STC for 429 Bell Helicopter Interiors EASA certification for the first installation of 429 Bell Helicopter MAGnificent luxury interior 525 Bell first flight with MAG’s landing system Master agreement for Stylence/ EMS Airbus H145 special cabin interior MARCH 2015 MARCH 2015 AUGUST 2015 SEPTEMBER 2015 SEPTEMBER 2015 HAI Eli-Expo Orlando partecipation in trade show and exhibition Contract for the manufacturing of the first AW189 VVIP interiors International patent for materials for aircraft interiors soundproofing Completion of the multi-stage electromechanical actuator project - Lombardy Aerospace District Bylaws reform and appointment of a manager for financial reporting pursuant to LD no. N. 262/2005 MAG - Company profile and sustainability Company profile MAG is an Italian industrial group operating internationally in the aerospace sector. It pursues a leadership position in the market segments in which it is present. It was founded in 1995 through a buy-out by private investors and is currently mainly owned by leading institutional investors. MAG has followed a highly ambitious quantitative and qualitative growth process with a targeted investment plan. The group currently boasts significant, comprehensive expertise and infrastructures to support its future growth. The group’s activities are focused in the helicopter and business & general aviation aircraft in the civil sector and, to a marginal extent, the military sector. In line with outsourcing trends on the aerospace market over the past twenty years, which have led the main original equipment manufacturers (OEMs) to transfer the design, production and management of entire systems to suppliers/ partners, MAG has decided to compete as a system integrator in the market segment that it has identified. The group’s origins and know-how as an aircraft maker undoubtedly contributed to its positioning, gained in previous industrial projects (Nardi, Agusta and SIAI Marchetti), involving structures and resources that are now part of the MAG group. Through the development of new products, expertise and technologies, MAG has strengthened its competitive edge by participating in innovative industrial projects as part of strategic partnerships with major OEMs or industrial groups that supply sophisticated products in the aerospace and defense sector. The group’s activities are currently organised into two operating segments. They have been defined as part of the process to improve the company’s strategies, leading to the identification of the two main strategic areas in which MAG is active. theoretically multi-business nature and its willingness to go through economic, operational and change processes that pursue coordination of products, technologies and the reference market. In this respect, the internal organisation evolved to be structured by divisions, incorporating production factors, technical and human resources, and which is deemed best to pursue management objectives. Consequently, some divisions sharing the same basis were subsequently combined, while maintaining the differences and the structures that had led to their identification. The drivers that currently determine the strategic positioning and competitive policies distinguish between the group’s offer of products and systems that mainly, but not exclusively, target Original Equipment Manufacturers, i.e., aircraft makers, and the provision of a wide range of services to aircraft makers, some of which are already part of the existing skill sets and others related to diversification and development objectives. Indeed, it is felt that this second strategic area, in terms of both size and nature, has more potential than its present value. However, this is also the reason for its identification as an operating segment, i.e., clearly directing the decisionmaking process and allocating the resources necessary to implement strategies. The first operating segment (the Integrated Aircraft Systems) is therefore characterised by an offer of products and systems that has many technologies and mainly targets OEMs. It is comprised of two divisions: Actuation and Landing Systems (“ALS”) and Cabin Comfort Systems (“CCS”). This is based on the company’s awareness of its at least 18 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 19 Strategic business units Divisions Business lines sbu1 integrated Actuation & Landing Systems •Landing Systems •Actuation & Flight Control Systems •Hydraulic Systems •Damping Systems aircraft systems SBU2 AIRCRAFT SERVICES Cabin Comfort Systems •Cabin Noise-Vibration Reduction Systems •Cabin Environmental Optimization Systems •Cabin Management Systems Design and Aircraft Services •Kit installation •Style Design •Aircraft Mission Customization •Aircraft Completion, Refurbishment & MRO one stop shop, FBO Product Related Services Production of Kits Products •Landing Gear •Wheel & Brake •Steering •Retract Actuator (Hydr. & EMA) •Command Lever & Control Unit (Hydr. Manifold, Electronic) Sites Companies Montreal (Canada) •Pilot Stick and Pedal Assy •Command Chain (Mechanical Rods, Wire) •Actuator (Hydr. & EMA) •Servoactuator •Control Unit (Hydr. Manifold, Electronic) Borgomanero (Italy) •Liners and Silens with soundproofing •Embedded Air Distribution Ducts •Environmental Control System •Air Purification •Cabin Monuments & Cabinets •intercom •infotainment •cabin lights control •cabin utilities control •cabin air flow control Monteprandone (Italy) MAG Design Studio Roma (Italy) Monteprandone, Vergiate (Italy) Philadelphia (USA) MAG Inc. Mecaer America Inc. Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. SAT S.p.A. SBU Integrated Aircraft Systems Divisions: Actuation and Landing Systems Cabin Comfort Systems Revenue (Mln. Eur): Operatings sites: Employees: 102,9 4 434 Actuation and Landing Systems division (ALS) The ALS division offers primary technological systems (safety critical), i.e., landing systems, actuation and flight control systems, damping systems and hydraulic systems. These products are created for specific aircraft and are sold to OEMs. By developing technologically homogenous systems, MAG group’s background of expertise in mechanical, hydraulic, electro-mechanical and electronic technologies, commands and materials is transversal. It has developed and consolidated this expertise over time in a lengthy process that began with build-to-print activities and ended with make-to-design projects, also entailing the creation of parts, the development and testing of systems, all the way to system integration. ◊ Integrated landing systems are mostly proprietary and currently include: ◊ front and main landing gear legs, ◊ wheels and brakes, ◊ retraction and extraction actuators (hydraulic and electro-mechanical), ◊ command levers and control devices (hydraulic and electronic), ◊ steering commands (hydraulic, electro-hydraulic and electromechanical), ◊ antiskid features. Mainly proprietary integrated flight command and actuation systems include: ◊ pilot and co-pilot control panels, pedals, ◊ flight controls (mechanical with bars and levers, electric wire), ◊ servo-actuators (hydraulic and electromechanical), ◊ closed-ring controls (hydraulic and electronic). The purpose of this division is to ensure customers receive support for the entire life of each product from a specific product support area, which also operates under licence for non-proprietary products. The division has operating sites in Borgomanero (Novara, Italy) and Laval (Montréal, Canada). It recently acquired new projects for the Bell Helicopter 505, Bell Helicopter 525, Airbus Helicopter AH160 and the Korean UAV Kaori and Alenia Aermacchi M345 aircraft. Cabin Comfort Systems division (CCS) The CCS division consists of technological/functional cabin comfort systems co-designed with OEMs in the initial development stage of a new aircraft, when the cabin can be significantly engineered to meet the customer’s needs or at a later stage. This system category is used in sophisticated cabin management systems which combine fully innovative technologies with existing ones adapted to the aerospace sector. This category mainly includes: ◊ noise-vibration reduction systems, ◊ environmental optimisation systems, ◊ cabin management systems, which share the common goal of improving cabin comfort. The developments of this business line are aimed at finding alternative solutions that meet the need for an improvement in functionalities, the maintenance of parts and systems, and that improve comfort through entertainment and vibration and noise reduction systems. Some developments are particularly innovative and result in the legal protection of design rights (e.g., Damp systems for multilayer composite panels); others refer to the introduc- tion of new technologies that generate technical contents for consumers in the aerospace field (e.g., WAP wrdware products and remote control systems). These systems are supplied as KITs and, in addition to distinguishing MAG’s systems offer, they complement the range of traditional components and parts (cabinets, liners, transparent electro-chromatic parts, lights, etc.). Therefore, cabin kits are differentiated based on the type of customisation (emergency medical service, VIP, corporate, oil & gas applications). The CCS division also ensures customers receive support for the product’s entire life from a dedicated product support area. CCS operating activities are concentrated at the Monteprandone site (Ascoli Piceno, Italy). This business line recently acquired new projects for the Bell Helicopter 525, AirbusHelicopter AH160, AgustaWestland AW 189 and the restyling of the AW139 aircraft. SBU Aircraft Services Divisions Aircraft Services Revenue (Mln. Eur): Operating sites: Employees: 20,5 4 93 Unlike the CCS division of the Integrated Aircraft Systems which mainly co-designs products with OEMs, the Aircraft Services segment offers services for aircraft already developed by the manufacturer. The MAG Design Studio, which constitutes an integral part of the AS division, is the distinguishing feature, as it aims to achieve brand recognition in the style of its VIP interiors, ergonomic optimisation and industrial design. Its aim is to offer a complete range of services to give end customers or operators customised aircraft that meets the requirements of their specific mission. As such, the MAG Design Studio strives to be both a point of reference for customers’ style coordinators and the solution for customers seeking one single provider with a complete solution. The range of aircraft services includes ◊ kit installation, ◊ style design, ◊ aircraft mission customisation (VIP and EMS interiors), ◊ air base services (flight, maintenance and overhaul services), ◊ support in pilot and maintenance technician training, to enable customers to fully focus on their core activities, such as emergency assistance, airtaxi services, business travel and freight transport. These services are offered to OEMs, operators and end customers and are based on the research and development (R&D) conducted for the proprietary systems developed by other group divisions. They draw on specific infrastructures (hangars, landing pads, airstrips and classrooms for technical personnel), which are either owned (the Tronto airstrip) or belong to third parties. The background exploited for this business line consists, inter alia, of aircraft building know-how passed down from previous manufacturing experience. Aircraft MRO & refurbishment, and cabin kit installation complete the range of services offered and can be carried out at either the customer’s facilities or MAG’s infrastructures for one-stop shopping. Mobile aircraft repair stations can also perform MRO activities on aircraft. Refurbishment and kit installation services include VIP (which can feature MAG Design Studio styling), EMS, Corporate, Utility and Oil & Gas interiors. AS activities are located in various centres near key customers and exploit infrastructures useful for the services, such as regional airports: Monteprandone (Ascoli Piceno, Italy), Vergiate (Varese, Italy), Philadelphia (PA, USA) and Hagerstown (MD, USA). The business line recently acquired new projects for the Bell Helicopter 429 VIP, Airbus Helicopters EC145 VIP and Airbus Helicopters EC 145T2 EMS aircraft. B y working every day in the factory to produce something that we then see living and running in the streets of the world and returning to us in the form of wage, which then becomes bread, wine, and house for our family, we contribute to the vibrating life of the factory, to its smallest as well as to its biggest things, we end up loving it, growing fond of it and, in this way, it truly becomes part of us. The work becomes little by little part of our soul, like an immense spiritual force. Lavorando ogni giorno tra le pareti della fabbrica e le macchine e i banchi e gli altri uomini per produrre qualcosa che vediamo correre nelle vie del mondo e ritornare a noi in salari che sono poi pane, vino e casa, partecipiamo ogni giorno alla vita pulsante della fabbrica, alle sue cose più piccole e alle sue cose più grandi, finiamo per amarla, per affezionarci e allora essa diventa veramente nostra, il lavoro diventa a poco a poco parte della nostra anima, diventa quindi una immensa forza spirituale. A. Olivetti9 Corporate responsibility Governance and sustainability MAG’s business model and corporate governance system took shape, first instinctively and then progressively designed, around the primary aim of creating long-lasting value. Over time, a sense of sustainability gradually, but determinately arose, as it is expressed in this report. The relationship between governance and government and the interdependence of a company’ social aspects and its central role in the implementation of industrial policies in MAG’s sector has traced an unusual path, with an uncommon timing, as can be seen in the experience of Airbus Industries, which was set up as a non-company for the European integration project10. Within the scope of the more recent debate about11 the 9 Ai lavoratori (2012), “Discorsi agli operai di Pozzuoli ed Ivrea” L. Gallino. Collana Humana Civitas, Edizioni di Comunità. 10 “L’Europa dei progetti: imprese, innovazione, sviluppo”. Dario Velo. Giuffré editore, 2007. 11 “Corporate Governance and Sustainability: Challenges for Theory and Practice”, Suzanne Benn, Dexter Dunphy, Routledge, 270 Madison Ave, NY, 2013. 28 MAG | Annual Report 2015 complex and frequently controversial nature of corporate responsibility, an increasingly specific ontology has taken shape in the form of a system of values that combine running a business with its sustainability, from the differentiated and multi-faceted view of stakeholders. In the past few decades, companies have become fertile ground for experimenting with economic theories that are, at times, contrasting12 but share the rising awareness of the multi-dimensional nature of company policies, which often prove to be ineffective when oriented only, or reductively, to generating profit. The way in which companies are now seen as experimental – and privileged - entities is due to the fact that a company constitutes the core unit of advanced economies, which is to say that it is the most elementary structure of economic development, and because its old and new governance systems have proven to be crucial for the development of economic behaviour, with a view to reconciling, after attaining coherence, business objectives with the principles of sustainability. 12 “The Social Responsibility of Business is to Increase its Profits”, Friedman M. (1970), New York Times Magazine, 13 Sept., N.Y. and “Strategic Management: a Stakeholder approach” Freeman R.E. (1984), Pitman, Boston. In recent times, sustainability principles have been applied to economic development, to the extent that they have been codified, and this has included many different rules, operating principles and process standards13 in the various fields. It is into this historically dense context in which much experience has been gained that the series of concepts and values on which MAG has based its own business model and governance structure fall, seeking to integrate as far as possible all the legislative and internal rules, relationships, processes and company systems through which it exercises business control, clearly outlining the structure of responsibilities that guides the achievement of objectives. From an operational standpoint, the pursuit of these objectives entails striving for excellence in business organisation, safeguarding the solidity of assets and the reliability of its essential processes and in the functional transparency and professional and ethical conduct. In conjunction with an efficient business strategy, these elements constitute the system of values whereby MAG interprets and meets the expectations of its stakeholders. 13 Consider ISO 26000 with respect to social responsibility and AA1000. MAG | Annual Report 2015 29 The stakeholders paradigm Recent developments in strategic management theory emphasise a change in the nature of companies, such as, for example, the growing importance of intangible assets, intangible capital and know-how, which are increasingly more valuable than financial assets. In order to understand and internalise the company’s aims and the factors underlying its success, the affirmation of its principles must also consider its vision of the identity and role of stakeholders. With respect to the identity of stakeholders, the most concise and preferred definitions take an approach that is both pragmatic and philosophical14, identifying a stakeholder as anyone who has an interest in MAG “at stake”, be such interest capital, human, physical or financial. With respect to their role, it is certain that the driver that links them is the fact that they share risk, giving each of them the ability and, at the same time, the right to influence strategic company decisions. The most interesting part of MAG’s value system is the fact that stakeholders provide a competitive edge in proportion to and because of their investment, be it tangible or intangible. Combining these elements, as noted above, Integration becomes the byword for a notion that was once technical/productive. In this way, it is borrowed from the terminology of the various integrated technologies on which MAG’s business plan is based, becoming a meta-term that efficiently denotes the view that stakeholders, or rather values, are complementary and interdependent in the group’s business model. Each of the stakeholders, to whom the section on the sustainability of the MAG project is dedicated (see Social sustainability), offers a different perspective on how value is created. Similarly, this aspect is considered in the strategic guidelines applied to long-term planning (see Strategies and strategic positioning). Stakeholder Value Competitive edge Risk Human resources (employees and workers) Identity Expertise and company climate Welfare Shareholders Address Solidity and wealth Share capital Customers Positioning Reputation and growth Confidence and goodwill Suppliers Integration Quality and efficency Continuity Financial community Resource allocation Liquidity Credit Public administration and institutions Consensus Systemic support and infrastructures Continuity and welfare Community and the local area Report Social and environmental resources Pollution and health Technological community Know how Innovation Change Economic value and stakeholders Maintaining that stakeholders contribute in different but fundamental ways to the company’s competitiveness means conceptualising that they contribute concretely to the potential creation of economic value. In line with the group’s newly developed notion of financial reporting, MAG has supplemented the performance and financial data to present a necessarily simplified schedule analysing the generation and allocation of economic value to stakeholders. 14 For everyone, M.B.E. Clarkson, “The Corporation and its Stakeholders: Classic and Contemporary Readings”. University of Toronto Press, 1998. 30 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 31 To this end, economic value means the total wealth created by MAG, based on the GRI15 definition in a manner consistent with objectively measurable indicators in accordance with the relevant standards of accounting and financial practice. However, economic value is also shown divided into value distributed and value withheld, constituting the breakdown of value among the various stakeholders (suppliers, workers, financial backers, shareholders, the public administration and the community). Economic value generated by the group 2014/15 2013/14 2012/13 2011/12 Revenue 123.356 130.788 148.936 122.134 Other segment revenue 7.998 (1.227) 16.681 6.351 Other income 1.750 724 918 1.030 301 371 319 26 1.918 939 (1.602) 2.650 Total economic value generated 135.323 131.595 165.252 132.191 Economic value distributed by the group 2014/15 2013/14 2012/13 2011/12 Supplier remuneration 80.477 80.285 103.380 82.188 Worker remuneration 36.313 37.573 46.332 34.942 2.450 2.801 2.413 3.805 - - - - 3.465 3.317 5.236 3.693 101 14 12 14 Total economic value distributed 122.806 123.990 157.373 124.642 Economic value withheld by the group 2014/15 2013/14 2012/13 2011/12 Amortisation and depreciation 4.825 4.562 4.267 4.330 Provisions 1.409 696 310 1.001 - - (94) - 6.283 2.347 3.396 2.218 12.517 7.605 7.879 7.549 Financial income Exchange rate gains (losses) Financial backer remuneration Shareholder remuneration Public administration remuneration Donations Utilisation of provisions Reserves Total economic value withheld The structure of distributed value highlights the numerical significance of wealth creation from the economic process carried out by the group’s business activities, with a significant role played by suppliers, corresponding to the strategically integrated supply chain, and collaborators, who are the biggest driver, through work and the skills they provide. The distribution of economic value to the public administration is also important. It ideally represents the remuneration of services, infrastructures and the community in general. Dividends are not distributed as earnings are withheld within the group as value allocated to support future development strategies. 15 Global Reporting Initiative. MAG | Annual Report 2015 33 The external context and currency depreciation against strong ones, being the US dollar, the Euro and the Yen. The macroeconomic context Six years after the world economy emerged from its broadest and deepest postwar recession, the holy grail of robust and synchronized global expansion remains elusive. As identified by the IMF16 in its recent World Economic Outlook Report, despite considerable differences in country-specific outlooks, the new forecasts bring down expected near-term growth marginally and downside risks to the world economy appear more pronounced. Advanced economies show strengthening of fundamentals in the short term, particularly the US and UK, more fragile in Europe and Japan. In emerging or developing economies the situation remains extremely uncertain and affected by economic factors, such as the considerable decrease in the price of raw materials, and the political instability which had a material impact and generated significant social and economic costs. Overall, the forecasts of the International Monetary Fund about said economies indicate 2015 as the fifth consecutive year of declining growth. Again with respect to these areas, it should be noted that the overall decline is accompanied by the resistance of productivity to improvement. This is partly due to the low investments of these countries, sometimes marked by high growth, that limit productivity and hold back wage trends. However, the weakness of aggregate demand which is, in turn, held back by the low level of investments in a vicious cycle, remains the common denominator. With respect to the overall trend of post-war economies, according to some economic historians, there is a progressive narrowing of the driving force of technological progress over growth, which is momentarily mitigated by the entry of China and former Soviet Union countries into the market economy. According to another school of thought, the driving force of the so-called “transformative innovation”, which ranges from robotics to bioengineering, maintains strong activation capabilities although, similarly to the invention of electric power over one hundred years ago, several decades are necessary before the returns are reflected in the quantitative growth of the domestic product. In more practical and immediate terms, the downward trend in the price of oil and commodities, including many metals, that has been underway more or less since 2011, further accentuated in the past few months, generating a progressive deterioration of the balance of trade for many producing countries and, consequently, a contraction of cash flows 16 International Monetary Fund (“IMF”). World Economic Outlook Report. 21 October 2015. Maurice Obstfelt. Economic Counsellor. 34 In this mix of different phenomena, several economists see the characteristics of a technical adjustment process that reflects growth rate differentials in a context of floating exchange rates. In other words, exchange rate trends are mainly due to their natural role of “shock absorbers” rather than to currency policy conflicts. In fact, every time an emerging country – e.g., Argentina or China – tried to introduce a fixed exchange rate, it had a devastating effect on both central bank reserves and, more generally, on the financial stability of the economy as a whole. At present, many issues of concern are caused by the significant rise in debt taken on in the strong currencies by companies operating in emerging markets, as well as the continuing concern over China’s prospects and the evolution of situations such as that of Greece in the Eurozone, which, sometimes, rapidly accentuate market volatility. Therefore, the overall scenario remains inconsistent, with figures highlighting the weakening of growth in the first half of 2015, still estimated at +3.1% p.a. globally, below initial forecasts (+3.8%) and 2014 actual figures (3.4%). Among the advanced countries, the United States and the United Kingdom show positive fundamentals and GDP growth per annum is respectively estimated at 2.6% and 2.5% for 2015 and 2.8% and 2.2% for 2016. In the US, the recovery is set to continue, mainly driven by the deflation of energy products, the reduction in fiscal drag and robust internal demand. These factors are expected to prevail over the impact on exports of the dollar, which has been persistently strong since early 2015. The unemployment rate further decreased to 5.1% at the end of August, down 0.4% and 1% on February and on the same period of 2014, respectively. Up until now the monetary policy has been careful in detecting emerging trends and postponed the normalisation process which, however, remains one of the goals of the Federal Reserve and a focus of attention for emerging economies. Based on the concerns about the international macroeconomic scenario, the September’s Federal Open Market Committee did not make any change to the target range for federal funds rates (0.0 – 0.25%), while market operators expect an increase in 2016, as confirmed by the trend of interest rates of OIS17. In North America, Canada shows an opposite trend, after the significant growth (2.4%) recorded in 2014. This is mainly due to the effect of the adjustment caused by the 17 Overnight Indexed Swaps. Source: Thomson Reuters Datastream. The expected return on these derivatives, reflected in prices, reflect operators’ expectations about the future trend of overnight interest rates. MAG | Annual Report 2015 Macroeconomic context (% change on the previous year) IMF118 Revisions vs July2015 2014 2015 2016 2015 2016 World 3,4 3,1 3,6 (0,2) (0,2) Advanced countries 1,8 2,0 2,2 (0,1) (0,2) Eurozone 0,9 1,5 1,6 (0,1) (0,2) (0,1) 0,6 1,0 (0,2) (0,2) UK 3,0 2,5 2,2 0,1 - US 2,4 2,6 2,8 0,1 (0,2) Canada 2,4 1,0 1,7 (0,5) (0,4) Emerging countries 4,6 4,0 4,5 (0,2) (0,2) Brazil 0,1 (3,0) (1,0) (1,5) (1,7) China 7,3 6,8 6,3 - - India 7,3 7,3 7,5 (0,2) - Russian Federation 0,6 (3,8) (0,6) (0,4) (0,8) World trade 3,3 3,2 4,1 (0,9) (0,3) GDP Japan fall in the price of oil products and other raw materials that account for a considerable portion of both domestic product and exports.18 Meanwhile, the effects of the earlier expansionary monetary policies, together with the robust growth in the US that drives non-commodity exports, generate a redistribution of aggregate demand and a positive overall effect on the domestic product of the last two quarters of 2015. After the fall recorded in the first half of the year19, the rebound effect is estimated at approximately 2%20 in the second half, bringing total annual growth to +1%. The analysis shown in the Canadian central bank’s Monetary Policy Report, highlights the change in the contribution of the various components of domestic product to the latter’s actual (2014) and expected (2015 – 2017) variation. In the Eurozone the situation remains complex, with a global recovery underway despite several risk factors, such as 18 IMF. World Economic Outlook Report. “Overview of the World Economic Outlook Projections”. Table 1.1. 19 (0.8) IQ, (0.5) IIQ. Source: Bank of Canada. “Monetary Policy Report”, 21 October 2015. 20 Bank of Canada, op. cit.. the weakening of world trade and the turbulence in financial and currency markets. Internal demand strengthened in the first quarter of the year and, based on statistics21, remains the main determinant of growth, while net exports are more influenced by the weak demand from emerging countries and benefit from the depreciation of the Euro, especially against the US dollar. Since the first few months of the year the recovery has spread within the Eurozone. The accommodative monetary policies progressively implemented by the European Central Bank played a decisive leading role, especially through the Expanded asset purchase programme (EAPP) which, since January 2015, has included the bonds issued by the central administrations of Eurozone countries. As of 9 October 2015, a total of 359 billion22 worth of public securities were purchased, in addition to 125 billion covered bank bonds and 13 billion asset-backed securities. The aim of these measures 21 European Central Bank, “Economic bulletin no. 4/2015”. October 2015. 22 Banca d’Italia, “Economic bulletin. No. 4/2015”. October 2015. 1.2 The Euro Area. MAG | Annual Report 2015 35 is to increase the amount of money23 in circulation in the system, enhancing the liquidity of public and private bodies that benefit from securitisation and obtaining effects similar to those generated by the quantitative easing policies directly implemented by the main monetary authorities24 to combat recession. All monetary indicators of the relevant period improved and the available liquidity lays the ground for an improvement of credit trends, which have remained weak up until now. In other words, the ECB’s measures are contributing to “restoring the proper functioning of the monetary policy transmission mechanism and soften credit granting criteria”25. Credit for this success goes to the Governor Mr. Draghi who substantially revolutionised the European Central Bank monetary policy, while complying with the mandate laid down under the European Treaty, against a fragmented and sometimes contradictory political context and an economic scenario facing the threat of deflation. Despite the slight improvement in the third quarter of 2015, the depreciation of the Euro26, which began in mid-2014, contributed to increasing the international competitiveness of European companies and redefining the inflation outlook for the area. Indeed, the import prices of consumables and intermediate goods rose considerably over the past few months, although the transmission of the exchange rate to harmonised inflation takes place with distributed and mitigated delay due to the nature of the production and the price chains. In the absence of further exchange rate fluctuations, the depreciation of the Euro should have its maximum inflationary effect at the end of 201527. Besides the economic factors and the real success of the measures that support the growth of Europe, the latter’s overall potential28 remains relatively weak given the legacy of the recent recession, demographic factors and the unsatisfactory productivity. The idle production capacity in the Eurozone remains above pre-crisis levels29, while the unemployment gap has widened to 10% of the labour force in September 2015 compared to 7.5% in 2007. 23 The impact affects the M3 aggregate which includes, compared to the other aggregates, financial assets (bonds and short-term government securities) which may represent a store of value. 24 The Federal Reserve decided (Q3 programme) to purchase securities worth USD40billion per month until a “sustainable” growth level is reached. The Bank of England implemented a purchase programme worth GBP375 billion, while the Bank of Japan further expanded its QE programme, increasing it to JPY91 thousand. 25 European Central Bank, op.cit., 5. Money and credit. 26 Since 6 November 2014, the date of commencement of the preliminary (according to EU) works for the Eurosystem purchase programme, the Euro has depreciated by 10% against the US dollar and by 5.2% in nominal effective terms. Source: Banca d’Italia., op.cit. 1.3 World financial markets. 27 E. Hahn., “Pass-through of external shocks to euro area inflation”, Working Paper Series, no. 243. ECB. July 2003. 28 IMF Executive Board’s discussion of the World Economic Outlook, Global Financial Stability Report, and Fiscal Monitor, 21 September 2015. 29 The Commission’s quarterly survey of businesses, fourth quarter of 2015. The percentage of idle production capacity is equal to 18.5%, up 2.9% on 2007. 36 Therefore, medium/long-term prospects30 remain characterised by moderate growth and limited inflation. Public finances indicate a deficit of the public administration of 2.6% of GDP. In September, the government revised estimated trends upwards35. 2015 indebtedness is expected to increase on 201436 despite the rise in tax revenues. In this context, the Italian economy shows moderate signs of recovery31, with a slight reduction of the gap compared to the Eurozone as a whole, estimated at 0.7% and 0.3% for 2015 and 2016, respectively. The growth recorded in the first two quarters of the year was driven by the good performance of exports and the increase in the domestic demand for consumer goods, especially durables, while the decrease in investments remains high, particularly in the construction sector. Thanks to the Eurosystem’s measures, after a long period of contraction, in Italy, lending to the non-financial private sector stabilised during the summer. However, lending remains extremely challenging to obtain for small companies and for specific sectors, such as the construction and the service sectors. Conversely, loans to larger manufacturing companies have increased in the twelve months to August37. In particular, Italy’s economic trends generally reflect changes in the macroeconomic environment rather than the government’s measures, where the public finance situation prevents the implementation, inter alia, of accommodating tax policies to complement the monetary ones introduced at central level32. Therefore, according to the most authoritative sources, the global economy experienced a growth slowdown in 2015 caused by the factors described earlier, specifically the performance of the emerging markets and the depressive effect on exporting countries of the decrease in the price of energy and non-energy raw materials. The delay in the definition and implementation of business policies to recover the impacts of the decrease in investments on production capacity, which marked the entire recessionary period, makes it difficult to adopt measures which will bring Italian companies out of the crisis. Growth is expected to resume at a higher pace starting from 2016, following the combined effect of two types of factors. The lack of measures to resolve local imbalances, i.e., involving those sectors that have the ability to activate the economy, such as the construction sector, mitigate the effects of the cyclical reversal and prevent Italy from fully benefiting from the opportunities offered by the improved economic situation. Italy’s GDP is 8.9% below pre-crisis levels, the number of employed people decreased by over 720 thousand and the number of unemployed workers doubled to almost 8 million33. Companies used the reforms implemented by the Italian government on the employment market, which were generally aimed at increasing flexibility, to essentially reduce personnel expenses rather than to increase productivity and the country’s growth potential. From a more technical point of view, the relief from social security contributions for employees newly-hired under open-ended contracts, and, above all, the new individual dismissal procedure introduced by the Jobs Act, which reduces the dismissal costs for companies with at least 15 employees, generated an initial increase in new employees. However, the effect on participation and employment rates which are, presently, contradictory34, should be assessed over a longer time horizon. 30 IMF, “Recent Development and Prospects”, Economic Outlook for Individual Countries and Regions. October 2015. 31 Banca d’Italia, op.cit., 2. The Italian economy. 32 Remark by Vitor Constancio, Vice-President of the European Central Bank at the Prometeia meeting, November 2015. 33 Source. Confindustria. Scenari Economici. No. 24/2015. “Le sfide della politica economica”. September 2015. 34 The available data refer to the Mandatory disclosures of the Ministry of Labour and Social Policies. They differ from those provided by ISTAT (the Italian National Statistical Institute) in its “Workforce survey”. MAG | Annual Report 2015 The first is the expected gradual return to growth of regions that are currently under stress or whose performance is largely below their growth potential, such as Brazil, Latin America in general and part of the Middle East. The second refers to the effect of countries such as China and India which continue to drive global growth in terms of size and trends. Finally, in the Eurozone, emerging countries show remarkably high growth rates38, supported by the main economic factors, though affected by the contraction suffered by Russia and the significant indebtedness of companies vis-à-vis investments. The political tensions with the Russian Federation have an impact on the most active countries, such as Turkey, which is expected to grow steadily by 3% in both 2015 and 2016. In the first half of 2015, international trading volumes increased at levels below GPD, indicating that the economic performance of the period was more favourable for the service sector, rather than for the sectors trading in goods. The analyses carried out by the International Monetary Fund and Consensus Economics on the risk data concerning the prospects of the global economic system point to a slight deterioration of the uncertainty index on the key factors of the global outlook. 35 “Note updating the Economic and Financial Report for 2015”, 18 September 2015. 36 132.8% of GDP compared to 132.1% in 2014, 129.3% compared to 128.4% if indebtedness is considered net of support to EUM countries [bilateral loans to Greece, Italy’s portion of the loans disbursed to the European Financial Stability Facility (EFSF) and the contribution to capital of the European Stability Mechanism (ESM)]. 37 Banca d’Italia, Economic Bulletin No. 4/2015 “Credit demand and supply” and Il Sole 24 Ore, “Bank Lending Survey.” 38 3% in 2015 and 2016. Source: IMF, op.cit. “GDP Growth Forecasts”. October 2015. The resulting scenarios based on quantitative data cannot cover the issues that, today, have a major impact on the evolution of social and economic systems, starting from the geopolitical risks that have an increasingly disruptive effect on international trade and financial transactions, and also cause imbalances, migratory flows and vulnerable social and cultural trends. The theoretical debate on Secular Stagnation39 introduces into econometrics an assessment of the economic systems’ potential to continue their expansionary trends that are already uncertain in the most advanced economies, despite the structural policies and reforms due to the considerable imbalances in many regions of the world which are often functional to preserving growth scenarios. This context includes theories40 that underline the strategic value of international agreements and reforms aimed at a more balanced distribution of wealth and access to natural resources, making the most of the relocalisation of production activities underway, including the re-territorialisation of areas. The contribution of innovation and research and development, particularly in the energy, transport and the commodities cycle sector, could prove decisive to the qualitative improvement of the economic processes, in terms of sustainability. Despite the quantitative effect, this essentially offers a broader and less self-referential perspective of progress. The aerospace industry The aerospace industry plays a strategic role in advanced economies, as it generates wealth and high-level technologies and constitutes a key sector for political/institutional and national sovereignty equilibrium. The modern age of the aerospace industry began 111 years ago with the first flight by the Wright brothers on 17 December 1903. From that moment on, it has sent the first man to the moon, introduced supersonic flight, developed aircraft carrying over one billion passengers per year and sent a spacecraft beyond the solar system. This industry changed how consumers travel, communicate by satellite, buy on the Internet, start armed conflicts and reach the furthest corners of the earth with humanitarian missions. The aerospace industry will continue to innovate technologies, generating improvements in this and other fields. 39 IMF, World Economic Outlook 2014, “Scenario analysis”, October 2014. 40 Karl Polany, Columbia University, “The Great Transformation: The Political and economic Origins of Our Time”, 1944, Review Essay by Anne Mayew, College of Arts and sciences, University of Tennessee. More recently, Serge Latouche, Paris Orsay University and Institut d’études du devoloppement économique et social (IEDES), “L’invention de l’économie”, 2010. MAG | Annual Report 2015 37 In the long term, the commercial sector will bring people closer using the safest and most efficient air transport. Financial performance differential between the top 20 US companies of the sector – Commercial vs. Defence. In billions of USD or as a percentage The defence sector is driven by the need for ongoing technical improvements in order to launch reconnaissance and containment missions that mitigate the risks for those involved. In general, technological innovation is the key factor for progress in this industry and to identify new markets and create demand for existing markets. Turnover of the top 20 companies in this industry in 201441 totalled approximately USD500 billion, with operating profit up on the previous year by more than 10%. The top 20 US companies in this industry account for roughly three quarters of the above figures, confirming North America’s leading role in industrial terms and with respect to the reference market value. Top 20 US A&D companies Nine months ended 09/2014 Nine months ended 09/2013 Var. % Commercial aerospace Defence 109,4 99,9 9,5% Operating profit 162,8 166,2 (2,1)% Commercial aerospace Defence 13,4 11,7 14,5% Defense 18,4 17,8 3,4% Financial performance of the top 20 companies in the aerospace industry. In billions of USD or as a percentage. Top 20 US A&D companies Turnover Operating profit Operating margin Nine months ended 09/2014 Nine months ended 09/2013 Var% 272,2 266,2 2,3% 31,8 11,7% 29,5 11,1% 7,8% 5,4% In this context, the commercial segment again outperformed the defence segment in 2014, whose performance remains strongly affected by the US government’s shrinking public spending after the strong impetus generated by the prolonged armed conflicts, from Iraq to Afghanistan. The US accounts for 39% of the overall global defence spending. Financial performance differential between the top 20 companies The entire sector employs a total of over two million people42, and three times as many if the entire industrial chain is considered43. As mentioned earlier, the aerospace industry relies on the mastery of high-level technologies and innovation plays a crucial role in companies’ commercial success, with implications for all other economic sectors through the overall industrial chain. The products that the aerospace industry develops are highly complex with research, development and production cycles which span an average of 30 years in the civil segment and 50 years in the military segment, contributing to the very long periods of invested capital remuneration. The extent of financial resources needed to support these processes is a barrier to entry. The aerospace industry is highly global in both its structure and outlets, exports significantly, is extremely competitive and is subject to drastic cyclical changes, especially in the civil segment. of the sector – Commercial vs. Defence. In billions of USD or as a percentage. Top 20 A&D global companies Nine months ended 09/2014 Nine months ended 09/2013 Var. % The aerospace industry. Civil aircraft and business jet Fatturato Commercial aerospace 171,6 159,4 7,7% Defense 199,1 201,6 (1,3)% Reddito operativo Commercial aerospace 17,5 15,4 13,6% Defense 20,6 19,9 3,5% 41 Deloitte. “2015 Global aerospace and defence industry outlook”. 2015. 38 The products developed are conditioned by the regulations of political, national and international institutions through independent access to the sky and space, telecommunications network control, surveillance, protection and defence In general, the aerospace manufacturing industry was reshaped after the end of the cold war, with a wave of restructuring in the various segments and, in particular, aircraft with over 100 seats, characterised by the Boeing/ Airbus duopoly, regional aircraft dominated by Bombardier and Embraer and helicopters in which a small number of OEMs operate in varying extents. 42 2,073,489 for 2012. Deloitte. “Global Aerospace & Defense Industry Financial Performance Study”. 2013. Pg. 10 Metrics. 43 Conférence FEM – “L’avenir de l’industrie aérospatiale européenne”. MAG | Annual Report 2015 On the other hand, the business jet segment is extremely dynamic and has expanded to accommodate new manufacturers, with the growing role of very light jets. 2015 will be remembered as a record year in terms of sector M&A transactions, with the total value of transactions approximating USD52 billion44. This includes, in particular, Lockheed Martin’s acquisition of Sikorsky Helicopter from United Technologies (USD 9 billion) and Berkshire Hathaway’s acquisition of Precision Castparts (USD 37.2 billion). At present, the fundamentals of the commercial segment are rather strong and encouraging, supported by low interest rates, access to loans and the decrease in operators’ management costs following favourable oil price trends. Given the instability that characterises many industrial sectors, the aerospace industry attracts investors despite intense market scrutiny. The performance of the civil aerospace industry is linked to the evolution of air transport and the reasons set out above. It shows a continuous improvement in the long term compared to the general economic trend. Indeed, compared to the average growth rate of the world economy which, in the period 2015 – 2034, is estimated at approximately 3.1%45, the estimated civil growth rate46 is equal to approximately 3.6%, with an expected aircraft demand of 38 thousand units worth about USD5,600 billion. The growth of passenger (+4.9%) and cargo (+4.7%) transport is equally high, with the RPK (Revenue Passenger Kilometer) index up by little less than 5% p.a. Civil Aircraft47 – Breakdown of demand by geographical segment in 2015 - 203448 Geographical segment Number of aircraft Percentage 14.330 37,7% Europe 7.310 19,2% North America 7.890 20,7% Middle East 3.180 8,4% Latin America 3.020 7,9% CIS48 1.150 3,0% Africa 1.170 3,1% Total 38.050 Asia Aeromobili civili - domanda di nuovi velivoli Civil Aircraft - demand for new aircraft 2015-2034 in units 2015 - 2034 in unità 8% Total cost (billions of USD) Unit cost (USD/ barrel) 2013 208 110 2014 195 100 2015 125 <80 In the short term, the increase in airline companies and operators’ productivity is a market driver, while in the long term, the main phenomena are linked to the changes underway in many regions of the world affecting transport means and characteristics. Almost 40% of the demand for new aircraft in the next twenty years will come from Asia, mainly driven by China which is set to become the largest domestic travel market, while Asian routes will hold the main share of traffic. 44 PWC. Missioncontrol. “Aerospace and Defense Industry Mergers and Acquisitions Report.” November 2015. 45 IHS Economics. “Country and Industry Forecasting”. Ed. March 2015. 46 Boeing. “Current Market Outlook 2015-2034”. Asia Asia Europe Europa 8% 38% North America Nord America Middle East Medio Oriente Latin America America Latina CIS 21% Africa CIS 19% In 2015, these parameters were particularly high (RPK: 6%, capacity +5.8%), mainly as a consequence of the improvement in the use conditions of the fleet that, during the year, benefited, in particular, from the decrease in fuel prices. Year 3%3% Africa From 1981 to 2014, the increase in the production and sale of commercial aircraft was 218%49, while the average increase50 in production over the past 20 years is approximately 87%. As mentioned earlier, income from commercial air transport doubled on the previous year thanks to the favourable conditions experienced in 2015, reaching the highest level of the past thirty years. Over the last ten years, the sector’s annual average growth rate (CAGR) approximated 7%, further confirming its outperformance of the economy. 47 Boeing. Op. cit. The data do not include business jets or light sport aircraft. 48 Commonwealth of Independent States 49 Deloitte. “Global Aerospace and Defense Industry Outlook”. October 2015. “History and forecast for large commercial aircraft orders and production (1981 to 2014)”. 50 7-year mobile average. DTTL. “Global Aerospace and Defense Industry Outlook”. Op.cit.. MAG | Annual Report 2015 39 With respect to the segmentation of turnover expected from new aircraft, 70% is still related to the single-aisle category which, at present, has a fleet of 14,100 aircraft. Business Jets and GA turboprops – Number of units and revenue in Civil Aircraft Units of Production 2015 - 2024 (% Market Share) 2015-202453 Units 16% 47% Billions of USD GA Turboprop (excluded pistons) 5.680 19,9 Very Light to Light-Medium Jets 4.134 34,1 Medium to Long-Range Jets 5.315 209,0 185 12,1 15.314 275,1 27% 6,5% 9,3%1,4% 11% Regional jets Regional jets 12,5% Single-aisle Single-aisle Small widebody Small widebody Medium widebody Medium widebody Large widebody Large widebody LargeAircraft Aircraft Large Regional RegionalAircraft Aircraft Business Jets Business Jets GA/Utility GA/Utility Corporate Airliners Total 70,2% Civil Aircraft Value of Production 2015 - 2024 (% Market Share) 4% 1% 8% As in prior years, during the economic downturn, the typical reaction of manufacturers was to increase investments and launch a series of new models. Performance discrepancies remain between the larger aircraft category (the mid-size and long-range), and so far less vibrant vitality lighter categories. Analysts estimate the sales potential54 for the next ten years at slightly less than 10 thousand aircraft, worth approximately USD255 billion or twice the amount for the previous decade. Business jet market forecast 20152015 - 2024 (units) Business jet market forecast - 2024 (unità) 300 unità 250 200 150 100 50 Veryto Light to Light-Medium Very Light Light-Medium JetsJets Corporate Airliners Airlines Corporate 7,2% 34,7% 12,4% 37,1% Regional aircraft 4.040 136,1 Business jet 9.634 255,3 GA/utility 5.680 20,0 36.277 3.084,2 Totale 51 Fonte: Forecast International, “Analysis 2. The Market for Regional Transport Aircraft”, November 2015. 40 After the negative period which went from 2009 al 2012, the business jets segment has been recovering since 2013 and is expected to consolidate in the next five years. This trend is supported by the increase in orders and the overall rise in air traffic using this type of aircraft. The next table shows the value of this market by aircraft type. 52 Source: Forecast International, “The Market for Regional Transport Aircraft. Analysis 2”, November 2015. MAG | Annual Report 2015 2024 2023 2022 2021 2020 100 75,9% 50 27,0% - GA Turboprops GA Turboprops GA Turboprops Medium Medium to to Long-Range Long-Range Jets Medium to Long-Range Jets Veryto Light to Light-Medium Light-Medium Jets Very Light to Very Light Light-Medium JetsJets CorporateAirliners Airliners Corporate Corporate Airlines Airlinee Types Airliner Types Medium Medium Light Large Large Super Mid-Size Super Mid-Size Long Range 2024 2.672,8 2019 150 2015 16.923 2017 200 2023 Large aircraft Miliardi di USD 2018 300 unità 250 4,4% 1,2% 51 Unità 2016 Business jet market forecast 2015 - 2024 (millions of US dollars) Business jet market forecast 2015 - 2024 (unità) Business Jets &Jets Business &Turboprops GA Turboprops Business Jets &GA GA Turboprops Value ofValue Production 2014 - 2023 of Production Units of Production 20142014-2023 - 2023 (%(% Market Share) (% Market Share) Market Share) 2022 Civil aircraft – Number of units and revenue in 2015 - 2024 GA Turboprops GA Turboprops Medium to Long-Range Jets Medium to Long-Range Jets Very Light In general, the group operates in this market as a supplier of landing systems for extreme categories, i.e., the largest business jets (Gulfstream) and very light jets (One Aviation). 2021 Of the two historical markets for regional aircraft, North America is the most dynamic, while Europe is affected by weaker economies and, above all, greater legislative and tax constraints, and, consequently is likely to be overtaken by Asia. 27,0% 2020 The regional segment has recently evolved with the consolidation of ETRs and Bombardiers in relation to turboprops and the withdrawal of other manufacturers from the market. Jets maintain their leading position; according to estimates, in the 2015 – 2024 decade, they account for 55.3% of the segment’s total deliveries and 74.6% of the value generated52. Medium LightLight Medium Very Light Light Light GA/Utility 2019 The table below provides a summary of civil aircraft market forecasts for 2015-2024, including business jets. Business Jets Regional Business JetsAircraft GA/Utility Large Large Super Mid-Size Super Mid-Size Long Range Medium Medium Light 2017 Consolidation by product family (components, air structures, electronics, interiors, etc.) could continue in the next few years to create economies of scale and ensure adequate investments in skills and equipment. Large Aircraft Large Aircraft Regional Aircraft Airlinee Types Airliner Types 37,1% 34,7% 2018 The second refers to the probable changes the supply chain is expected to undergo with further consolidation, given smaller companies’ difficulties in meeting the necessary investment levels. 1,2% 2016 The first envisages the entry of a new global competitor in the duopoly that has existed since 1997. This possibility is mainly linked to the technological factor, i.e., in terms of innovation with an impact on both functionality and efficiency. 87% - Business & GA Turboprops Business JetsJets & GA Turboprops of Production Units Units of Production 20142014-2023 - 2023 (% Market Share) (% Market Share) 2015 Based on the above, production levels are expected to increase by at least 20% over the next ten years, with two possible developments. Medium LightLight Medium Very Light Very Light The latter’s market is highly concentrated in North America, the largest one geographically, but that has also reached a certain level of saturation. Despite the improvement in the overall economic conditions and in companies’ profits, private parties are still reluctant to complete significant acquisitions, also given the uncertainties surrounding some aspects of the tax policies to be adopted by the government. With respect to the first category, Gulfstream has maintained its leadership position. The introduction of the G650 aircraft, for which MAG is producing most of the landing system, along with Bombardier’s Global 7000 and 8000 mo- 53 Source: Forecast International, “The Market for Business Jet Aircraft. Analysis 3”. December 2014. 54 9,634 in the 2015 - 2024 period, 2015 estimate: 893. Source: Forecast International. “The Market for Business Jets Aircraft. Analysis 3”, October 2014. Light MAG | Annual Report 2015 Light 41 dels, constituted the potential birth of a new category: ultralong-range aircraft, as the size and performance of these models significantly differs from the long-range average. Gulfstream has also completed the development of the P42 which is a substantial evolution of the G450 and which sees the collaboration of MAG group in the design and production stages for the main landing gear components. The very light jet segment was the most affected by the economic downturn and its post-crisis recovery is slower. However, the last few months of 2015 showed indications of a rebound related, in particular, to the customer One Aviation. Indeed, the latter, which is the result of the merger between Eclipse Aerospace Inc. and Kestrel Aviation Inc., has a considerable delivery portfolio of the aircraft mounting MAG E500 and E550 landing system from 2016 onwards. Trade associations, led by NBAA and GAMA, worked to counteract this adverse publicity with empirical research to highlight the economic advantages that the companies would benefit from using private jets on an on-demand basis, as a shuttle between remote production sites, or for chartering activities when utilisation is low. The helicopter industry is worth approximately USD23056 billion on a ten-year basis and consists of a limited number of manufacturers (OEMs), six of which cover roughly 54% of the market in terms of the number of aircraft and 64% in terms of revenue (Sikorsky Aircraft, Airbus Helicopters, Bell Helicopter, AgustaWestland, NH Industries and Boeing Rotorcraft Systems). Including the share held by the Russian Federation’s Russian Helicopters, the oligopoly accounts for almost 69% of the number of aircraft and nearly 84% of revenue. The issue of alternatives to air transport was covered by some studies on the top 500 S&P companies, coordinated by the above associations, which provided an exhaustive picture of private air transport and a quantification of the economic benefit for companies. According to statistics, only 22% of companies used private jets exclusively to transport top management, while 50% transported also senior or middle managers and the remaining 20% technical and sales personnel and staff. Very Light jet market forecast - 2024 (unità) market forecast 2015 - 20242015 (units) The key drivers for private transport are particularly interesting: 64% of the companies said that airline schedules were incompatible with business travel needs, 19% that private jets were necessary to reach destinations that were not served by airline operators, while a small percentage cited the need to connect to a public transport route. The diversification of private transport services offered using business jets, such as fractional ownership, air charter or jet cards, services provided by specialised companies, have spurred the growth of the sector. Analysts’ estimates are generally prudent on this point and indicate an interesting development of very-light jets over the next ten years in terms of units delivered and value. Very light Jet The evolution of the European market is negatively affected by some regulatory obstacles and tax disincentives that increase operators’ management costs. 2016 Furthermore, an important contract with the Chinese operator Jinggong General Aviation involving 20 aircraft was unveiled during the NBAA convention held in Las Vegas in November 2015. few years highlighted once again the issue surrounding the social acceptability of possessing and using this type of aircraft in a difficult social context, brought to light by politicians that did not hold back with their criticism about the privileges enjoyed by many corporations. Among the consolidated manufacturers, Airbus Helicopters and AgustaWestland substantially confirmed their market share, while the Bell Helicopter Textron group further improved its position as a result of its aircraft range renewal programme it launched some years before. Helicopter -- Big BIG77OEMs OEMs Helicopter Unitsof ofProduction Production 2015 2015 -- 2024 2024 Units (%Market MarketShare) Share) (% 8,5% The positive period that began in 2011 continued in 2015 and should last until 2020 at least, with a steady increase in orders and deliveries although some market outlets, such as the Oil & Gas applications, are facing a crisis caused by the decrease in the price of oil products and the reduction in the profits of sector companies. Despite these short to medium-term trends, the outlook remains positive and shows a consolidation trend of growth opportunities. The forecast number and revenue of the units estimated for the next ten years can be summarised as follows. 32,6% 150 100 50 2024 2023 2022 2021 2020 2019 2018 2017 2015 - The key drivers for the development of this segment are the flexibility of private transport, which is mainly business, in an increasingly international context, lack of satisfaction with commercial airlines and safety issues. In the next few years, applicable regulations could entail certain aspects, particularly in terms of emissions and the expansion of the ETS55 system or the creation of equivalent systems, causing market changes with an impact on operators’ management costs and, potentially, providing an impetus to renew existing fleets. Europe constitutes the second most important market in this category, with growing demand, in particular in Eastern Europe and Russia. Lightforecast jet market2015 forecast 2015 -(units) 2024 (milioni di USD) Very light Jet Very market - 2024 800 600 400 200 2024 2023 2022 2021 2020 2019 2018 2017 2016 2015 - Over the past 30 years, the success of the business jets industry was driven by changes in travel trends and how the public perceived these jets for business travel purposes, as an opportunity to improve logistics and, hence, productivity, rather than as a status symbol. However, the economic difficulties that marked the past From a technical/commercial point of view, the smaller size aircraft category shows some overlaps with turboprops and the helicopter segment, given the aircraft cost range (purchase and operating costs). Consequently, the less expensive jets are included in the business fleets as an alternative to turboprops (Daher-Socata TBM 900, Pilatus PC-12) or helicopters. 55 European Union (EU) Emissions Trading System (ETS). Following opposition from a number of Member States of the European Union, a tripartite agreement (European commission, European Parliament, Council of Europe) was reached in March 2014, subsequently voted on by the European parliament, restricting ETS application to flights to and from one of the 27 Member States. MAG | Annual Report 2015 Units Billions of USD Sikorsky Aircraft Corp. 1.867 40,0 Airbus Helicopters 4.256 35,9 Bell-Boeing Joint Program Office 157 11,3 AgustaWestland 1.952 25,4 Bell Helicopter Textron 2.828 18,0 Russian Helicopters 3.159 45,6 513 18,3 Other 7.125 47,9 Total 21.857 242,4 19,5% 8,9% 14,5% Sikorsky aircraft Corp. Bell-Boeing Joint Program Office Bell-Boeing Joint Program Office. Bell Helicopter Textron Inc. Boeing Rotorcraft Systems Airbus AgustaWestland Airbus Russian Helicopters All Others Sikorsky aircraft Corp. Agusta Westland Bell Helicopter Textron Inc. Russian Helicopters Boeing Rotorcraft Systems All others Helicopter - BIG 7 OEMs Value of Production 2015 - 2024 (% Market Share) 16,5% 19,8% 7,5% 14,8% 4,7% 18,8% 7,4% Boeing Rotorcraft Systems 0,7% 12,9% 2,3% Helicopters (Big 7 OEMs) – Number of units and revenue in 2015-2024 200 42 Helicopter industry redirection launched, inter alia, by Russia, technological developments and considerable investments, such as in Korea. Meanwhile, the outlet markets of the helicopter industry evolved and grew, creating the conditions for an overall development of the industry. Sikorsky aircraft Corp. Bell-Boeing Joint Program Office Bell Helicopter Textron Inc. Boeing Rotorcraft Systems 10,5% Airbus AgustaWestland Russian Helicopters All Others The market segmentation by helicopter category shows that civil aircraft will account for 73% of helicopter units and 40% of helicopter revenue over the next decade, while heavy military aircraft for defence will account for over 50% of revenue. In recent years, the share of the top six OEMs of the Western market fell slightly following the entry of some new OEMs, specifically the Russian Federation and South Korea, in addition to the business restructuring and partial 56 Source: Forecast International, “The Market for Light Commercial – Rotorcraft. Analysis 3”. November 2014 and “The Market for Medium-Heavy Commercial – Rotorcraft. Analysis 4”. March 2015. MAG | Annual Report 2015 43 Helicopters – Number of units and revenue in 2015-202457 Units Billions of USD Light civil helicopters (< 4.5 t) 11.353 30,7 Medium civil helicopters (4.5 – 8.5 t) 1.916 31,5 Heavy civil helicopters (>8.5 t) 1.728 28,8 862 7,4 Light military helicopters (< 4.5 t) Medium military helicopters (4.5 – 8.5 t) Heavy military helicopters (>8.5 t) Total 962 5.036 21.857 mand, while the utility aircraft usage accounts for between 15% and 25% and includes the offshore energy sector, currently facing a small crisis due to the decrease in the price of oil products. A geographical analysis of the light civil aircraft market shows that demand is still highly concentrated in mature economies, especially in Europe and North America, which should represent approximately 55% of the demand for the coming decade. Asia is the second most important market, with an estimated share of 15%, like that of Latin America. Both markets are growing strongly. 27,0 117,0 242,4 The most numerically significant segment, i.e., light civil helicopters, is positively related to the performance of the global economy, as confirmed by the strong recovery since the lows reached in 2010. The current forecasts indicate a growth cycle until 2020, followed by a decrease in 2021 – 2022 and a return to growth in 2023. The outlook for Asia currently reflects the closure of the Chinese market to commercial private aviation. This political factor is evolving and, as of 2016, may introduce some significant changes to future trends, boosting infrastructural investments and commercial opportunities. Recently, China’s helicopter fleets have expanded at high rates61, but from a low starting point and still only to modest revenue. The Indian and the Russian markets are potentially extremely rich, although both governments, for different reasons, adopt protectionist policies that limit the opportunities available to Western manufacturers. Helicopter Units of Production 2015 - 2024 (% Market Share) According to operators , the main driver of this market is the renewal of fleets, comprised of aircraft with many flight hours, unsuited to customers’ needs or no longer under warranty, which are replaced with models with more sophisticated avionics and more complete equipment, including in terms of flight safety. 58 23,0% 4,4% 51,9% 3,9% In general, market surveys59 indicate the following as deciding factors in selecting aircraft from the most to the least influential range, cabin size, reliability levels and safety equipment, followed by performance and brand loyalty. 7,9% 8,8% Civili leggeri (< 4,5 t) This segment is highly dependent on the economic trend of North America and Europe - that account for over 50% of its market, in addition to another 20% represented by Latin America and Asia. 57 Source: Forecast International, “The Market for Light Commercial – Rotorcraft. Analysis 3” and “The Market for Medium-Heavy Commercial – Rotorcraft. Analysis 4”, op.cit. 58 Honeywell, “Turbine-Powered Civil Purchase Outlook”, 2015. 59 Honeywell, op.cit. 60 Source: Forecast International, “The Market for Light Commercial – Rotorcraft. Analysis 3”, op.cit. 44 Civili pesanti (>8,5 t) Light military (<4.5 t) Governativi leggeri (< 4,5 t) Governativi medi (4,5 – 8,5 t) Governativi pesanti (>8,5 t) Medium Civil ( 4.5 - 8.5 t) Medium military ( 4.5 - 8.5 t) Heavy Civil ( > 8.5 t) Heavy Military ( > 8.5 t) The helicopter market breakdown by aircraft manufacturer shows a dramatic concentration, with the top three manufacturers – Airbus Helicopters, Bell Helicopter Textron and AgustaWestland – accounting for over 54% of demand for new aircraft in the next ten years, and over 68% in terms of revenue. Units Billions of USD Airbus Helicopters 3.772 27,3 Bell Helicopter Textron Inc. 2.583 12,3 AgustaWestland 1.808 22,4 Sikorsky Aircraft 650 11,0 MD Helicopters (MDHI) 210 0,5 Other 5.974 17,7 Total 14.997 91,2 MediumGovernativi military ( 4.5 pesanti (>8,5- t)8.5 t) Heavy Civil ( > 8.5 t) Heavy Military ( > 8.5 t) MAG | Annual Report 2015 AgustaWestland Bell-Agusta Aerospace Co. MD Helicopters Inc. (MDHI) All Others Eurocopter Sikorsky Aircraft Corp. Bell Helicopter Textron Inc. Bell-Agusta Aerospace Co. AgustaWestland MD Helicpoters Inc. (MDHI) All others Civil Helicopter - Big 5 OEMs Civil Helicopter - BIG 5 OEMs Value of Production 2015 - 2024 Value of Production 2015 - 2024 (% Market Share) (% Market Share) 19,5% 29,9% 12,1% Bell Helicopter Textron Inc. AgustaWestland Eurocopter Sikorsky aircraft Corp. Sikorsky Aircraft Corp. Bell Bell-Agusta Aerospace Co. Bell-Agusta Aerospace Co. All Others Textron Inc. Helicopter MD Helicopters Inc. (MDHI) MD Helicpoters Inc. (MDHI) The top three OEMs hold a dominant position mainly in the civil, light and medium helicopter segment, which is also the most competitive. They also constitute the main market for the group’s products and services, especially for the consolidated operating segments (supra Company profile). The investments made during the 20 years of life of MAG, particularly over the past ten years, were mainly aimed at increasing the commercial diversification, pursuing an increasingly balanced position vis-à-vis the various aircraft manufacturers. The MAG group is present with its products in all main civil helicopter projects (AW109, AW119, AW139, AW169, AW189, B429, B525, AH145 and AH160), and is the landing system manufacturer for six projects. Governativi leggeri (< 4,5 t) 61 20% on an annual basis in the period 2009 – 2014. The 2014 year-end fleet is estimated at 465 units. Source: Forecast International, “The Market for Light Commercial – Rotorcraft. Analysis 3”, op.cit. Bell Helicopter Textron Inc. Sikorsky Aircraft Corp. All others Civili medi (4,5 – 8,5 t) Medium Civil ( 4.5medi - 8.5 Governativi (4,5t) – 8,5 t) 0,0% 1,4% Eurocopter AgustaWestland 3,1% Light military (<4.5 t) 12,1% Eurocopter 11,1% Civili pesanti (>8,5 t) 4,3% 13,5% 11,9% Civili leggeri (< 4,5 t) 17,2% 24,6% 13,0% Light civil (< 4.5 t) 25,2% 39,8% 0,5% 0,0% 12,7% 48,3% Civil Helicopter - Big 5 OEMs Civil of Helicopter - BIG 5 OEMs Units Production 2015 - 2024 Units of Production 2015 - 2024 (%Market Market Share) (% Share) Civil helicopters – Number of units and production revenue in 2015-202463 Si tratta di un segmento di mercato che é cresciuto costantemente negli anni recenti e di cui si prevede una ulteriore crescita favorita dal lancio di nuovi modelli. Helicopter Value of Production 2015 - 2024 (% Market Share) According to analysts60, the industry for this type of helicopters should grow by approximately 5.6% year on year until 2017, followed by a more moderate 2.8% between 2018 and 2020. As mentioned earlier, starting from 2021, a physiological decrease is expected, although the time horizon is speculative. In terms of applications, because of their versatility, these aircraft are suitable for many uses. The business market accounts for approximately 31% of usage, law enforcement and EMS usage make up between 15% and 20% of de- Civili medi (4,5 – 8,5 t) Light civil (< 4.5 t) The Medium/Heavy civil aircraft segment is substantially a niche occupied by a relatively small number of models which, due to their weight, size and complexity, have fewer potential applications than light aircraft models, and are mainly used to support energy source exploration and offshore drilling platforms, as well as, to a minor extent, SAR62 activities and VIP government transport. Historically, Sikorsky, Airbus Helicopters and Russian Helicopters have been significant players in this segment, while more recently AgustaWestland and Bell Helicopter have launched new models - the AW189 and Bell 525 – which straddle the light civil and medium civil segments, like the S-92, the AS332/ EC225 and the Mil Mi-8/17 family. 62 Search and rescue. 63 Source: Forecast International, “The Market for Medium-Heavy Commercial – Rotorcraft. Analysis 4”. Op.cit. With respect to the military sector, the light aircraft segment is sluggish, after a period of interrupted growth which peaked in the five year period 2006 – 2010, doubling the value of sales due to high military spending. Consequently, as the amounts recorded in 2010 were unsustainable, the correction has generated a decline that is expected to continue through to 2023, with a small recovery in 2016.This segment is led by Airbus Helicopters and Bell Helicopter in terms of units delivered and revenue, respectively. The MAG | Annual Report 2015 45 power relations are not expected to change in the next ten years. petitive factors. The same applies to the medium-heavy helicopter segment that experienced a protracted period of growth (2005 – 2014) to subsequently stabilise and then point to a contraction phase. In this category, the weight of government spending is clearly critical and, consequently, the conclusion of the some stages of military campaigns, above all Afghanistan and Iraq, as well as the budget limitations imposed by political changes in this respect, played a very important role. This segment includes almost all the leading manufacturers with important aircraft: AgustaWestland with the AW101 and the CH47, manufactured in partnership with Boeing (the latter is present with the V-22, a convertiplane manufactured for the Marines and the US military forces), Airbus Helicopters with the AH/EC725 and Sikorsky with the Black Hawk H-60 series. Governmental Helicopters 8 OEMs Governmental Helos - BIG- Big 8 OEMs Units Production 2015 Units ofofProduction 2015- 2024 - 2024 (% Market Share) (%Market Share) 18,0% 2,3% 4,7% 4,6% Eurocopter AgustaWestland BellNH Helicopter Textron Inc. Industries SARL Bell-Boeing All OthersJoint Program office NH Industries SARL Boeing Rotorcraft systems Korea Aerospace Industries Boeing Rotorcraft systems Korea Aerospace Industries 19,2% 36,7% 29,0 484 8,7 157 11,3 AgustaWestland 144 3,2 Bell Helicopter Textron 245 5,7 NH Industries 322 13,6 Boeing Rotorcraft Systems 513 18,3 Korean Aerospace Industries 313 6,1 Other 3.446 55,6 Total 6.860 151,5 MAG Group’s inclusion in military development projects is currently limited to variations of civil models with a small market share (approximately 10% of the total) and the Korean Utility Helicopter, built by KAI (Korea Aerospace Industries), on which production began in 2012, with approximately 260 helicopters expected to be built. Access to military development projects is characterised by restrictions, which typically consist of regional subsidy policies and strict regulations (ITAR), which represent com64 Source: Forecast International, “The Market for Light Military – Rotorcraft 2015 - 2024”, November 2014 and “The Market for Medium-Heavy Military – Rotorcraft 2015 - 2024”. April 2015. Outout / Outcome 5,7% 7,4% 12,1% 9,0% Sikorsky Aircraft Corp. AgustaWestland Boeing Rotorcraft systems Eurocopter Korea Industries BellAerospace Helicopter Textron All Others strenghening Eurocopter Program office SikorskyBell-Boeing AircraftJoint Corp. Bell Helicopter Textron Inc. brand recognition and 2,1% 3,8% increased commercial and AgustaWestland NH Industries SARL Inc. Bell-Boeing Joint Program office NH Industries SARL Boeing Rotorcraft systems Korea Aerospace Industries All Others Strategies and strategic positioning geographical diversification remuneration of stakeholders larger international presence Integration of the product and customer satisfaction and sound service offer reputation continuous product and process techynological competitive innovation advantages more efficient operating model General directives optimisation of financial stability technological change valuing high-profile internal infrastructural developments behavioural developments macroeconomic context external context 1.236 value creation matrix creation of value Billions of USD ◊ consolidating MAG’s reputation as a reliable industrial aerospace group with a solid range of products and services. Customers are at the heart of every initiative in this strategy; ◊ strengthening the group’s presence in its market segments, not only by growing in size but also by focusing on the essential processes of its core business, with the aim of acquiring a leadership position; ◊ increasing its diversification, with an increasingly international presence on the relevant advanced or emerging markets, by entering new geographical areas (Asia) and expanding its presence in the training equipment and business jet segments; ◊ strengthening its operating model, pursuing greater efficiency and process/structure integration. This scope also includes projects involving human resources, management incentives and striving to balance individual results with those of the entire group; ◊ optimising equity soundness, while maintaining a balance of sources and applications of funds, in order to strengthen capital, profits and cash flows. Governmental Helicopters - Big 8 OEMs Governmental Helos - BIG 8 OEMs ValueValue of Production 2015 - 2024 of Production 2015 - 2024 (% Market Share) Share) (%Market 4,0% Bell-Boeing Joint Program office 46 AgustaWestland All Others eight OEMs)64 Airbus Helicopters 3,6% Eurocopter Bell Helicopter Textron Inc. Military helicopters – Number of units and revenue in 2015-2024 (top Sikorsky Aircraft 2,1% 7,5% Sikorsky Aircraft Corp. Sikorsky Aircraft Corp. Bell-Boeing Joint Program office Segment reporting); strengthening its capital and managing it with discipline; consolidating relationships with customers and retaining them; expanding its customer base in its market segment and consequently diversifying its portfolio and the related risks; projects of technical excellence, both in terms of applied research grants and the development of new products; projects to develop the brand and increase brand recognition. Consequently, the fundamental elements of this strategy consist of 7,1% 50,2% The presence of OEMs from emerging countries, such Korea Aerospace Industries (KAI), or the Russian Federation (Russian Helicopters) is increasingly stronger. According to analysts, the latter is expected to lead the market over the next ten years with over 2,171 aircraft and a market share of 40.9%. Units ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ socio-political scenarios resources workplace diversity and legal-legislative context MAG has developed its strategy for the next five years with a focus on exploiting growth opportunities and enhancing the group. The strategy is based on the priority values (see Mission & Values) that motivate us to improve and consolidate our strengths and reduce our limitations and weaknesses. Business strategies and positioning. The strategic plan In general, the group’s goal is to structure its approach and organisation in order to make the most of its tangible and intangible assets in the interests of all stakeholders and achieve satisfactory profitability levels through discipline, simplicity and a focus on: The MAG group has charted its course in the light of the above, substantially combining the experience of historic aerospace companies, such as SIAI, which celebrates its anniversary, and Agusta and Nardi in the helicopter segment. This vision entailed significant investments in product innovation, initially as part of strategic partnerships (e.g., UTAS) and then individually, after consolidating skills and reputation. ◊ its core business, which it has accurately identified for each operating segment (see Company profile and Note esplicative al bilancio consolidato, 3.4 MAG’s business project re-interprets the values set 20 years ago in a modern way and with a focus on components, progressively developing a range of products (systems) and In recent years, this activity encompassed applied research grants, with institutional partners (e.g., universities and private research centres), necessary to increase the skills in MAG | Annual Report 2015 opportunities activities (services) to be offered to aircraft OEMs, integrating technologies and systems on which its signature and competitive edge is based. MAG | Annual Report 2015 47 Ownership status Customer diversification & Product Development New AW109 servo actuator Hanwa LAV LS AW101 VIP INAER H145 EMS MAKE TO DESIGN AW139 FCS Bell 525 CCS Bell 429 CCS VIP AW139 CCS TAI Hurkus LS AirGreen H145 EMS AA M345 LS AW119 LS (skid) AW139 LS AW109 CCS Bell 525 LS AH160 CCS H145 CCS VIP AW109 LS Bell 505 FCS & servo actuation Hanwha KUH FCS AW169 FCS AH160 LS Bell 429 LS Eclipse E550 LS AW189 CCS NH500 AS AH160 FCS UTC A380 LS BUILD TO PRINT Piaggio P180 FCS AW129 FCS AB412 AS Finmeccanica Airbus Helicopters Bell Helicopter United Technologies Others UTC P42 LS UTC G IV-V LS UTC G650 LS AW109 FCS AW119 FCS MATURITY AW101 FCS FULL PRODUCTION LS FCS CCS VIP EMS Landing Sys Flight Control Sys Cabin Comfort Sys VIP Interior Emergency Medical System AW189 FCS EARLY PHASE PRODUCTION TO BE STARTED Product life phase related segments. The group’s strategies since it took its current form are significantly informed by innovation as a core principle, as the group strives for innovation as a means proportionate to its size and potential, while also pursuing all tangible opportunities (see Sustainable innovation and infra Development of new products). From a strategic and market positioning point of view, a first evolutionary phase can be identified which developed entirely in the helicopter elective segment, to subsequently extend to trainers, business jets and UAVs. More recently, a second phase generated a more precise identification of business strategic affairs (BSA), based on which the organisational, operational and management sectors that constitute an operating segment were designed and built. The first area coincides with the Integrated Aircraft Systems segment, described earlier, which today combines the whole range of systems, being the safety-critical parts of the ALS division (landing systems, flight control systems, hydraulic systems, etc.) and the interior components of the Cabin comfort division (liners, cabinet, infotainment systems, etc.), which both serve the OEM market. Percentage wise, the group’s systems account on average for 10% of the aircraft sale price, in addition to maintenance activities that may reach a further 15%. In the short term, the group’s objectives were aimed at expanding its market penetration with the implementation of the following cross selling commercial strategies: ◊ business strategies, i.e., targeting OEMs that belonged to the same group as the customers already served, ◊ product/service strategies, i.e., integrating the supply to the same customer with other products or services that are part of the same portfolio. These strategies, including as part of organic growth, strengthened or accelerated the diversification actions that constitute a priority. At the reporting date, the weight of the main customer (Finmeccanica group) decreased by almost 10% on 2013/14 and is expected to fall below 50% over the fiveyear business plan. MAG Group program (2015 - 2024) The second area (Aircraft Services) refers to the supply of aircraft services that the group is already able to provide as part of a series of existing skills (e.g., MRO, aircraft completion, refurbishment, etc.) which, however, can be further extended or developed, and with a potentially interesting market outlet which, in turn, can also be extended from helicopters to fixed-wing aircraft. With respect to the market, this strategic area can be mainly identified in operators and end customers. Rotary Wing Programs Fixed Wing Programs MAG group ASA (2016 - 2020) Integrated Aircraft Systems Aircraft Services In the first case, the driver of the potential size of these markets relates to the demand for new aircraft of the reference segment, including that of the regional aircraft that the group intends to penetrate in the near future. This segment is estimated at approximately USD 80 billion, of which USD10 billion refers to commercial helicopters. Suppliers Commercial and relationships Integration, quality Financial community Financial Profitability, financial soundness Public administration and institutions Infrastructures and relationships Consensus, distribution of wealth Community and the local area Natural and environmental Innovation, reducing consumption Technological community Technological Innovation, reducing consumption Many of the investments made, not only in technologies, although they are certainly the most voluminous, cannot yet be perceived in terms of current activities, but are an essential factor in consolidating MAG’s position and ensuring business continuity over time. Key Business Plan Guidelines In 2015, the Company has refined its corporate strategy, which had already been laid out in the previous years. Through the 2016 – 2020 business plan, the Company will implement such strategy. Key business guidelines of the plan are: ◊ By 2020, exclusively through organic growth, we plan to reach €200M in Sales, with an international footprint and a diversified Customer Base (none of our Customers will have a dominant position). These goals will be achieved also thanks to the new contracts that have been awarded in the recent past and are now in a development phase. As soon as production will start, such new contracts will provide high revenues for many years - in 2020 these contracts will return additional sales for €80M - thus supporting future growth. ◊ MAG new development initiatives will be mainly focused on: The group’s growth process is therefore based on development objectives in accordance with defined priorities. These objectives are based on the essential elements underpinning its strategies. As such, its growth does not relate solely to volumes. It includes a series of actions aimed at increasing value, as defined in previous sections of this report (e.g., Economic value and stakeholders) and, accordingly, considering the perspective of the various stakeholders. Stakeholder Type of capital Objective Human resources (employees and workers) Human and organisational Employment, value and climate Shareholders Financial Profitability, financial solidity Customers Commercial and relationships Reputation, satisfaction helicopter, trainer and VLJ new programs. We will be increasingly offering to our Customers electromechanical retraction actuation systems, in line with today’s “more electric and greener” market trends. ◊ Flight Control Systems activities will be focused on hydraulic and electro-mechanical actuation for both rotor wing and fixed wing platforms through the development of new primary and secondary flight control actuators and servo-actuators. MAG will exploit more and more its various experiences, which already allowed the company to win different contracts in the recent past. ◊ Cabin Comfort will continue its path of growth through the development and the acquisition of new competences and technologies in order to further improve cabin comfort control and performances in terms of noise and vibration reduction, environmental control and cabin management. Especially concerning VIP mission configurations, the capabilities of our Design Studio will be an essential key to success. A) strengthening Aircraft Services Strategic Business Unit, especially in North America, B) increasing the Company’s role in the fixed wing market segment, allowing us to double fixed wing related-sales between 2015 and 2020. This will lay the foundations to increase fixed wing sales significantly during the following five years. In detail, the main key aspects for this strategy will be: A) stems Strategic Business Unit Integrated Aircraft Sy- ◊ Landing Systems business line – which today is already focused mainly on fixed wing aircraft applications – will continue to grow thanks to the longterm strategic cooperation with UTAS, and thanks to the beginning of the production phase of several B) Aircraft Services Strategic Business Unit In addition to strengthening our presence in North America, which will be the main development driver for the next five years, we will try penetrate the fixed wing market by leveraging our cabin comfort competences, as we did successfully on rotor wing aircraft. In synergy with our OEM Customers, we will offer our services to End Users, completing the range of our mission customization solutions. In this context, the Aircraft Refurbishment market segment will offer interesting opportunities in the years to come. During the five-year plan, margins are expected to grow, not only because of the increase in volumes, but also as a result of MAG efficiency improvement activities which were launched a couple of years ago and have seen: layout reorganization of plants, investments in new machinery and in IT Systems, training of people that have been heavily involved in lean manufacturing activities. MAG growth and development will also be supported by the Company’s Merger & Acquisition Plan, which represents a potential upside of the Business Plan, yet not being part of it. Target Companies’ profile is obviously in line with the above-indicated strategies, such as, for example, the further development of Aircraft Services activities in North America. MAG growth through acquisitions will depend on the amount of external funds to which we will have access. This, combined with our current competences and capabilities, as well as our diversified portfolio, which includes four business lines, may notably allow us to reach a significant size and visibility in the International Market. MAG | Annual Report 2015 51 Corporate governance and business conduct Governance is the term used since the Middle Ages65 to indicate the rules of conduct for an individual, family, political system or even the cosmic relationship between god and nature. Over the centuries, a principle has arisen with respect to the separation of running a business from its strategic and control guidelines, with an increasingly clear and elaborate definition, generally in the aftermath of large scandals, from the mercantile companies of the 17th century66 to the Enron scandal67. It has, in this way, become a set of legislative and internal rules, relationships, processes, systems and responsibilities to be followed not only in the pursuit of the organisation’s objectives but also in the methods used to achieve them. implement a single model, as conceived by Jaeger70 which includes ◊ the identification of shared targets and strategic plans for the individual group companies; ◊ the preparation of annual budgets for the group and the individual companies; ◊ the implementation of forecast and control models; ◊ ongoing updates of the group’s organisational structure. Each of these components has been approved by the relevant corporate bodies. The parent is responsible for defining and checking strategic matters and policies concerning the divisions of the various group businesses. The growing complexity of companies and the contexts in which they operate has led to the development of different approaches and frequently created excessive regulations surrounding the debate whether corporate governance should or should not be essentially by rule (as in the case of the SOX69 Act) or by principle (the UK system of comply or explain). This debate continues, demonstrating how the issue has not been resolved with a system of rules, as necessary as they are, but is deeply rooted in the company culture. We are convinced that it is through cultural entrenchment that terms like “transparency” and “integrity” resound in organisations and are effectively implemented. Single business model From a more strictly legal/corporate standpoint, MAG has adopted an organisational model, entailing management and coordination among the various entities, to pursue and 65 Geoffrey Chaucer, “The Canterbury Tales” (1380), “Fragment VI”. 66 South Sea Company, 1720, insider trading by King George I’s chancellor. 67 Enron Corp. 2001 bankruptcy declared in the United States Bankruptcy Court. 68 A. Smith, “The Wealth of Nations”, 1776, “The directors of companies, being managers of other people’s money rather than their own, cannot well be expected to watch over it with the same anxious vigilance with which they watch over their own”. 69 Paul Sarbanes – Mike Oxley, Public Company Accounting Reform and Investor Protection Act, 2002. 52 The internal control system is comprised of a series of rules, procedures and organisational structures aimed at ensuring compliance with company strategies and the achievement of the following objectives: ◊ the effectiveness and efficiency of company processes, ◊ safeguarding the value of assets and protection against losses, ◊ the reliability and integrity of financial information; ◊ compliance with applicable legislation, plans and internal procedures. As part of its management and coordination activities, MAG: The management and control model MAG’s governance model is traditional, i.e., it features: The engine behind this development can be summarised in the words of Adam Smith68. Prudent management of others’ interests cannot come spontaneously to management, whereas the primary result is, undoubtedly, the segregation of duties, in which roles are assigned to separate parties to reduce or limit conflicts of interest, in conjunction with a series of controls that are as independent as possible. Other elements of the internal control system ◊ shareholders’ meetings, held as ordinary and extraordinary meetings and called to pass resolutions in accordance with the law and by-laws; ◊ the board of directors, appointed to perform administration and company management; ◊ the board of statutory auditors, required to oversee: (i) compliance with the law and deed of incorporation and with the principles of correct administration in the performance of company activities; (ii) the adequacy of the company’s organisational system, the internal control system and the administration/accounting system, (iii) the ways in which corporate governance is actually implemented, (iv) risk management, (v) the legally-required audit and the independent auditors’ independence. MAG has opted to adopt a traditional administrative and control model, as it is the most prevalent in the group’s history and more in line with its business context than other alternative models based on other systems. The company has voluntarily adopted a system of criteria and principles that integrate its administration and control system, based on the code of conduct that Borsa Italiana S.p.A. wrote in 2011 for listed companies71. During the year, this process entailed an amendment of the document describing Corporate governance, appointing a manager for financial reporting, an investor relator and identifying the lead independent director within the board of directors. 70 Rozenblum Doctrine. Pier Giusto Jaeger, “L’interesse sociale” Giuffré, 1964. “L’interesse sociale tra valorizzazione del capitale e protezione degli Stakeholders. In ricordo di Pier Giusto Jaeger”. Quaderni di Giurusprudenza Commerciale. Giuffré, 2010 71 Code of conduct approved by the Committee for Corporate Governance in March 2006, modified in March 2010 by replacing article 7 (now article 6) and subsequently updated in December 2011, July 2014 and July 2015. MAG | Annual Report 2015 ◊ checks the strategic development of the various areas in which the group’s operates (see Strategies and strategic positioning); ◊ conducts a management control to ensure that a balance is maintained, particularly with respect to the profitability indicators and the financial balance of both the individual companies and the group as a whole (see Group performance); ◊ performs an operating check to evaluate each entity’s different risk profile through risk management activities (see Risk management and compliance) In compliance with the provisions of the code of conduct on which the company has based its policies, the administrative and control model is integrated with: On 31 March 2015, as part of a reorganisation, the shares held by IMI Investimenti S.p.A., accounting for 16.42% of share capital, were transferred to Melville S.r.l. which is part of the US Neuberger Berman group. The latter operates in private asset management sector. There were no other changes in the ownership structure in 2014/2015 or after the reporting date. Shareholder Number of shares Percentage of share capital S.B.I. S.p.A. 7.931.242 60,37% Melville S.r.l. 2.157.345 16,42% 91.481 0,70% 2.957.932 22,51% 13.138.000 100,00% Private Equity Partners S.p.A. Private Equity Partners SGR S.p.A. Total MAG Shareholders at 30/09/2015 (% share capital) Melville S.r.l. Private Equity Partners S.p.A. S.B.I. S.p.A. Private Equity Partners SGR S.p.A. MAG Shareholders at 30/09/2015 (% share capital) committees set up within the board of directors to renew company bodies, with responsibility for making proposals and recommendations on specific issues without decisionmaking power, such as the executive committee (strategic committee72) and the appointment and remuneration committee; c)the internal auditor, responsible for an audit plan to check that the internal control and risk management system is functional and adequate. Finally, the group’s administrative and control model includes the Supervisory Body, which was set up following the group’s adoption of the organisational and management model pursuant to Legislative decree no. 231/2001, whose functions, since 25 March 2013, are entrusted to the board of statutory auditors, as permitted by Law no. 183/2011. Shareholders MAG’s shares are owned by private and institutional investors at 30 September 2015, as shown in the table below. 72 On 21 September 2015, in their extraordinary meeting, the shareholders amended the by-laws, eliminating the provision whereby the executive committee is a delegated collective body. On the same date, the board of directors appointed a strategic committee. The board of directors The current board of directors was appointed on 25 March 2013 in its present configuration of seven members and will remain in office until the approval of the financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015. The board of directors met 17 times in 2014/2015 and was fully attended. The statutory auditors attended the meetings, along with, on certain occasions, a few MAG managers who were asked to report on specific issues on the agenda. BOARD OF DIRECTORS [number of meetings during the year: 17] MAG | Annual Report 2015 53 position member code Chairman Alberto Ribolla executive Managing Director Claudio Brun executive Deputy Chairman Corrado Monti executive Deputy Chairman Valter Pasqua executive Director Ruggero Manciati non-executive and independent Director Emanuele Vignoli non-executive Director Enrico Ricotta non-executive and independent Consiglieri per fascia di età 14% 29% 35 - 50 35 - 50 5050-- 60 60 Over 60 Oltre 60 Composizione del Consiglio Amministrazione Composition of thedi board of directors 29% 38% 14% 32% 57% 30% MAG MAG Media Assonime Assonime average Amm. Non esecutivi ed Executive directors Indipendenti Non-executive ordinary direcgors Amm. Non and esecutivi "semplici" No-executive and independent directors Amm.esecutivi 9,30% 9,30% 41,86% 27,91% 11,63% Strategic plans and SISTEMA DIand GOVERNANCE E ASSETTO Governance system ORGANIZZATIVO budget, ordinary and organisational structure extraordinary finance Resolutions and transaction DELIBERE E INFORMATIVE SU ANDAMENTO information about GESTIONE E DOCUMENTIManagement CONTABILI of performance and periodic PERIODICI litigation and accounting reporting PIANI STRATEGICI E BUDGET, OPERAZIONI remuneration DI FINANZA ORDINARIA E STRAORDINARIA Other Directors by age bracket 57% BoD’s resolutions by topic Distribuzione delibere Cda per argomento GESTIONE CONTROVERSIE, REMUNERAZIONI The board of directors carried out an in itinere assessment ALTRO of the adequacy of its and its committees’ size, composition and functioning, which showed that: ◊ the board of directors’ size (seven members, falling within the by-laws’ provision requiring from five to nine members) is adequate, considering the business size and type; ◊ considering that the board of directors consists of four executive directors experienced in business management and three non-executive directors with different expertise, two of whom are independent, its composition is adequate; ◊ the board’s functioning and that of its committees, illustrated in the tables below, ◊ is consistent with the company’s size and type of activities and with the duties assigned to the Chairman and Managing director. Constantly referring to corporate governance best practices, the board has decided, within the scope of its duties and powers and within the limits of the by-laws, to: ◊ accurately define the role of the Chairman of the board of directors and distinguish the duties, assignments and powers of this role from those of the bodies appointed to manage business, specifying the contents, limits and methods of the assigned powers; expand the role of the independent directors, as they are defined in the aforementioned code of conduct and relevant doctrine73, who have “no relationships with management or the company that would compromise their independent judgement”, ensuring that “any (potential) conflict of interest is adequately handled”. This process was completed in July 2015 with the appointment of a lead independent auditor within the board of directors. 73 Code of Conduct of Borsa Italiana (cited) and “Internal controls in listed companies” Consob (Italian commission for listed companies and the stock exchange), Legal notes no. 4 – September 2012, EU Commission recommendations no. 162 of 15 February 2005, “Role of directors without executive duties or members of the supervisory body in listed companies and members of committees of the board of directors or supervisory body”. 54 MAG | Annual Report 2015 The executive committee (strategic committee) On 6 October 2014, pursuant to article 18 of the by-laws, MAG included an executive committee in its governance model, which was set up within the board of directors to create a closer link between the management structure and the board of directors. As part of the ongoing evolution of corporate governance, considering the Committee’s significant function of strategic guidance, the model was updated by amending some articles of the by-laws. Accordingly, in their extraordinary meeting of 21 September 2015, the shareholders amended the by-laws, introducing the role of manager for financial reporting (see) and eliminating the executive committee as a delegated collective body. On the same date, the board of directors set up the strategic committee, comprised of the same members as the former executive committee. During the year, the executive committee met nine times. The meetings were attended by all its members. The strategic committee met once. EXECUTIVE COMMITTEE [number of meetings during the year: 9] STRATEGIC COMMITTEE [number of meetings during the year: 1] Member Code Alberto Ribolla executive Claudio Brun executive Corrado Monti executive Valter Pasqua executive lating to development projects worth over Euro 40 million in total; ◊ approval of fast-track investments in property, plant and equipment and intangible assets entailing changes in the approved budget with subsequent reporting to the board of directors and approval of the purchase agreements for goods and services exceeding budget figures by over Euro 100 thousand; ◊ approval of the system risk monitoring plan and checking that preventive measures and planned corrective actions are implemented. This committee is in place and was set up within the board of directors for a useful and necessary purpose, i.e., to create a structured, organic process for the definition of the business mission and to encourage the implementation of its ethics in the strategic plan (see The stakeholders paradigm). Furthermore, having a body that liaises with company management increases the opportunities to report the repercussions that the main strategic decisions have on relationships with stakeholders. As noted earlier (see Strategies and strategic positioning), for MAG, the strategic plan not only serves as a guide for strategic decisions, but is also a tool for communications with stakeholders. The appointment and remuneration committee On 25 March 2013, the board of directors appointed an appointment and remuneration committee and assigned it the duties provided for by the code and those previously assigned to the remuneration committee. The appointment and remuneration committee, set up within the board of directors, carrying on from the remuneration committee, consists of three members, including two non-executive members. The executive committee (strategic) is chaired by the deputy chairman74 and is composed of three other members of the board of directors. The committee meets once a month to discuss the following topics, as delegated by the board of directors: During the year, the committee met three times and was fully attended. At the reporting date, the committee was comprised as shown below75. REMUNERATION AND APPOINTMENT COMMITTEE [number of meetings during the year: 3] ◊ preliminary approval of the parent’s and group’s draft medium-term business plan and the annual budget, which will then be submitted for the definitive approval of the board of directors, and monitoring that they are properly implemented on a monthly basis; ◊ preparation of development projects for new market penetration and the pursuit of strategic opportunities; ◊ approval of binding bids for long-term contracts re74 Alberto Ribolla, formerly deputy chairman of the board of directors until 16 July 2015, replaced by Valter Pasqua. Member Code Emanuele Vignoli non-executive Valter Pasqua Executive Ruggero Manciati non-executive and independent 75 Until 16 July 2015, the composition was unchanged from the previous year (A. Rubolla – Chairman, M. Boschini, R. Manciati). MAG | Annual Report 2015 55 Manager for financial reporting In their extraordinary meeting of 21 September 2015, the shareholders amended the by-laws, introducing the role of manager for financial reporting in accordance with Legislative decree no. 262/2005 and approving the related Regulation. The by-laws amendment completes the voluntary adjustment of the company’s governance and alignment to the best practices applicable to companies whose shares are traded on regulated markets. The appointment of a manager for financial reporting is part of a project for the implementation of a compliance model pursuant to Legislative decree no. 262/2005 and related provisions76, which will substantially start in 2015/2016. The board of statutory auditors The board of statutory auditors was appointed on 27 December 2013 with the same composition as the previous three-year term. It will remain in office until the approval of the financial statements as at and for the year ending 30 September 2016. ment. The assessment was based on information provided by and with the support of internal committees, with the assistance of the parent’s management. As mentioned above, since 25 March 2013, the board of statutory auditors also performs the Supervisory Body’s duties, as provided for by the administrative and control model pursuant to Legislative decree no. 231/2001. Internal audit With its resolution of 25 March 2013, the shareholders appointed an independent expert - Sergio Lamonica - to handle internal audit for the 2012/2013-2014/2015 threeyear period. The Internal Auditor is responsible for checking that the internal control and risk management system is functional and adequate. He reports to the board of directors and is not responsible for any operating areas. His term of office is that with which the board appointed him. During the year, the Internal Auditor performed nine audits of the group companies and prepared the same number of audit reports. Risk assessment The group is exposed to a variety of risks due to the nature and type of its business activities and the context in which it operates. In addition to that described in the notes to the consolidated financial statements with respect to the technical and strategic management of financial risks (see 5.3 Financial risk management), the group companies’ risk management policies are based on containing and monitoring the main risk factors. Over the past few years, the group has progressively embraced risk assessment and risk management concepts to create and subsequently follow a structured risk identification, measurement and management process. During its meeting of 30 March 2012, the board of directors of the parent, MAG, established the position of Chief Risk Officer (CRO) for the first time and assigned the role to the Deputy Chairman, confirming the appointment and powers when it renewed his office on 25 March 2013. The CRO’s work plan involves the implementation of a complex risk assessment process, which entails the assessment of risks with the involvement of top managers and company bodies in their respective areas of expertise. This process has led to, inter alia, the preparation of a risk management operating manual in accordance with UNI ISO 31000 standards, containing the guidelines for risk identification, probability and impact assessment, corrective measures to eliminate risks and risk mitigation, transfer and retention, in accordance with UNI ISO 31000 and CEI EN 31010 standards. Foremost, the assessment of risks to which the group is effectively exposed has led to their identification and mapping by nature and type, as illustrated in a chart further on. BOARD OF STATUTORY AUDITORS [number of meetings during the year: 3] Risk management and compliance Position Member Chairman Rocco di Leo Standing statutory auditor Luisa Marzoli Standing statutory auditor Guido Riccardi Alternate statutory auditor Daniela Caminiti Alternate statutory auditor Giovanni Tedeschi Information flows pursuant to Legislative Decree No. 262/2005 The CRO monitors that the procedure is followed through routine follow-ups and by specifically monitoring planned and agreed risk mitigation activities. MAG’s administrative and control system is based on periodic and systematic flows of information between the various bodies. These flows are managed using reporting systems aligned to group principles and standards, based on high-tech, integrated ERP data input systems and individual accounting systems for each of the consolidated investees. During the year, the board of statutory auditors met four times. Average attendance of its members was 89%. The statutory auditors’ duties extend past conducting checks and participating in periodic meetings required by law to their involvement in the meetings of the board of directors and the meetings held twice a year with the independent auditors. Over the years, the board of statutory auditors has checked the suitability of Mecaer aviation Group S.p.A.’s and its strategic subsidiaries’ organisational, administrative and accounting structures, with specific reference to internal controls, risk management and conflict of interest manage76 Legislative decree no. 303/2006, Legislative decree no. 195/2007, Legislative decree no. 58/1998 (Consolidated finance act). 56 Accordingly, the group has identified respective risk owners to whom it has individually presented the risk management plan, along with the operating manual and it has identified the potential risks that fall into their areas of expertise, introducing a procedure in which risk reporting forms are filled out and the risk register is updated. In accordance with the respective deadlines and methods established in the by-laws, corporate governance model and other internal documents, such as procedures and instructions, each body reports to its superior body on the activities it has performed in the reporting period and those that it has planned for the subsequent period, along with any observations and recommended steps. In this area, MAG has voluntarily implemented an integrated compliance model that meets the principles of Legislative decree no. 262/2005, which is expected to be launched in 2015/2016, where the appointment of a manager responsible for financial reporting plays a complementary and functional role (see Manager for financial reporting). In the future, this model will entail changes to the by-laws and integrations to the governance model in order to make the integrated compliance model fully effective. MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 57 Risk map Below is a summary of the group’s main risks, which were identified during the risk assessment processes, along with the measures or policies that the group pursues to monitor risk factors and mitigate them. . Risk Risk management actions The general economic crisis has influenced the budgets of the public administrations and the relevant sector in general, which could reduce the group’s profitability and its ability to generate cash. The group has taken measures to boost production efficiency and perform contracts according to schedule, while at the same time striving to contain overheads and maintain adequate investment levels. It carefully vets investments through the scrupulous evaluation of potential returns and whether they are strategic, in order to keep its competitive edge in both the current situation and the long term. For certain business lines dedicated to institutional customers (AS division), the group relies on the spending of national governments and public institutions, which could be further cut as a result of the financial crisis. The group continues to take direct steps to increase the expertise of internal personnel dedicated to these types of activities, which require high levels of specialisation and specific certification, so as to expand the range of aircraft and activities they cover. This increase in its potential offer enables the group to participate in a larger number of public tenders. The group is highly dependent on sales to companies that belong to the same group (concentration). For some time, the group has launched plans to achieve a greater degree of customer and market diversification in the medium-term. These plans are part of a significant and targeted investment policy, which focuses in particular on the development of new products. This policy has enabled it to acquire important new contracts in recent years. The group’s contracts are mainly of a long-term nature with established prices, which affect profit margins in the long term. The group has a structured, agreed and formalised process for quoting product and contract costs. Its internal control system provides for a review of estimated contract costs on a systematic basis. These procedures entail the monitoring of significant risks, which are identified from when the bid is made, throughout the project, including through the constant comparison of the actual progress of the project and its stage of completion in the accounting records. These analyses involve top management, the program managers and the technical, engineering, manufacturing, production and administration departments. The results are weighted in the calculation of the necessary costs to project completion at least once a year. As part of its continuing operations, the group is exposed to liability risks with its customers or related third parties. The more significant obligations include ensuring suitable aftersales support, including through dedicated logistical-industrial structures. The group’s organisational structure is divided into divisions, in order to better focus on customers, establishing, in subsequent stages, a project management function within the divisions. In this context, a product support structure may be created with a dedicated division. The group negotiates and agrees insurance policies on the market for individual projects/products to cover any damage. The group conducts a risk assessment each year to identify maximum insured amounts and terms that best meet its risk levels. The agreed policies also sufficiently meet the coverage levels required by customers for contracts in place. Given the rigidity of its industry, the group faces the risk of having single source strategic suppliers, whose performance can affect the continuity of projects (business interruption risk). The group reduces this risk through processes that, with increasing structuring, ensure: - careful selection and monitoring of the supply chain to achieve high levels of integration; - availability of double source strategic sub-supplies, where possible. 58 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Risk Risk management actions The group’s debt could affect its operating strategies. The group monitors developments in its financial debt on a daily basis, in both Italy and for its foreign operations. Its financial strategy consists of maintaining a balance between the sources and application of funds, particularly with respect to the weight of consolidated debt against investments carried out. In 2014/2015, the group contained its financial debt, despite substantial investments to develop and produce new products. The group also constantly monitors the interest rates of its loans. The internal control system provides for short-term and mediumterm financial planning activities. Based on expected cash generation, credit lines in place and the positive outcome of all financial transactions to date, the group believes that it will have the necessary resources to meet all its obligations. The group generates part of its revenue in currencies other than those in which it incurs its costs. Accordingly, it is exposed to currency risk. Part of consolidated assets are in US and Canadian dollars. The group continuously applies a currency risk hedging policy by aligning revenue in non-Euro currencies to purchases on markets outside the Eurozone. The group seeks ways to balance cash holdings and cash requirements in the various foreign currencies among the companies operating in the different regions, always in compliance with fair value rules. In the short-term, volatility on currency markets could lead to exchange rate differences. As the volumes of flows in non-Euro currencies rise, the group intends to agree short-term hedges. The group operates on complex markets, in which the settlement of potential disputes could be complicated and take a long time. Furthermore, the group is exposed to environmental risks due to its various industrial plant. The group regularly monitors pending and potential disputes, taking the necessary corrective action and adjusting its provision for risks on a periodic basis. With respect to environmental risks, the group has a prevention and ongoing monitoring programme in place, as well as insurance coverage in one specific case, in order to mitigate the consequences of a polluting event. The group operates on particularly complex markets, which require compliance with specific regulations. Through specific external structures, the group monitors constant updates to relevant regulations, subjecting the launch of business projects to checks of compliance with restrictions and the obtaining of the necessary authorisations. A significant portion of consolidated assets is intangible, particularly development costs for new products. The group constantly monitors the progress of projects, taking necessary corrective measures whenever there are unfavourable trends. These updates influence estimated flows used for impairment testing of amounts recognised in the consolidated financial statements. The group’s success also depends on the ability of its executive directors and other members of management to effectively manage it and its individual business segments. The group’s human resource management policies facilitate the identification of objectives, the medium-term appreciation of skills and the maintenance of the corporate climate. Through appropriate structures (the remuneration committee), the group is implementing a management by objectives strategy to complement its key management personnel incentive policies. The notes to the consolidated and separate financial statements provide disclosures about disputes and contingent liabilities. The assessment of contingent liabilities of a legal and tax nature, which requires the use of estimates and assumptions, shows the costs that the directors, based on the opinion of the group’s consultants, reasonably estimate the group will incur. MAG | Annual Report 2015 59 Legal compliance Fiscal governance The group is pursuing a plan to gradually integrate corporate governance and legal compliance tools. As part of its legal compliance and risk control projects, the group has commenced a coding process for internal guidelines to organise, define and authorise infragroup transactions. Internal control system The group has gradually adopted an internal control system, which has now reached varying degrees of implementation and is most structured for the accounting control system and administrative/accounting procedures, in order to ensure that financial information is complete and correct (supra Other elements of the internal control system and, in this section Information flows pursuant to Legislative Decree No. 262/2005). Strengthening the internal control system is a key objective in the scope of internal control tools and the modules comprising the overall system (segment and consolidated reporting, management control and the information system) and in view of increasingly integrating the risk management system. Organisational model pursuant to Legislative Decree No. 231/2001 The first step in this direction has been to develop the organisational and management model recommended by Legislative decree no. 231/2001, which the group first adopted on 11 December 2007. The aim of the model is to prevent specific types of crimes from being committed by employees and/or contractors in the group’s interests or to its benefit. Overseen by the Supervisory Body, the model and controls performed by the company functions involved have been subsequently adjusted to meet organisational changes within the group and developments in the applicable legislation. The following table indicates the main updates recently made to the model. Update Content 26 February 2013 Implementation of organisational changes during the year 26 February 2013 Introduction of the special section concerning environmental crimes 17 July 2013 Integration of information flows from those subject to the model towards the Supervisory Body 17 July 2013 Informing and training employees about the existence and updating of the model During the year, systematic checks were performed to verify that the model is effective, with the Supervisory Body conducting controls and through interviews with personnel involved in sensitive activities. 60 The aim of these steps is to ensure in the future and to an increasingly structured extent that ◊ infragroup transactions are documented using the appropriate contracts in accordance with the form and substance requirements of legislation in the countries where the group operates; ◊ contracts are subject to validation and authorisation by the bodies and organisations responsible for such, in accordance with the accountability structure; ◊ infragroup transactions are carried out in accordance with the requirements of effectiveness and economic substance applicable to non-related parties and on an arm’s length basis; ◊ fixed considerations for economic and financial transactions are consistent with market rates in accordance with the concept of fair value and with the principles established by international practice authorities. As a first step in the implementation of this fiscal governance policy, each year, the parent prepares internal transfer pricing documentation pursuant to article 1.2-ter of Legislative decree no. 471 of 18 December 1997, which was introduced into Italian legislation by article 26 of Law decree no. 78 of 31 May 2010, converted, as amended, by Law no. 122 of 30 July 2010 (the “Dossier”). The purpose of the Dossier is to document how transactions between the group companies are governed on an arm’s length basis in accordance with OECD guidelines. General remuneration policy The remuneration policy is made up of all the criteria and guidelines that apply to the definition of remuneration for: ◊ members of the board of directors, ◊ members of the board of statutory auditors, ◊ key managers. In recent years, the group has gradually implemented tools to align the process by which remuneration is defined with objectivity criteria and the requirements of strategic enhancement objectives, made possible by remuneration policies. The broadest objective is to attract, motivate and retain people who, given their technical and managerial skills and their different backgrounds, gender and experience, give the group a competitive edge. MAG | Annual Report 2015 An effective remuneration policy reinforces the commitment of employees and contractors and their alignment with commitment to organisational goals, the group’s mission and its culture and values. The following matrix summarises the principles and criteria underpinning the remuneration policy. amount, including both fixed fees and payments for meeting attendance, of all board members’ remuneration. The members of the board of directors receive fixed fees for their responsibilities as a steering and control body, while financial incentives will be introduced if the company is listed. There are no share-based incentive plans or early severance package agreements signed in advance. Purpose and general principle Principles Criteria The board of directors Fairness and consistency Balanced remunerative packages based on one’s position, responsibilities, expertise and demonstrated abilities; Consistent approach in the various countries/businesses/functions. Upon the proposal of the appointment and remuneration committee and having heard the opinion of the statutory auditors, the board of directors determines the fees for directors with specific duties, within the aforementioned amount. Alignment with business strategies Structured incentive systems linked to the achievement of sustainable results for the group; Definition of individual objectives to maintain sustainable levels of performance in terms of results and risks. The board of directors also defines an incentive plan (MBO), considering proposals by the Appointment and Remuneration Committee and budget constraints. The plan is for: Competitiveness Ongoing analysis of peers’ remuneration practices and general market trends; Competitive salaries in terms of amount and composition; Alignment with the business strategy and goals. Rewarding merit and performance Bonuses based on performance, distinction and selectivity; Close link between remuneration and group results; Fixed and merit-based remuneration seen as a key driver for motivating and retaining employees and for aligning performance with organisational objectives. Governance and compliance Transparent governance; Remuneration guidelines that are consistent with national/ international practices and the group’s values. Parties involved in the remuneration process Governance systems and rules are aimed at ensuring the clear, transparent and efficient definition and management of the group’s remuneration and incentive policies. The main players in the process are: ◊ the shareholders ◊ the board of directors ◊ the Appointment and Remuneration Committee. ◊ Executive directors; ◊ Key managers77; ◊ Junior managers or managers heading functions or projects. Appointment and remuneration committee The Appointment and Remuneration Committee is entrusted with preliminary and proposal duties for the determination of fees and the remuneration criteria of the company’s subsidiaries as well, in order to encourage the application of consistent criteria throughout the group. The Appointment and Remuneration Committee is set up within the board of directors and consists of at least two non-executive directors and/or one independent director. The term of office for members of this committee coincides with the term of office of the board of directors. If the latter is terminated in advance - for any reason - the committee’s term of office immediately lapses as well. The board of directors can revoke the committee’s mandate at any time. The chairman of the board of statutory auditors attends the committee’s meetings. No director attends the meetings of the Appointment and Remuneration Committee when the proposals of the board of directors for their remuneration are being formulated. The Human Resource Manager serves as the committee’s secretary, and the Human Resources Department is responsible for implementing the committee’ proposals once they have been approved by the board of directors. Shareholders’ meetings Upon the proposal of the board of directors and having heard the opinion of the appointment and remuneration committee, the shareholders determine the maximum total 77 The board of directors approves the incentive system. Managers and junior managers participate in the short-term merit-based plans provided for by their individual employment contracts. This clause is included in the initial or renewed employment contract depending on the type and breadth of the employee’s or contractor’s responsibilities. MAG | Annual Report 2015 61 Components of remuneration gate for access to the plan) and individual targets, which are quantifiable and measurable and can either relate to economic results/the financial position or technical/production indicators. Fixed remuneration Fixed remuneration is based on the resource’s role within the organisation and is aimed at rewarding expertise and merit. The board of directors defines the structure of the shortterm incentive plan, upon the proposal of the Appointment and Remuneration Committee. Specifically, the following parameters are considered: Medium to long-term incentive system for senior managers. ◊ he objectives and responsibilities assigned to the position held; ◊ relevant remuneration benchmarks, with specific focus on professional positions presenting the highest market risk, the business sector and the relevant context; ◊ how the person fills the position in terms of proven performance and expertise; ◊ potential growth for the most important professional positions and those requiring critical expertise that is the most difficult to find on the labour market; ◊ experience gained and career path. Variable remuneration The incentive system includes long-term variable components which constitute a recent development line for the group’s policy as they create a sense of identity and instil loyalty in key positions. At present, they are reserved for the managing director and senior managers (General Manager/s, Co-General Managers and Division Heads). Performance-based bonus. This is linked to productivity and profitability for the year. The conditions and criteria applied are defined annually when the supplementary company contract is agreed. Blue collars, white collars and junior managers not covered by the MBO policy are eligible for this bonus. The variable component of remuneration is mainly based on the measurement of performance on an annual and/or long-term basis. Other one-off bonuses The aim is to involve and direct people towards company strategies, rewarding them for the value of individual and team contributions. Furthermore, to complete the variable component of remuneration, group companies may reward exceptional performance and seek to retain resources with a one-off bonus, following selection and merit-based criteria and within budget constraints. Gates to remuneration and a system of objectives based on the group’s and the individual company’s performance have been established to ensure a more direct correlation between company results and the bonuses paid. Performance is measured considering performance and financial indicators. Variable, performance-based remuneration consists of the following components: Short-term management-by-objective incentives (annual MBO bonus). The short-term merit-based component may constitute up to 30% of gross annual remuneration, unless otherwise indicated by the Appointment and Remuneration Committee, and may be paid in part if only some of the collective or individual targets are achieved. It is paid in the month following that in which the shareholders approve the financial statements for the year to which the targets relate. The variable component is annual and is linked to an incentive plan (MBO). This plan provides for the definition of shared targets (e.g., consolidated EBITDA, considered the group’s main economic performance indicator, and which is usually used as the 62 Benefit (non-monetary) Other non-monetary benefits are part of the group’s welfare system and fall within a broader notion of remuneration: ◊ Third-party liability insurance policy (D&O), offered to directors, statutory auditors and managers for liability for illegal acts or the violation of obligations in the performance of their duties; ◊ Term life and disability/illness insurance policy offered to executive directors and managers, including optional integration in addition to the mandatory collective life insurance coverage required by the national labour agreement for industrial managers; ◊ Health insurance policy offered to managers who, in addition to the provisions of the national labour agreement for industrial managers, also benefit from an extra policy for medical expenses not covered by the integrative healthcare fund (FASI). ment purposes. the statutory auditors’ fees as a fixed amount. Severance pay Key managers. These fees relate to employment contracts subject to the national labour agreement for industrial managers. In general, the group does not provide for any particular pay if employment or one’s position is terminated in advance. However, the payments and contributions due pursuant to law and the national labour agreement or under individual agreements reached within the scope and in accordance with the limits of such provisions are paid to prevent legal action taken on objective grounds. Directors and key managers in subsidiaries. Their fees and remuneration are fixed amounts. Remuneration and the pay-mix Different, competitive pay packages are created according to position, and include fixed and variable remuneration and benefits. Non-competition agreements To protect professional positions presenting high market risk and those with critical know-how for the group’s success, non-competition agreements have been defined with a consideration agreed while the employment relationship is in place. Addressees of the policies Board of directors. The board members’ total remuneration consists of a fixed amount and fees for their attendance. The aim is to position the group’s remuneration in line with the market, while seeking to competitively remunerate the top performers, resources with the best potential or those holding strategic positions with the highest attrition risk. The group aims to create a balance between the fixed and variable components of remuneration, setting well-balanced pay mix levels. Variable remuneration may not exceed fixed remuneration; therefore, a ratio of 1:1 has been set as the maximum limit. Board of statutory auditors. The shareholders determine fixed remuneration short-term variable remuneration long-term variable remuneration Senior managers Yes 25%-30% Of gross annual salary Yes Key senior managers Yes 20%-25% Of gross annual salary - Other managers Yes 10%-20% Of gross annual salary - Other group personnel Yes - - beneficiaries For the completion of specific duties assigned to personnel, special benefits may be provided, and as such are covered by various application and tax rules. These benefits include company cars for both work and personal use and weekday housing for certain professional figures within the group for the performance of their duties, for travel and for manage- MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 63 Social sustainability The analysis of employees by gender reflects the stratification that the group inherited with the business units it has acquired. It is the group’s policy to strictly enforce equal opportunities, not only with respect to gender, but also religion, personal beliefs, race, ethnic origin, etc.. Human resources and safety in the workplace Personnel hiring, composition and change policy It is with growing attention that the group monitors the main data on its workers, including employees, temporary workers and all other types of contractors and freelancers. This focus is an extension of the group’s values and is due to the awareness that expertise is not the only key factor in the achievement of objectives, but a series of other factors like company climate and constantly enhancing and encouraging professional and human qualities that resources offer and can develop is also crucial. Throughout the year, management strives for ongoing dialogue with workers on the actual application of contracts, their renewal and the management of relationships. At 30 September 2015, MAG group employees numbered 537, compared to 521 at the end of 2013/2014, with an annual average that remained higher than both previous years, analysed by month and gender below. 2014/2015 2013/2014 M F Total M F Total M F Total 448 73 521 456 75 531 430 67 497 November 454 74 528 456 75 531 429 67 496 December 450 73 523 456 75 531 431 67 498 Jennuary 449 75 524 458 75 533 439 68 507 Febbruary 445 74 519 462 75 537 441 70 511 March 443 77 520 457 77 534 444 67 511 April 446 78 524 458 78 536 446 73 519 May 450 80 530 455 77 532 456 72 528 June 453 81 534 456 76 532 457 73 530 July 453 80 533 452 76 528 458 73 531 August 453 81 534 449 74 523 457 74 531 Annual average 64 455 82 537 449 72 521 454 75 529 449,92 77,33 527,25 455,33 75,42 530,75 445,17 70,50 515,67 MAG | Annual Report 2015 2014/15 2013/14 2012/13 M F Total M F TOT M F Total October 41 4 45 64 7 71 73 14 87 November 39 4 43 60 7 67 80 16 96 December 37 6 43 54 7 61 63 17 80 Jennuary 39 5 44 47 6 53 88 24 112 Febbruary 41 5 46 43 6 49 91 24 115 March 37 3 40 43 6 49 92 24 116 April 34 2 36 37 6 43 78 18 96 May 37 4 41 40 4 44 83 18 101 June 38 5 43 40 4 44 71 10 81 July 37 5 42 40 4 44 72 10 82 August 29 3 32 35 4 39 67 8 75 September 40 3 43 42 4 46 66 8 74 37,42 4,08 41,50 45,42 5,42 50,83 77,00 15,92 92,92 Annual average 2012/2013 October September The group also has temporary staff78 (with temporary employment contracts) in accordance with current laws and with the aim of covering peaks in activities. The number of temporary staff is on-the-whole modest although, in prior years, activities were particularly intense in some transitional phases, leading to an increase in temporary staff. This was particularly the case in 2012/2013 and in the first half of 2013/2014, and related to the VIP AW101 interior contracts carried out by the CCS and AS divisions. The table below shows the average cost of temporary staff of the year, analysed by gender and compared with the previous two years. In 2014/2015, the group hosted young interns gaining work experience to complete their studies, generally in support functions (administration, finance and HR). Headcount changes in 2014/2015 Changes in the headcount in 2014/2015 are summarised below. 30/09/14 Managers Junior managers and white collars Hired Terminated Transferred Promotions 30/09/15 26 2 2 0 1 27 234 30 23 0 -1 240 Blue collars 261 23 15 1 0 270 Total 521 55 40 1 0 537 78 The temporary staff discussed in this section consists of personnel working under the temporary employment contracts permitted under Italian law. It does not include any other forms of employment (e.g. jobshoppers, contract-workers, etc.). MAG | Annual Report 2015 65 The table below analyses personnel by the functional area in which they work, considered thematically and transversally rather than in terms of the overall organisation, which is divided into divisions. The table also analyses the category and gender of new employees hired in the past three years. 2014/15 2013/14 2012/13 M F Total M F Total M F Total 1 1 2 3 0 3 3 0 3 Junior managers and white collars 17 13 30 18 4 22 26 13 39 Blue collars 23 0 23 15 1 16 41 2 43 Management (MD, Op.Un.Div.) 85 Production Managers Annual average 41 14 55 36 5 41 70 15 Resignations in 2014/2015 and the previous two years are analysed below by age and gender. 2014/15 2013/14 2012/13 M F Total M F Total M F Total 0 1 1 1 0 1 2 0 2 between 21 and 30 years 10 0 10 10 1 11 6 0 6 between 31 and 40 years 9 1 10 9 5 14 8 3 11 up to 20 years between 41 and 50 years 4 0 4 6 2 8 7 2 9 over 50 years 13 2 15 14 1 15 11 0 11 Total 36 4 40 40 9 49 34 5 39 2014/15 2013/14 M F Total M F Total M F 9 3 12 8 2 10 8 2 10 216 5 221 208 5 213 215 5 220 Product support 73 11 84 74 7 81 81 7 88 Quality 44 7 51 46 6 52 44 5 49 Research and development 53 5 58 52 4 56 50 4 54 Locistic 25 14 39 27 12 39 24 13 37 Administration, Finance, Information systems 12 23 35 13 20 33 10 22 32 Human resources and organisation 3 8 11 3 7 10 3 8 11 Sales 8 4 12 6 6 12 6 6 12 Purchases Total Managers Junior managers White collars Blue collars Total Resignation 0 1 12 2 15 Retirement 0 0 0 4 4 Contract expiry 0 0 2 0 2 Dismissal 1 1 6 5 13 Failure to pass the trial period 0 0 0 4 4 Death 1 1 0 0 2 Total 2 3 20 15 40 12 2 14 12 3 15 13 3 16 455 82 537 449 72 521 454 75 529 Hiring policy ◊ in various steps by different people, ◊ considering many different candidates for the same position. Candidates are evaluated on the basis of their skills, training, previous experience, expectations and potential, with respect to the organisation’s specific needs. All newly hired employees are given a copy of the national labour agreement and the MAG code of conduct. Employees are analysed by diploma/degree below. 2014/15 Analisys of empolyees by age, seniority and function The first two tables analyse employee percentages by age, 2013/14 2012/13 M F Total M F Total M F Total 63 2 65 71 3 74 77 3 80 between 31 and 40 years 161 36 197 156 34 190 148 34 182 between 41 and 50 years 116 27 143 103 21 124 107 23 130 over 50 years 115 17 132 119 14 133 122 15 137 Total 455 82 537 449 72 521 454 75 529 up to 30 years 2014/15 2013/14 M F Total M F Total M F 181 40 221 175 32 207 195 36 231 between 6 and 10 years 140 15 155 142 13 155 126 10 136 between 11 and 20 years 91 22 113 86 22 108 80 23 103 79 66 2012/13 M F Total M F Total M F Total University degree 20,1% 6,1% 26,3% 20,4% 5,1% 25,5% 20,1% 5,1% 25,2% High school diploma 28,1% 5,8% 33,9% 24,4% 4,4% 28,8% 24,9% 4,7% 29,6% Professional school 16,6% 2,6% 19,2% 18,3% 2,7% 21,1% 17,8% 2,7% 20,5% Middle school 19,7% 0,7% 20,5% 23,4% 1,1% 24,4% 23,5% 1,1% 24,5% 0,2% 0,0% 0,2% 0,2% 0,0% 0,2% 0,2% 0,0% 0,2% 84,7% 15,3% 100,0% 86,7% 13,3% 100,0% 86,5% 13,5% 100,0% Elementary school Total Over the past four years (2011/12 – 2014/15), employees with a university degree rose by almost 3% (from 23.5% to 26.3%), while employees with a high school diploma increased by almost 6% (from 73.6% to 79.3%). MAG group promotes its employees’ professional growth through continuous training. On the basis of feedback from the relevant supervisors, HR management prepares an annual training plan with specific courses to be held. 2012/13 up to 5 years over 20 years 2013/14 Training and seniority for the past three years. Totale Total The principles for the recruitment of new resources are based on ensuring equal opportunities for all candidates, without any discrimination, and following a hiring process that is carried out Finally, the following table summarises the reasons for termination of employment79 in 2014/2015. 2014/15 2012/13 Total 43 5 48 46 5 51 53 6 59 455 82 537 449 72 521 454 75 529 In 2014/2015, 15,284 hours of training were offered, compared to 12,805 hours in the previous year and an average of 16,200 hours in the last four years. Not considering new employee training, which is part of the orientation process and, therefore, linked to changes in the headcount, training hours totalled 5,193, compared to 6,634 in 2013/2014 and 8,361 in 2012/2013. The table below analyses hours of training in the previous three years, highlighting the courses held by in-house trainers. When the reason is death, the employee did not die while working or for a work-related reason. MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 67 2013/2014 2012/2013 Work hours and absence 2011/2012 In-house training for new hires 7.176 2.531 6.853 Quality, safety and the environment 2.480 1.382 2.546 Administration and organisation 888 120 679 Foreign languages 336 738 597 Research and development 467 998 1.061 Computer skills 158 749 1.174 3.717 4.196 1.528 63 2.091 5.321 Total 15.284 12.805 19.759 including: Hours of training by internal personnel 10.091 5.585 12.170 Product/process awareness Other There are 40 hours of work per week for the Italian companies and Canada (Quebec) and 46 for the US. In the first two cases, the 40 hours are divided into five working days from Monday to Friday. The following table summarises main overtime data80. 2014/15 Monthly average workers reporting overtime Number of overtime hours Number of hours per year per person 2013/14 2012/13 313,0 326,0 294 32.496,3 33.213,3 39.250,0 61,6 62,6 76 2014/15 2013/14 2012/13 39.140,8 39.028,0 37.905,0 3,8% 3,8% 3,7% 74,2 73,5 73,5 2014/15 2013/14 2012/13 20.308,0 19.849,0 22.302,0 2,0% 2,2% 2,6% 38,5 37,4 43,2 The following tables give information81 on total hours of employee absence The group has launched and, for the most part, completed a safety in the workplace training programme for workers, nominees and managers, along with periodic updates, in line with the provisions of current legislation. Total annual hours of absence The group has also made language training a priority, partly given its focus on international development, and therefore this constitutes an objective for the expansion of the programme. Diversity and equal opportunity As noted previously, MAG group is committed to guaranteeing equal opportunities to all women employees, who make up 15.3% of its personnel (13.8% in 2013/2014 and 14.2% in 2012/2013). Although, because of its industrial nature, the company has historically seen the prevalence of male employees over female employees, especially among blue collars, the most recent group policies are based on the principles of pluralism and prohibits all forms of discrimination, naturally leading to a change in the gender composition of its headcount. 2014/2015 number % 2013/2014 Percentage hours of absence/workable hours Average hours of illness per person and hours of sick leave. Total annual hours of illness Percentage hours of illness/workable hours Average hours of absence per person 2012/2013 M F Total M F Total M F Total 455 82 537 449 72 521 454 75 529 84,7% 15,3% 100,0% 86,2% 13,8% 100,0% 85,8% 14,2% 100,0% Similarly to other indicators, these figures are below the averages82 of Italy’s metal-mechanical industry. Worker health and safety and work environment The group is also very attentive to the family needs of its workers, without jeopardising its organisational and production requirements. It is a priority for the group to safeguard its workers’ health and safety. The health and safety issue management system is compliant with current laws and regulations in the various legal systems where the group operates and, more generally, is aimed at continuously improving work conditions. This attention is reflected in its maternity and paternity leave, as provided for by the various legal systems where the group operates, in its approval of requests to reduce work hours (part-time contracts entailing partial days or partial weeks). The group’s Italian companies have updated procedures and operating processes to the requirements of Legislative decree no. 81/2008 (Consolidated act on health and safety in the workplace). The group employs 25 disabled people, who were hired not only to fulfil a legal obligation (under Italian law) but to encourage their inclusion and integration in its organisation. The table below summarises data on injuries in the workplace. Remuneration and incentives Junior managers and managers (or equivalent levels under other legislation) participate in an incentive system that include a merit-based component (MBO) and remuneration commensurate with the achievement of collective and individual targets, subject to gates, in accordance with the criteria described in section GENERAL REMUNERATION POLICY (see). The pension plans in place for all group employees are those provided for by current legislation applicable where the group operates. MAG | Annual Report 2015 2013/14 2012/13 Injuries in the workplace 1 3 Injuries in transit 2 - 1 20 47 280 Average duration of absences due to injuries in the workplace (days) MAG employees are assigned positions in accordance with the standards of the applicable labour agreements (Italian entities apply the national labour agreement for the metal-mechanical industry), integrated by secondary contracts that provide for minimum remuneration based on the employee’s level and a merit-based bonus for blue and white collars. 68 2014/15 Average duration of absences due to injuries in transit (days) 6 86 - 31 Total hours of absences due to injuries 712 343 2.797 Hours of absences due to injuries per person 1,35 0,65 5,42 The trend is consistent with the group’s policy and the figures are considerably lower than the averages83 of the metalmechanical industry. 80 It does not include MAG Inc. data (the sites in Philadelphia - PA and Hagerstown - MD) which are not completely available for prior years used for comparison. 81 The previous note also applies to absences. 82 Source: Federmeccanica, “L’industria metalmeccanica in cifre”, June 2015. – Per capita total hours of absence from work: 110.5 and hours of sick leave: 51.7. (2013 figures). 83 Source: Federmeccanica, op.cit., Per capita hours of absence from work for injuries: 11.9 (2013). MAG | Annual Report 2015 69 Shareholders SHARE CAPITAL. The composition of share capital is described in the section on corporate governance (see SHAREHOLDERS). Institutional investors, which are all Italian residents, own a significant portion of the parent MAG’s share capital. There are non-controlling investors as well, as a result of the local public entity’s84 5.6% investment in the wholly-owned subsidiary SAT. DIVIDENDS. MAG’s shareholders have adopted a policy that does not provide for the distribution of dividends. Profits are entirely reinvested in operations. RELATIONSHIPS WITH INVESTORS AND FINANCIAL ANALYSTS. MAG’s financial reporting policy is based on integrity, transparency and continuity, with a maturity that tends to anticipate its growth process. In line with the group’s growth in size and complexity, the main steps in the preparation of financial information are summarised below. First set of financial statements audited on a voluntary basis 1996/97 Group accounting standards (ITA GAAP) and consolidated report 2001/2002 Group standard evolution (start up and R&D) GAP analysis Group accounting standards (IFRS) IFRS transition - Group FS 2002/2003 Management reporting - local GAAP and consolidated 2010/2011 2011/2012 Qustomers and quality managements Sales analisys A breakdown of group revenue by division and product line is given in the directors’ report (see GROUP PERFORMANCE), while geographical segment reporting is provided in the notes (see 3.4 SEGMENT REPORTING). maintaining adequate customer satisfaction by meeting current (and potential) requirements; ◊ striving for continuous improvement in processes and products; ◊ integrating the supply chain, which is qualified based on industrial criteria in a continuous improvement process, ◊ improving business performance. These targets are pursued through the investment of resources and organisational aspects and can be tangibly seen in the obtaining and maintenance of certification, the result of a company culture that strives to uphold the principles of quality. In terms of numbers, current expenses85 and quality investments can be summarised as follows (amounts in thousands of Euros) The group’s turnover continues to be quite concentrated in terms of customer and country as a result of the oligopoly nature of its main market, which consists of helicopter OEMs, and due to the complexity of the diversification underway for some time. Indeed, the diversification process is connected with the high investment rate in new product development, with a rather long maturation cycle, that the group pursues in terms of ◊ expanding the production range – with the effect of offering more products and services for the same aircraft; ◊ addition of new applications for its products/services – with the effect of broadening the potential market for these products/services. In each of these cases, business relationships with customers include a significant degree of integration and longterm consolidation. 2014/15 2013/14 2012/13 Product certification 200 171 185 Process certification 227 109 120 Equipment and measurement and inspection tools - operation 124 110 123 Equipment and measurement and inspection tools - investment 173 85 101 5 1 1 Training 24 38 16 Trials and tests (laboratories, universities, entities) 72 87 71 826 601 617 51 52 49 Technical standards, software, publications Total Addetti all’assicurazione/controllo qualità The following table summarises the main certification of the group’s sites and organisational units. Type Industry standard Ministero Difesa (IT) Upgrading of the internal control system - dev. programs For the above reasons, an analysis of customers by size shows that nearly all group customers are in extremely large groups, global competitors, which are often conglomerates. 2004/2005 2006/2007 LITIGATION. There is no litigation with shareholders either pending at this time or in the past.. European Aviation Safety Agency (EASA) Quality management Kick-off of the control system project First-time application of IFRS 8 on a voluntary basis IFRS transition statutory FS 2013/2014 First integrated annual report The quality management system is crucial for companies operating in the industrial aerospace industry if they are to operate as an aerospace organisation and is an essential condition for business continuity. Federal Aviation Administration (FAA) Transport Canada Civil Aviation (TCCA) As such, it can be divided into two main parts: ◊ the general quality system (an industry standard), as for advanced industrial companies in general, which is integrated with environmental and workplace safety management systems; ◊ specific certification, such as for the organisation of production and the development and maintenance of aerospace products. Special Process NADCAP Accreditation Certification Unit/site AS/EN 9100:2009 Borgomanero (IT), Monteprandone (IT) Laval (Can) EN 9110:2012 Borgomanero (IT), Monteprandone (IT) AER-Q-2110 Borgomanero (IT), Monteprandone (IT) Design Organization Approval (Part 21 J) Monteprandone (IT) Production Organization Approval (Part 21 G) Borgomanero (IT), Monteprandone (IT) Maintenance Organization Approval (Part 145) Borgomanero (IT), Monteprandone (IT), Laval (Can) Continued Airworthiness Maintenance Organization (Part M) Monteprandone (IT) Repair Station (Part 145) Borgomanero (IT), Philadelphia (USA) CAR 573 (Part 145) Borgomanero (IT) Manufacture and Certification (AWM 561) Laval (Can) Maintenance Organization Approval (CAR 573.02) Laval (Can) Non Desctructive Testing Surface Enhancement Borgomanero (IT) Both parts are aimed at achieving the following objectives: 84 the Ascoli Piceno municipal authorities 70 85 The data do not include internal costs (e.g. hours of training taught by internal personnel). MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 71 Type Certification Unit/site Airbus Helicopters AgustaWestland Service Center AgustaWestland Bell Helicopter Diamond Aircraft Industries Customers approvals One Aviation Hanwha Corporation Piper Aircraft Piaggio Aero Industries Service Center Woodward HRT (amounts in thousands of Euros or percentages) 2014/15 Materials, components and purchased semifinished products Operating assets 44.033 53,5% 2013/14 41.940 47,6% 2.560 3,1% 4.341 4,9% Services 35.727 43,4% 41.898 47,5% Total 82.320 100,0% 88.179 100,0% There were no significant disputes with suppliers at the reporting date. UTC Aerospace Systems (GLG) Nortrop Grumman Model NH 300C Type Certificates Helicopters Model NH 300D Model AMD 500N The group also holds a series of product certifications, some of which are the equivalent of industrial design rights (e.g. STC), described in the section on new product development. The group measures the quality management system’s overall reliability using key performance indicators (KPI), which are continuously monitored both internally and in conjunction with customers. The KPI system differs depending on the type of activity and customer. There were no disputes with customers at the reporting date. Costs to repair products under warranty remain within physiological levels, and are provided for by constantly adjusting the provision for product warranties. At 30 September 2015, the provision for product warranties totalled €1,273 thousand, releasing the accrual of €115 thousand for 2014/15. Suppliers and contractual terms The MAG group has consolidated, longstanding relationships with most of its suppliers, especially those that make up the supply chain, which is integrated through supply insourcing processes and provides products and services with the necessary certification and qualifications required by the industry. Contractual terms are based on the principles of integrity, fairness and agreed growth strategies. In order to treat their suppliers consistently, with a few necessary local differences, the group companies have prepared: ◊ procedures and operating instructions to ensure that supplier vetting processes and/or the periodic review of suppliers are carried out properly and on an arm’s length basis; ◊ general contractual terms applicable for specific categories of supplies, which are subject to specific approval and referenced in purchase orders. Relationships with the financial community The group has consolidated relationships with banks and financial institutions. Its debt is contained and its financial indicators reveal a sound level of equity and well balanced sources and applications of funds. At 30 September 2015, the ratio of net financial debt to equity attributable to the owners of the parent is 0.58 (30 September 2014: 0.75). Debt is mainly non-current (97.4%; 74.9% in the previous year). The group’s credit facilities total roughly €105 million; of these, none of the bank facilities (approximately €26 million) were used, while roughly 42% of facilities for the factoring of trade receivables was used (approximately €70 million). Financial debt is analysed in the notes to the consolidated financial statements (see 9.1 Net financial debt), while additional information on exposure and financial covenants is given in the section on 5.3 Financial risk management(see 5.3.5 Liquidity risk). In 2013/2014, for the first time, the group underwent a voluntary rating procedure by a leading private rating agency. The rating was made available to the group’s main banks, as provided for by private rating rules. The group operates with 12 Italian banks and four foreign banks (HSBC, Republic Bank, Wells Fargo and Toronto Dominion). There are no disputes pending with financial entities. To help share with suppliers the values underpinning the group’s business model and to ensure compliance not only with laws but also with the principles of transparency and integrity, MAG has informed all its suppliers of its code of conduct, which it has published on its website and references in each purchase order that it issues. The table below summarises group purchases by current expenses and investments in the past two years. Relationships with the public administration Historically, the group’s relationships with the Italian public administration consist of the following main types: ministration; ◊ beneficiary of subsidised financing instruments; ◊ investee of public entities; ◊ generic relationships with the public administration (e.g., tax authorities, agencies, social security institutions, etc.). The group supplies public administration bodies and institutions (e.g. Ministry of Defence - General Directorate of Air Armaments - Armaereo, Ministry of Farming and Forest Policies and the Italian Tax Police) within the scope of contracts, usually of a long-term nature, for the supply of products and maintenance and overhaul services (of aircraft and parts) and engineering services. Over the years, the group has benefited from public financing assistance in the form of loans and, to a lesser extent, grants, to support research and development and innovation in general, mainly under the following legislation: ◊ Law no. 808 of 24 December 1985; ◊ Law no. 46 of 17 February 1982; ◊ Law no. 296 of 27 December 2006 (and Law no. 244 of 24 December 2007). Other minor assistance (e.g. Law no. 311 of 30 December 2004) falls within the scope of relationships with the tax authorities in the form of partial tax relief. Law no. 808/85 also constitutes the main source of financial assistance to the industrial aerospace sector, with the aim of developing and increasing the competitiveness of industrial aerospace companies, through a support to the research and development activities in a sector which is deemed strategic for the industrial policy. Aerospace is indeed an investment-intensive sector as it is oriented to achieving very innovative technological solutions which, due to their inner complexity, are risky and do not guarantee immediate economic return. By providing financial support to the research and development projects carried out by enterprises, the Law aims at mitigating such risks during the start up phase of the project, so that technology advances of the sector are encouraged. In more general terms the Law qualifies as a measure of industrial policy, which can help the enterprises’ competitiveness, strengthen the level of employment, positively contribute to the country balance of payments, namely of the trade balance. As such, Law no. 808 facility has represented for the MAG Group a key factor for creating a heritage of relevant skills in the technological fields where the Group has been engaged, skills that have promoted the process of growth, of generating employment, of diversification and internationalization. ◊ supplier of products and services to the public ad- 72 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 73 After the introduction of Law no. 808/85 into the legal system, there have been changes in its implementing measures, especially as regards its regulatory provisions and the discipline of the different reimbursement regimes, changes that have been mostly enacted by deeds of the Public Administration. More specifically, the CIPE Directive no. 28 of 22 March 2006, which basically rules all MAG programs, introduced a distinction of the programs that qualify for Law no. 808 assistance, between: ◊ Programs considered relevant to “National Security” or of “European interest” and ◊ Other programs. In the Group 20 years history, the assistance received under Law no. 808/85 globally amounts to € 46.4 million, against four programs considered relevant to National Security (€ 32 million), one program of European Interest (€ 10 million) and two programs pertaining to the latter typology. The assistance (received and to be received) for the National Security and European Interest programs has been progressively deducted over the years from the costs capitalized against the relevant projects. Therefore, the royalties to be paid to the MiSE (Ministry of Economic Development) in proportion to the sales of the products incorporating the technologies developed, furtherly represent lato sensu a social allocation of the economic value generated through this government assistance. Over the same 20 years, the Group has borne some € 110 million of R&D expenditures, which became the driving force of its evolution, whose spillover effects were either internal, in terms of increased skills and market penetration, or external, in terms of creation of value, not merely economic, in the territories where the Group has been operating. Given its importance in terms of investing in the development of new products, additional details on financing and the accounting treatment of the related financial statements captions are provided for in the Annual Financial Report (see Development of new products, 4.1.1.1 Research and development costs). The public administration’s non-controlling interests in the group companies consist of the Ascoli Piceno municipal authorities’ investment in the subsidiary SAT S.p.A. (Società Aeroporto del Tronto S.p.A., “SAT”). SAT is the vehicle for the project to create, through a series of steps, an infrastructure for fixed-wing aircraft landing with maximum weight at take-off of up to 20 tonnes. The infrastructure will be used to develop the group’s industrial activities and, at the same time, make it possible to set up a civil protection operating base. Accordingly, the public administration bodies’ investment in SAT, provided for by article 6 of its by-laws, is justified by the public’s general interest in the construction of infrastructure 74 that could be strategic in an area that mostly falls within objective area 286 and has poor infrastructure levels. It is in these terms that Resolution no. 215 of 16 February 2005 of the Marche Regional Council falls, setting the guidelines for the creation of regional territorial development agencies, along with the decree of 1 March 2006, whereby the Ministry of Economic Development (previously the Ministry of the Economy and Finance) granted the Ascoli Piceno municipal authorities funds to be used for the investment in SAT. In 2014/2015, the Marche Region expressed particular interest in the infrastructure to be used a base for the Civil Protection, identifying the possibility of the local authority disbursing a grant against the residual portion of investments. Environmental policy and responsibility Over time, the group has kept an ongoing focus on the environmental impact of its production activities, although they cannot be considered high risk. Nevertheless, its risk and compliance analyses (see Risk management and compliance) and analysis of compliance with increasingly stringent standards on safety in the workplace (see Human resources and safety in the workplace) have progressively lent more structure to the analysis process and the prevention of potential risks. This process is completely based on principles whereby companies are required to: ◊ take a preventative approach to environmental issues; ◊ implement initiatives that promote greater environmental responsibility, ◊ encourage the development and widespread use of environmentally-friendly technologies. In this respect, the group has always made compliance with environmental protection legislation a crucial issue and has always treated it as an opportunity to instil a company culture that includes the understanding that sustainability should be considered as part of the value of economic activity and products and services. During the year, the procedure to obtain the ISO 14001 certification began. This certification provides for the audit of Italian sites starting from June 2016. In this respect, the group set up an overall reporting system to gather statistical data and indicators on the environmental impact of its activities, as preliminarily summarised herein. 86 Areas with structural difficulties needing socio-economic redevelopment support, in accordance with the qualification under the EU Regulation for Structural Funds for 2000 - 2006. MAG | Annual Report 2015 Environmental impact Natural gas Consumption of gas per hour worked 2014/15 88 4,05 m3/h Materials used and recyclability of products The group’s main product lines (Aircraft Systems SBUs) are characterised by high performance rates and an optimal use of natural resources. The raw materials used mainly comprise steel, alloy steel, aluminium and aluminium alloys and composite materials. They must comply with specific composition techniques (STM/SAE/ISI). However, no sector regulations prevent the use of recycled raw materials. Accordingly, it is estimated that 65% of aluminium and aluminium alloys come from recovered scrap. With respect to steel, no specific information is available on the percentage originated from minerals. Most materials used in processing represent a very low environmental hazard and production scraps and trimmings are always reused or recycled through secondary markets subject to specific controls. Consequently, the group has identified the chemicals used as the first type of hazardous materials to be monitored. Specifically, paints prevail in terms of quantity. During the year, paint consumption was monitored using the following indicators.87figure is the simple arithmetic mean of consumption per hour worked, calculated for each production site. Hazardous raw materials Raw materials consumption (paints) Consumption of materials per hour worked87 Consumption of electricity Consumption of electricity per hour worked Value m.u. 5,9 Ton 0,020 Kg./h Energy sources The Italian sites mainly use natural gas for central heating and the painting systems. Conversely, the Canadian site uses electricity also for central heating.88 Natural gas 2014/15 Value m.u. 503.318 m3 87 This figure is the simple arithmetic mean of consumption per hour worked, calculated for each production site. 88 This figure is the simple arithmetic mean of consumption per hour worked, calculated for each production site. 2014/15 Value m.u. 6.420.574 Kwh 79,36 Kwh/h All water used in production processes by the group’s sites is disposed of. Consequently, there are no industrial water discharges. Over 50% of all water used in industrial processes is withdrawn from the well and is recovered by concentration systems that minimise the volume of water required. Water Consumption of water (well) Consumption of water (well) per hour worked Consumption of water (aqueduct) Consumption of water (aqueduct) per hour worked 2014/15 Value m.u. 11.352 m3 0,08 m3/h 11.092 m3 0,07 m3/h Waste Scrap and waste from production are identified and separately collected to be subsequently recycled and disposed of.89 Waste generation89 2014/15 The cyanidric products used at the Monteprandone site must be authorised and withdrawals are rigorously monitored through time access to deposits by personnel with a permit to handle toxic gases. Consumption of natural gas Electricity 2014 Value m.u. 362,0 ton Total annual amount generated per hour worked 0,70 ton/h Annual amount of hazardous waste generated 29,9 ton Annual amount of hazardous waste generated per hour worked 0,06 ton/h Total annual amount generated Emissions The efficiency level of pollutant emission control systems is ensured by regular maintenance and periodic monitoring of all emissions which confirmed the group is well within the legal ceiling. Thermal power stations are regularly inspected (NOx) and cooling and air conditioning systems containing F-gas are subject to maintenance and periodic inspections in accordance with the law. No ozone depleting substances are used and systems using R22 were modified or are being removed. 89 The figure refers to 2014 (calendar year). Indeed, for Italian companies, it is derived from the Environmental declaration form. MAG | Annual Report 2015 75 CO2 emission figures of the year are given below. They refer to energy consumption using natural gas (central heating or production processes), electricity, fuel for company cars and helicopters. CO2 emissions Use of natural gas, electricity and fuel for vehicles 2014/15 Value m.u. 5.029 ton Expenditure and investments During the year, environmental costs were incurred in connection with waste disposal, consultancies, analysis of emissions and waste water and environmental maintenance. Furthermore, the various group sites incurred costs related to environmental protection investments. Environmental investments 2014/15 Value m.u. Environmental expenditure 179 Eur /000 Impact environmental expenditure/ Turnover 0,15 % Environmental investments 938 Eur /000 Impact environmental investments/ Turnover 0,76 % Claims and litigation There was no environmental contamination or pollution (underground or above). No significant environmental litigation is underway. Furthermore, the group believes that product innovation is a key factor in corporate environmental responsibility, and achieves such innovation by striving for production solutions that improve performance in terms of reducing fuel consumption, improving the conditions of use and, for the future, improving transport in general (see Sustainable innovation). Within the scope of the environmental compliance procedures, the various risk owners constantly monitor all main risks, in accordance with applicable legislation. No environmental events or claims occurred in recent history as a result of the group’s production activities, and no mid to high risk factors have been identified to date. 76 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Sustainable innovation Product and process innovation is a strategic target for the group, as it is a key factor in its development and essential to building competitive edge and maintaining it over time. Analyses conducted on current industrial trends in advanced countries reveal structural changes that increasingly entail the outsourcing of lower valued added components in industrial production. Highly effective institutional surveys, such as the EU survey, identify precise technological gaps as the reason for delays in certain areas like Europe and associate high economic development potential with strategic technological lines, as a necessary aspect for sustainability and improved quality of life. The annual IUS90 for 2015 and the European Commission have once again highlighted how national systems that are balanced with respect to their various aspects – research and development inputs, business innovation activities and innovation outputs – not only remain top innovation leaders but are closely correlated with the performance of the economy. This leads to91 certain guidelines for the revision of the industrial system92 in which, beginning with the restrictions created by the high cost of energy and ageing infrastructures, growth drivers are identified in the technologies that encourage the sustainable development of economies, such as the achievement of renewable energy targets in 2020, energy resource storage and redistribution systems, smart grids, new materials and hybrid and electric means of transport. Therefore, the definition of the priority technologies on which to base Europe’s industrial redevelopment has led 90 “Innovation Union Scoreboard 2015”. Directorate-General for Enterprise and Industry, European Commission. 91 Jeremy Rifkin, Foundation on Economic Trends. “The third Industrial Revolution. How Lateral Power Is Transforming Energy, the Economy, and the World”. 92 José Manuel Barroso. “Mission Growth: Europe at the Lead of the New Industrial Revolution”. European Commission conference papers, 29 May 2012 MAG | Annual Report 2015 77 the European Commission to prepare a Framework for the Horizon 2020 project. The result is the development of the FP793, it identifies Key Enabling Technologies (KET), which correspond with the technological domains that represent key elements in promoting innovation and growth and that, accordingly, are placed at the centre of initiatives aimed at boosting the competitiveness of European industry. aerospace districts in the Piedmont and Lombardy regions organised by the EU. These projects are at an advanced stage of completion. The Lombardy Aerospace District KETs make it possible to innovate processes, goods and services in all economic sectors and, accordingly, are systemic as they tend to converge and integrate. The MAG group’s focus on the potential associated with KETs has motivated it to identify innovative solutions that have been either developed or researched in the scope of what are essentially new product development projects (see DEVELOPMENT OF NEW PRODUCTS). Fondo Europeo di Sviluppo Regionale (FESR) Lombardia (European fund for Lombardy regional development). Industrial research and experimental development project for a multi-stage electromechanical actuator. The group’s recent advancements in the H20 Framework are summarised below. KET Applications Nanotechnology Advanced materials Summary and effective manufacturing of nanomaterials, their components and systems Development of structurally advanced “3D printing” materials (carbon microtubules) Technology relating to functional, multifunctional and structural materials Development of DAMP (Diffused Anti Vibration Multilayer Panels) Technology relating to sustainable industry materials Development of surface treatment technology to replace chrome and cadmium (Nitrex) Transition to a reliable, sustainable, competitive energy system “Challenge” technology To create an intelligent, environmentallyfriendly, integrated transport system Development of technology to implement and control primary and secondary flight controls and landing systems based on the use of electromechanical components (see National and international platform) Applications are developed through a network of partnerships with aerospace engineering departments at universities (the Polytechnic University of Turin, the Polytechnic University of Milan, the Pisa University and the Rome 3 University) and research bodies (Centre Recherche Industriel du Quebec). Research and development applied to products fall under a few main lines divided into the helicopter and fixed-wing aircraft segments. ◊ Landing systems and the related hydraulic, electromechanical and electrohydraulic retraction and actuation systems, hydraulic and electromechanical flight controls (primary and secondary commands) and, eventually, wire flight control. ◊ Control and energy damping systems (advanced sound and vibration reduction solutions), infotainment and cabin comfort control. With respect to the qualification of innovation for transport and logistic development, having defined one of the five pillars94 of the third industrial revolution, the introduction of very light jets marked a groundbreaking change, winning One Aviation Inc.(formerly Eclipse Aerospace Inc.) the Collier Trophy95 of the US National Aeronautic Association (NAA). In the wake of the creation of the E500 with the previous Eclipse Aviation Corp., the E550 dual reactor is the most sophisticated version of the innovative personal jet concept, combining energy efficiency, avionics and extremely advanced technology with a low purchase cost. These elements, which gave rise to the category of very light jets in 2006/2007, gave a new group of users access to this type of private air transport and reinvented the concept of general aviation. More in general, all the solutions aimed at improving energy efficiency and attaining sustainable mobility models directly or indirectly combine technological excellence with environmental sustainability in which the concept of sustainable innovation lies. National and international platform The main projects in which the group is actively involved include those developed through technological clusters, like the 93 Framework Program 7 (2006 – 2013). 94 Jeremy Rafkin, op.cit. 95 Award established in 1911 (the first Collier Trophy was awarded to Glenn Curtiss for his successful development of the seaplane), which NAA gives each year for “the greatest achievement in aeronautics or astronautics in America, with respect to improving the performance, efficiency, and safety of air or space vehicles, the value of which has been thoroughly demonstrated by actual use during the preceding year”. 78 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Piedmont Aerospace District Fondo Europeo di Sviluppo Regionale (FESR) Piemonte (European fund for Piedmont regional development). Research project for innovative solutions to be applied to flight controls and actuators for “All Electric Aircraft” (AEA) with the aim of improving the performance of aircraft and reducing fuel consumption – hybrid flight control systems (HFCS). Partner – the Polytechnic University of Turin. MESAP (Mechatronic and advanced production systems) District - Research project for innovative solutions for electrohydrostatic circuits with applications in aerospace, avionics and robotics – Electro Hydrostatic Actuation for Industrial Automation and Vibration Control (EHA InAViCo). Partner – the Polytechnic University of Turin. The aim is to institutionalise intellectual property (IP) management activities (i.e., patent portfolio management, control of patent filing procedures, maintaining approved patents, protecting group know-how and monitoring technological competitors’ patent activities) and the related processes and consolidate them over time. To this end, during the past two years, the group has conducted, with increasing frequency, precedent research and the parent has set up an R&D COMMITTEE FOR PRODUCTS AND TECHNOLOGIES to: ◊ periodically monitor the road map of technological development and provide updates on road map progress; ◊ create a shared database of group companies’ know-how, promoting access thereto; ◊ lay the foundation for the optimisation of IP resources, including financial resources. During the year, the committee met once. The table below provides data summarising initiatives performed in the past three years 2014/15 2013/14 2012/13 Feasibility analysis and precedent research 2 3 2 International patent applications 1 1 - Supplementary type certificates (major changes) 3 3 3 58 63 67 Minor changes - Industria 2015. Development project for advanced electromechanical retraction actuation systems for helicopter landing systems. Partner – University of Pisa – Department of Aerospace Engineering. Using, managing and protecting intellectual property Very recently, new product development, which the group primarily conducts under contractual arrangements with public or private customers, underwent a structural change both in the sense that it now increasingly requires significant investments from the group and that is now allows for greater autonomy, rewarding originality and innovation in the proposal of solutions and applications. This development was concurrent with growth in in-house engineering expertise and the gaining of experience in certain types of products and technologies. Similarly, initiatives have been launched with a focus on subsequent steps in the vetting of grants for innovation that the group contributes, which can constitute intellectual property at various levels, from ordinary know-how to stronger design rights that are legally protected. MAG | Annual Report 2015 79 Annual report Translation from the Italian original which remains the definitive version Report of the auditors in accordance with article 14 of Legislative decree no. 39 of 27 January 2010 To the shareholders of Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. 1. We have audited the consolidated financial statements of the Mecaer Aviation Group as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015, comprising the statement of financial position, statement of comprehensive income, statement of changes in equity, statement of cash flows and notes thereto. The parent’s directors are responsible for the preparation of these financial statements in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards endorsed by the European Union. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audit. 2. We conducted our audit in accordance with the auditing standards recommended by Consob, the Italian Commission for Listed Companies and the Stock Exchange. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement and are, as a whole, reliable. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by directors. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion. Reference should be made to the report dated 23 December 2014 for our opinion on the prior year consolidated financial statements, which included the corresponding figures presented for comparative purposes. 3. In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements of the Mecaer Aviation Group as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015 comply with the International Financial Reporting Standards endorsed by the European Union. Therefore, they are clearly stated and give a true and fair view of the financial position of the Mecaer Aviation Group, the results of its operations and its cash flows for the year then ended. 4. The directors of Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. are responsible for the preparation of a directors’ report on the financial statements in accordance with the applicable laws. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the consistency of the directors’ report with the financial statements to which it refers, as required by the law. For this purpose, we have performed the procedures required by the Italian Standard on Auditing 001 issued by the Italian Accounting Profession and recommended by Consob. In our opinion, the directors’ report is consistent with the consolidated financial statements of the Mecaer Aviation Group as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015. Novara, 23 December 2015 KPMG S.p.A. Marco Boniardi - Director of Audit (signed on the original) Director’s report Group performance The group’s overall performance for 2014/2015 can be summarised as a slight decrease in volumes while overall profitability has significantly improved. The previous year was still affected by the discontinuation up of the AW101 line of the CCS division, at the Yeovil (UK) operating site, which was substantially completed in the first half of 2014. As described in the 2013/14 annual report, the foreign permanent establishment ceased to exist in 2014. The portion pertaining to the AW101 line, net of production revenue and cost, was slightly below €50 million in the three-year period 2011/12 – 2013/14, while the performance of revenue was more linear, with 2013/14 similar to 2011/12, up by approximately €11 million in 2014/15 compared to 2013/14. The activity peaks of this cycle were flanked by major diseconomies affecting the entire business and engineering structure, which was required to support particularly complex contracts, with different implementation factors and very short execution times. Similarly to last year, the group strategy that envisaged the use of mainly temporary resources for the Yeovil (UK) operating site mitigated the economic effects of the discontinuation. In terms of operational experience and technological expertise, the experience gained from such contracts gave the group a significant range of skills with potentially positive effects on future business developments. 2014/2015 saw the acquisition of significant contracts, such as Alenia Aermacchi’s HET Trainer M345 landing system, the first VIP interior for the AW189 or the Stylence/EMS special cabin interior for the Airbus H145. The ongoing evolution of the group’s strategies identified a common strategic area for the ALS (Actuation and Landing Systems) and the CCS (Cabin Comfort Systems) divisions, based on the offer of systems and components mainly to the OEM market. Consequently, it meets the requirements to become its own Strategic Business Unit (SBU), Integrated Aircraft Systems, which, however, internally preserves the two existing divisions, combined because of their similarity. 84 MAG | Annual Report 2015 In this respect, the AS division, created last year within the previous Maintenance and Completion division, continues to focus on the supply of services, both interiors and customised, and reconfiguration, maintenance and repair services, carried out directly on the aircraft. Consequently, it is a separate SBU, Aircraft Services, which represents an important element for the group’s medium/long-term business development. In terms of turnover, during the year, the Integrated Aircraft Systems SBU recorded a slight decrease in its overall value on the previous year, with significant growth in the ALS division product lines and a reduction in those related to the CCS division. With respect to the former, the increase in the production and sale of landing systems, in which the Gulfstream G4-G5-G650 and, in part the G7, lines built by the Canadian site, played a fundamental role, should be noted. The first flight of the Bell 525 Relentless mounting MAG’s landing gear took place in July 2015. With respect to the cabin interiors offered by the CCS division, as discussed in the introduction to this report, the comparison with the prior year is affected by the discontinuation of the AW101 line, net of which volumes are in line with 2013/14. The division is changing with a new focus on defining the reference strategic area and as a result of the diversification process involving products (with the expansion of the cabin management system range – e.g. environmental) and customers (with systems that, today, target a larger customer portfolio). For example, during the year, this process led to the delivery of the first interior kit for the Bell 525, while some interiors for the Airbus AH145 are being manufactured. The Aircraft Services SBU showed substantial stability although the maintenance and overhaul services, which are carried out at the Monteprandone site, remain closely related to trends in public spending by the public administrations (the National Forest Guard, Italian Tax Police and Air Force) which are the main clients. Considering the operating rigidities of the business line and the limited fungibility of the relevant resources, the volumes have a direct effect on profitability. MAG intends to maintain a portfolio offering an adequate saturation level of the facilities. During the year, some major contracts were renewed, such as that for the long-time industrial support to the NH500 aircraft used by the Air Force, or with the Ministry for Agriculture and Forestry for the same type of aircraft. The interiors services, which are mainly carried out at the operating sites in Philadelphia and Hagerstown, show growth in volumes on the previous year. In terms of design, which is a key aspect in the search for customised style solutions, the achievements of the year include the EASA certification of the first installation of the Bell 429 MAGnificent luxury interiors. Other achievements of the year include the International Yacht and Aviation Award with the Belvedere concept for the private jet category. Consolidated revenue for 2014/2015 exceeded €123 million, compared to €131 million in the previous year. Although volumes are not a priority, the group’s growth rate in the long-term can be measured with a CAGR96 for turnover in the past five years of approximately 5%. Revenue in foreign currency was generated against an appreciation of the US dollar against the Euro, which was particularly marked in the second half of the year and the volatility of the Canadian dollar against the Euro although the average values tend to converge. With an average exchange rate of 1.1464 for 2014/2015 (1.3564 in 2013/2014), the monthly average US dollar/Euro exchange rate hit its low in October 2014 (1.2823) and peaked in April 2015 (1.0552). With an average exchange rate of 1.4025 CAD/€ in the year (1.4625 in the previous year), the Canadian dollar’s monthly average reached its low in August 2015(1.5236) and peaked in April 2015 (1.3085). Revenue from sales in the year in foreign currency total ap96 Compound Annual Growth Rate. MAG | Annual Report 2015 85 proximately USD65.7 million and CAD0.4 million. [thousands of Euros or percentages] 2014/15 TR - Total revenue from core business 123.356 R - Revenue 133.104 The following table summarises total revenue from the core business during the year, analysed by the operating segments within the two business lines, which is how the group is structured. Additional information on revenue by operating and geographical segments is given in the notes to the consolidated financial statements (infra 3.4 Segment reporting). EBITDA . 2014/2015 2013/2014 2012/2013 2011/2012 Flight control systems and mechanical parts 32.342 29.881 24.002 27.510 Retractable landing and other hydraulic systems 31.432 26.092 24.901 21.459 Other products and mechanical processing 2.087 4.699 5.987 5.506 Hydraulic systems product support 6.637 5.999 6.978 5.347 Engineering 2.249 2.923 3.180 4.871 74.747 69.594 65.048 64.693 4.393 5.020 17.979 7.349 Completion of interiors with the supply of kits 23.756 37.124 45.624 29.887 Total CCS division 28.149 42.144 63.603 37.236 102.896 111.738 128.651 101.929 6.718 7.942 9.306 7.029 [thousands of Euros or percentages] Total ALS division Interior and non-structural components Total Integrated Aircraft Systems Interior services Overhaul and maintenance of aircraft and components 13.742 11.108 10.979 13.176 Total Aircraft Services 20.460 19.050 20.285 20.205 123.356 130.788 148.936 122.134 Group total In the Integrated Aircraft Systems business unit, revenue trends offset each other between the growth recorded by the ALS division, especially in relation to flight control and landing systems, and the reduction for the CCS division, almost entirely attributable to the completion of the AW101 line contracts. With respect to the systems of the ALS division, the expansion of the production range (e.g., landing gear for the G7 Gulfstream aircraft) and the increase in production contributed to a higher turnover. Furthermore, product support recorded positive results for the year with the group investing in resources and organisation for the future development of an area deemed strategic. Engineering revenue remains stable although its trend is strictly related to the type of new product development contracts which do not always generate revenue and, clearly, the progress of projects. Revenue-generating projects include that for the development of the landing system of Alenia Aermacchi’s M345 trainer aircraft, which will cover several years. Revenue of the CCS division remained steady if the AW101 effect is not considered which, in the first half of 2013/14, accounted for just under €15 million of turnover. With respect to diversification, for some segments, 2014/15 saw some important steps following the substantial completion of some development contracts (Inaer EMS and Bell 429 interior) which open up to new market segments for the supply of interior component kits. With respect to the AW101 line, the group entered into an agreement with AgustaWestland whereby MAG obtains a kind of exclusivity for the production of additional interiors, possibly in 2016, based on different economic and organisational factors from those for the 2012 – 2014 three-year period. This agreement relies on the skills developed by the group which substantially represent a competitive edge. The Aircraft Services business line recorded a positive year overall, growing on the previous year. Helicopter overhaul shows a more or less steady trend and the interior reconfiguration of the Part 145 gave a positive contribution. In this respect, the production of the first AW139 VIP interiors in the sites of the US subsidiary should be noted. Overall performance confirms that described earlier, with a change in turnover which, net of the completion of the AW101 contracts, points to an upward trend (5% CAGR 2010 – 2015). Meanwhile, the measures to improve organisation and obtain a more balanced saturation of production site, especially those located abroad, generated an increase in operating profitability, which was particularly strong in the year ended 30 September 2015. % of R 2013/14 % of R 130.788 2012/13 % of R 148.936 130.285 2011/12 % of R 122.134 166.536 129.515 16.213 12,2% 12.413 9,5% 16.811 10,1% 12.371 9,6% EBIT 9.979 7,5% 7.155 5,5% 12.328 7,4% 7.040 5,4% EBT 9.748 7,3% 5.664 4,3% 8.637 5,2% 5.911 4,6% Profit for the year attributable to the owners of the parent 6.285 4,7% 2.347 1,8% 2.577 1,5% 2.223 1,7% To give a better view of the performance of the year, profitability is normalised by eliminating non-recurring or exceptional items which do not relate to operations, shown in the table below. [thousands of Euros]] Description Grants related to income 251 Prior year income 672 Other non-operating income 113 Adjustment to the product warranty provision (115) Write-downs of inventories (E500) (784) Non-recurring expense E500 (176) Prior year expense (137) Total net non-recurring expense (176) In 2014/2015, adjusted EBITDA come quite close to the unadjusted value. An examination of the trend of this indicator throughout the most recent years shows an underlying trend towards the ongoing improvement of performance. [thousands of Euros or percentages] 2014/15 TR - Total revenue from 123.356 % of R 2013/14 130.788 % of R 2012/13 148.936 % of R 122.134 2011/12 core business 133.104 130.285 166.536 129.515 % of R R - Revenue 16.389 12,3% 13.604 10,4% 16.815 10,1% 13.323 10,3% Adjusted EBITDA 10.155 7,6% 8.346 6,4% 12.332 7,4% 7.992 6,2% Adjusted EBIT In the overall evaluation of profitability, the above-mentioned elements of discontinuation should be noted as well as the fact that the life cycle of the group’s products and services has not yet reached the maturity stage. The profitability of the systems still in a start-up stage is still affected by modest batches and experience curves. The after-market and product support, in general, show considerable development margins in the medium/long-term and do not account for a significant portion of revenue yet. Net financial expense was positively impacted by favourable exchange rates, specifically in relation to the US dollar, which appreciated against the Euro, and the Canadian dollar. These two currencies are functional currencies for the group companies. Interest and financial expense improved on the previous year thanks to the reduction of loans and debts and on-the-whole favourable interest rates. Indeed, the European Central Bank’s accommodating monetary policy continued throughout the year and in a context of weak growth with deflationary trends, the official rate has been kept at its all-time low of 0.05 points since September 2014 and generated a negative bank overnight deposit rate (-0.30 since 10 September 2014). Official ecb rate Start date 07/2011 11/2011 12/2011 07/2012 05/2013 11/2013 06/2014 09/2014 Rate 1,500 1,250 1,000 0,750 0,500 0,250 0,150 0,050 The three-month Euribor continued to decrease in 2015, with negative averages from May onwards. The general conditions of financial markets slightly improved compared to 2014 although the statistical figures indicate that the credit market is still struggling with high spreads that continue to be affected by the weak conditions of financial companies. The group’s financial position remains steady, with credit facilities totalling €106 million (bank credit facilities of €27 million 86 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 87 for cash or advances and credit facilities for trade receivables factoring of €79 million). At the reporting date, 31% of the bank credit facilities were used, while approximately 42% of the available facilities for the factoring without recourse of trade receivables were used. Thanks to its credit rating, the group can access credit with the main banking groups at prime rate conditions, while maintaining borrowing costs within satisfactory parameters. [in thousands of Euros] Interest and other financial income 2014/2015 2013/2014 2012/2013 2011/2012 301 371 325 26 1.918 939 (1.602) 2.650 (23) (47) (29) (1.216) (1.931) (2.367) (1.893) (1.946) Fees, commissions and other charges (496) (387) (492) (643) net financial expense (231) (1.491) (3.691) (1.129) (2.126) (2.383) (2.060) (2.563) Net exchange rate gains (losses) Interest expense on discounting Interest and other financial expense Net of exchange rate differences and discounting These parameters were analysed as part of the group’s financial risk management policy (see 5.3 Financial risk management). The debt to equity ratio, based on equity in the consolidated financial statements, reveals a balanced use of sources, showing very contained financial leverage. The debt to EBITDA ratio indicates that the group’s potential ability to repay its financial debt using operating profit is adequate. The table below provides liquidity ratios that, although affected by lower volumes with an impact on EBITDA in absolute terms, confirm that the group has maintained a balance of current sources and application of funds. Interst cover ratio DEBT TO EQUITY 2014/2015 2013/2014 2012/2013 2011/2012 0,58 0,75 0,46 0,43 DEBT TO EBITDA 1,72 2,62 1,15 1,37 DEBT TO ADJ. EBITDA 1,70 2,39 1,15 1,27 2011/2012 liquidity ratios parametro 2014/2015 2013/2014 2012/2013 current ratio 2,04 1,71 1,61 1,57 acid test ratio 0,99 0,95 0,67 0,83 At the reporting date, the group held financial instruments hedging interest rate risk; (see 4.2.4 Derivatives). In the consolidated statement of financial position, net non-current assets are in line with those of the prior year due to the continuation of significant investing activities (€8,517 thousand in property, plant and equipment and intangible assets), against amortisation/depreciation (€4,825 thousand) and an increase in non-current loans and borrowings (€2,747 thousand). The group’s policy is aimed at maintaining a balance between non-current sources and applications of funds (see Statement of cash flows). The group continues to invest heavily in the development of new products (these activities increased by €5,581 thousand, net of grants and tax credits), with an impact of roughly 4.5% on consolidated revenue. This is above the averages for the sector, but is a distinguishing feature of the group’s development process. The section on research and development activities (see Development of new products) also includes detailed information on the main projects and their funding, given that certain projects have received government assistance to support innovation. Investments are essential to create and maintain a competitive edge and ensure continued growth above the market average levels of comparable competitors. Current non-financial assets increased mainly due to the trend in work in progress, (€2,188 thousand) in parallel with the progress of the overhaul and interiors contracts in place at year end, while trade receivables decreased significantly (-€9,540 thousand). At the previous reporting date, the latter’s balance was considerably high due to the delay in some cash inflows. The trend in current assets was also the result of a decrease in trade payables (-€10,343 thousand). Closing net financial debt decreased on the previous year end by €4.7 million. The decrease is entirely related to the non-current portion. Additional details on the composition of net financial debt are provided in the notes (see 9.1 Net financial debt). Statement of financial position highlights [in thousands of Euros] A- NET NON-CURRENT ASSETS B- NET CURRENT ASSETS C- POST EMPLOYMENT BENEFITS AND PROVISIONS 2014/2015 2013/2014 2012/2013 2011/2012 32.020 30.217 25.116 23.076 56.876 58.757 48.269 45.862 (12.646) (12.851) (12.456) (12.957) D- INVESTED CAPITAL 76.250 76.123 60.929 55.981 E- EQUITY 48.402 43.593 41.659 39.086 F- NET FINANCIAL DEBT 27.848 32.530 19.270 16.895 G- TOTAL AS IN D 76.250 76.123 60.929 55.981 88 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 89 Alternative (“NON IFRS”) performance ratios To provide a better understanding of the group’s performance in the year ended 30 September 2015, in addition to conventional ratios presented in accordance with IFRS, this report provides certain performance ratios to supplement and not replace - conventional ratios. The ratios used are detailed below. Profitability ratios EBITDA (Earning Before Interests, Taxes, Depreciation and Amortisation – from continuing Operations). The parent uses this ratio as a target for internal management control and in presentations to analysts and investors. It serves as a unit of measure to evaluate operating performance. Profit for the year ++ Current and deferred taxes ++ Financial expense/(financial income) ++ Non-recurring expense/(non-recurring income) ++ Amortisation, depreciation and accruals ++ Impairment losses/(reversals of impairment losses). ADJUSTED EBITDA takes account of non-recurring or exceptional items. EBIT (Earning Before Interests and Taxes – from continuing Operations) or Adjusted Gross Operating Profit. Profit for the year ++ Current and deferred taxes ++ Financial expense/(financial income) ++ Non-recurring expense/(non-recurring income) ++ Impairment losses/(reversals of impairment losses). L’ADJUSTED EBIT takes account of non-recurring or exceptional items. 90 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Financial ratios NET FINANCIAL DEBT (Net financial position)97. This ratio is used to indicate the group’s more general financial position.Liquid funds (bank and postal accounts, cash and cash equivalents, cheques) ++ Securities in portfolio and liquid funds (or equivalents) ++ Current financial assets -- Bonds -- Current and non-current bank loans and borrowings -- Other bank loans and borrowings and/or other loans that generate financial expense -- Future lease payments to the lease companies recognised using the financial method (IAS 17). DEBT TO EQUITY RATIO. The ratio, which shows the balance between borrowed and venture capital and the level of capitalisation, compares net financial debt to equity. CURRENT RATIO. This is a liquidity ratio expressing the ratio of current assets to current liabilities. ACID TEST RATIO. Highlights of main consolidated companies The following notes provide information on other group companies by operating segment, including their financial highlights stated under IFRS, drawn from the respective financial statements. Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. Within its group, the company acts as parent responsible for centralised activities. It also carries out production activities on the helicopter and small jet market. MAG is the result of the combination of previous corporate and operating sites that, in line with the group’s organisation, report to two main operating segments, comprised of divisions. The Integrated Aircraft Systems operating segment which focuses on the supply of systems and equipment for OEMs, comprises the ALS (Actuation and Landing Systems) and the CCS (Cabin Comfort Systems) divisions, while the Aircraft Services operating segment provides a wide range of services for standard aircraft and coincides with the division of the same name. The table below summarises core revenue by business line, as they are structured within the two operating segments. This ratio measures the group’s ability to repay current debt. It is the ratio of cash plus current assets to current liabilities. Mixed ratios DEBT TO EBITDA RATIO. The ratio, which is also frequently used the other way round, shows the group’s ability to repay its financial liabilities by using the gross operating profit. 97 See also the notes to the consolidated financial statements – see 9.1 NET FINANCIAL DEBT. MAG | Annual Report 2015 91 2014/2015 2013/2014 2012/2013 2011/2012 Flight control systems and mechanical parts 32.343 29.881 24.002 27.510 Landing and other hydraulic systems 13.496 15.713 15.762 15.278 Other products and mechanical processing 2.097 4.866 6.108 5.710 Hydraulic systems product support 5.237 4.480 5.695 4.086 Engineering 1.526 1.298 1.600 4.247 54.699 56.238 53.167 56.831 [thousands of Euros or percentages] Total ALS division Interior and non-structural components 4.393 5.020 17.979 7.029 Completion of interiors with the supply of kits 26.759 39.280 47.294 32.270 Total CCS division 31.152 44.300 65.274 39.300 Total Integrated Aircraft Systems 85.851 100.538 118.441 96.131 Overhaul and maintenance of aircraft and parts 7.702 9.052 9.610 12.332 Total Aircraft Services 7.702 9.052 9.610 12.332 93.553 109.590 128.051 108.463 Total In 2014/2015, the revenue of the Integrated Aircraft Systems operating segment fell short of that of the previous year, and was down significantly in the CCS division. In 2013/2014, the latter’s revenue included approximately €15 million generated by the AW101 line manufactured at the foreign permanent establishment of Yeovil (UK), which substantially ceased operations in the first half of 2014. Net of this event, which accounted for almost €10 million in 2011/2012, approximately €26 million in 2012/2013 and €15 million in 2013/2014, revenue shows a more linear trend with a substantial stability in the ALS division and a slight reduction in the CCS division. These phenomena accompanying the changes to the product mix, especially in relation to interiors, where a diversification process is in underway ultimately leading to an expansion of the product range (EMS, VIP KIT interiors) and the penetration of new market segments, are also the result of cross-selling activities vis-à-vis new customers within which MAG is present through the ALS division projects (landing and hydraulic systems, flight controls). Engineering revenue relates to non-recurring fees for the development of new products. Its performance is directly correlated to the percentage of completion of engineering projects. The actual figure for the year was generated by various contracts, including the landing system of the M345 trainer. line and the UK operating site, which was burdensome for the entire division, are no longer present. In fact, the production sites efficiency measures, including through improvement business plans and partial reorganisation (e.g., lean manufacturing), generated benefits in terms of process flows and margins from the manufactured systems. These processes are also implemented with an increased integration of foreign sites into the activities of the two divisions comprising the Integrated Aircraft Systems operating segment. The parent’s net financial debt is balanced and, considered overall, representative of most group assets. Net non-current assets increased in step with investing activities, which mainly relate to new product development (€5,657 thousand, net of grants) and fixed capital (€880 thousand). Financial investments were carried out in the investees during the year (€5,000 thousand and €1,250 thousand to increase the share capital of Mecaer America Inc. and SAT S.p.A., respectively), partly in capital injections and partly by allocating financial assets to capital, by converting loans into capital. Net current assets decreased on the previous year, mainly due to the effect of the reduction in trade receivables (€12,283 thousand), which were particularly high at 30 September 2014, partly offset by the decrease in balance of trade payables (€9,435 thousand). Contract work in progress increased by €2,192 thousand, reflecting the above effect of the increase in the production of the Aircraft Services operating segment. Closing net financial debt decreased (€3.515 thousand) on the previous year. During the year, it complied with expected levels and is mainly non-current. Statement of financial position highlights [in thousands of Euros] 30 September 2015 30 September 2014 30 September 2013 30 September 2012 34.687 A- net non-current assets 55.399 47.317 41.968 B- net current assets 40.276 46.806 34.626 34.151 (12.530) (12.751) (12.366) (12.866) C- post employment benefits and provisions D- invested capital 83.145 81.372 64.228 55.972 E- equity 54.676 49.388 45.401 38.152 Additional information in this respect is provided in the section below on development projects, in which the project managed by the parent, including through its subsidiaries, are described (see Development of new products). F- net financial position 28.469 31.984 18.827 17.820 G- total as in D 83.145 81.372 64.228 55.972 In the Aircraft Services operating segment, maintenance and overhaul activities did not perform particularly well. These activities mainly take place at the Monteprandone (AP) service station, where the volume of activities is affected, also in terms of timing, by how often public administrations decide to avail of maintenance as part of the long-term contracts entered into with the company. In this respect, these activities suffered a delay especially in the first half of the year, which was recovered in the last few months of the year. Some long-term aircraft categories (e.g., 3,000 h) were also subject to unscheduled activities that envisaged significant changes to the contracts. Mecaer America Inc. Mecaer America manufactures mechanical and hydraulic parts for airplanes and helicopters. Accordingly, it reports to the Integrated Aircraft Systems operating segment, specifically, the ALS division. The production site is located in the aerospace industrial district of Laval (Quebec), and it is specialised in the construction of landing gear and related retraction systems for helicopters and airplanes. Consequently, turnover was lower, although production revenue remained in line with prior years. The global economic performance was positive since the significant improvement in operating profit offset the effect of the reduction in volumes. [thousands of Euros or percentages] TR - Total revenue from core business R – revenue EBITDA EBIT 2014/15 % of R 2013/14 % of R 2012/13 % of R 2011/12 93.553 109.589 128.051 108.463 100.805 108.914 141.233 114.921 % of R 13.304 13,2% 12.381 11,4% 16.761 11,9% 14.525 12,6% 9.244 9,2% 8.989 8,3% 14.075 10,0% 11.556 10,1% EBT 8.588 8,5% 7.237 6,6% 12.084 8,6% 5.864 5,1% Profit for the year 5.164 5,1% 3.987 3,7% 7.249 5,1% 2.438 2,1% It also provides maintenance and overhaul services (MRO) for components and systems. Recent years have seen a lengthy start-up phase and development projects for new products. These have required substantial investments, production and industrial activities. Over the past three years, the company’s and the group’s strategy focused on the integration between make to design projects, which are characterised by long-term development cycles and have a great potential over the long term, and make to print projects, that suit the specialist skills acquired by Mecaer America, especially in the landing system field but, can be launched more rapidly and, therefore, contribute to the achievement of the break even point. These results are mainly due to the fact that some diseconomies generated by the peak of activities related to the AW101 2014/2015 saw the company achieve and surpass the financial stability thresholds included in the business plans for the 2015/2016 two-year period. This is the result of the increase in production of the main projects in which the company is involved (e.g., Gulfstream G4, G5, G650) and the start of production of new products (G7, Bell 429), to which the appreciation of the US dollar contributed. Indeed, a signification portion of revenue is generated in this currency. MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 92 93 Operating profit was positively affected by the volume effect and the series of business efficiency measures launched in the previous year and in parallel with the repositioning of the William Price – Laval site. In the budget for 2015/2016, volumes are expected to continue to grow and profitability is set to increase, in line with the trend highlighted since the year ended 30 September 2015. In these financial statements, the company prudently increased the allowance for the write-down of inventories - spare parts and systems, for the E500 and One Aviation E550 aircraft (formerly Eclipse Aerospace Inc.). Following the CAD1,250 thousand increase, the allowance amounts to CAD4,862 thousand compared to inventories of CAD5,871 thousand. The accrual is due to a lower absorption rate of finished goods of the year, compared to prior estimates. Nevertheless, the reduced absorption is due to a time shift mainly attributable to the recovery of the very light jet segment, and the fact that the customer still had a stock of landing gear, which is now depleted. The prospects for future projects are still encouraging since the customer confirmed the production plans, supported by a growing backlog. During the year, this interest was extended to the Marche region, which is favourable to an airfield that is suitable for the construction of a base for the Civil Protection. This region is willing to cover the residual investment necessary to complete work by disbursing a grant related to assets. Cumulative investments up to 30 September 2015 total approximately €8.6 million, of which €6.4 million refers to the airfield whose first section (a length of 800 metres), with drainage pavement, was completed during the year. Final costs are estimated at an additional €1.5 million and relate to the extension of the airstrip with asphalt for its full length (1,499 metres) and related works to reinforce, control rainwater and improve the functioning of the control tower. According to the business plan, works are expected to be completed in 2017. SAT has the necessary work authorisations and, to date, there are no constraints that may prevent the completion of works. During the year, the company obtained the authorisation to build a variation which will expire in 2016, unless extended. Furthermore, the state concessions necessary to control rainwater were obtained from the Ascoli Piceno municipality. The company’s engineering expertise in the retractable landing system segment, based on the use of hydraulic and electromechanical technologies, represents a pillar for the group. The group is particularly interested in building this infrastructure because it will help develop the activities of the business line that reports to the Aircraft Services operating segment. Indeed, in the group’s business plan, the airfield availability plays a strategic role for a series of projects to diversify the supply of services in this operating segment by extending to the fixed-wing aircraft industry. Therefore, 2014/2015 ended with increased EBITDA, a profit for the year for the first time and a net financial position of CAD1,440 thousand. In this respect, the business development opportunities that have been included in the long-term plan, show adequate conditions to recover investments in the medium/long-term period. The business plan that covers the next three years confirms a consolidation of the viability of management and shows cash flows adequate to ensure the recoverability of investments. The company closed the year with performance slightly above that of the previous years, although it is still undergoing start-up and was entirely focused on investing activities. The €5,000 thousand share capital increase was carried out by the parent during the year as resolved in 2014. [thousands of Canadian dollars or percentages] 2014/15 % of R 2013/14 % of R 2012/13 % of R 2011/12 TR - Total revenue from core business 38.997 34.022 23.988 20.212 R – Revenue 39.257 34.174 29.480 21.252 % of R EBITDA 3.657 9,3% (766) (2,2)% (1.741) (5,9)% (3.109) (14,6)% EBIT 1.401 3,6% (3.143) (9,2)% (3.915) (13,3)% (6.055) (28,5)% EBT 1.270 3,2% (3.390) (9,9)% (5.916) (20,1)% (4.335) (20,4)% Profit/(loss) for the year 1.270 3,2% (3.390) (9,9)% (5.916) (20,1)% (5.017) (23,6)% Having reached satisfactory revenue levels, profitability is in line with that of the business lines of the group’s more mature and consolidated facilities, although there is still room for improvement. In 2014/2015, Mecaer America posted taxable income for the first time. However, it prudently did not recognise deferred tax assets on prior year tax losses which, net of the portion falling due in the tax period covered by these financial statements, amount to CA31,302 thousand and CAD31,125 thousand for federal and provincial taxes, respectively. SAT Società Aeroporto del Tronto S.p.A. [thousands of Euros or percentages] 2014/15 TR - Total revenue from core business 155 R – Revenue 155 EBITDA 35 % of R 2013/14 % of R 155 25 % of R 155 155 22,6% 2012/13 18 % of R 140 155 16,1% 2011/12 140 11,6% (8) (5,7)% EBT (22) (14,2)% (38) (24,5)% (49) (31,6)% (67) (47,9)% Loss for the year (28) (18,1)% (40) (25,8)% (51) (32,9)% (67) (47,9)% Mecaer Aviation Group Inc. This company has its registered office in Wilmington, Delaware and two operating sites based in Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, near the Philadelphia North East Airport, and in Hagerstown, Maryland. Furthermore, it can operate in New Jersey in respect of some aircraft maintenance contracts. Finally, it has a sales office in Irving, Texas, located in the Dallas-Fort-Worth aerospace district. Its mission is to provide aircraft maintenance and overhaul services and interiors and regulation services, which make up the core business of the Aircraft Services operating segment. Its main customer remains the US related company AgustaWestland (AW Philadelphia Corp.) with which a contract for the supply of the interiors of the AW119 and AW139 aircraft is in place. This company’s mission is to promote, create and manage airfields, helicopter landing pads and airports within the province of Ascoli Piceno and Italy. Accordingly, it focuses on developing communications in its local area. As part of the strategic areas identified by the group, the company falls under the Aircraft Services segment. Since its inception, the company has implemented an investment plan with the aim of building an airport mainly to serve the industrial site, with possible repercussions for the surrounding area, particularly in terms of the potential development of general aviation locally. However, a strong development is underway. Indeed, in 2014/2015, a significant portion of activities was carried out for other customers. This related to maintenance (e.g., New Jersey State Police and Maryland State Police) and interiors services. In April 2015, MAG Inc.’s first VIP interior was completed at the Hagerstown site. A local public body (the Ascoli Piceno municipal authorities) has invested in the company, demonstrating institutional interest in building the infrastructure, in a local context where infrastructure is lacking. The performance of the year was affected by some inefficiencies attributable to the first VIP contracts which required reworking and, more generally, the increase in the operating costs related to the opening of the Maryland site when saturation was not complete. During the year, MAG Inc. personnel accidentally severely damaged the tail boom of a New Jersey police plane under maintenance. The repair costs (approximately USD949 thousand) were fully covered by the aviation policies in place, although these amounts had a negative effect on the performance of the year. MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 94 95 However, an overall financial balance was maintained and the results achieved were in line with expectations. The target for the current year is to improve the industrial efficiency of sites. [thousands of US dollars or percentages] 2014/15 TR - Total revenue from core business 15.732 R – Revenue 18.423 % of R 2013/14 % of R 14.009 2012/13 % of R 14.701 14.240 2011/12 % of R 10.667 15.201 10.821 EBITDA 779 4,2% 1.018 7,1% 1.742 11,5% 527 4,9% EBIT 127 0,7% 694 4,9% 1.527 10,0% 384 3,6% Profit for the year 590 3,2% 714 5,0% 647 4,3% 947 8,7% Net financial position amounts to USD570 thousand at 30 September 2015. MAG Inc. represents a frontier in the development of the group’s business that intends to invest in the expansion of this operating segment, focusing, in particular, on the North American market which offers good potential for the industry as a whole and as a line of development for Aircraft Services in particular. Development of new products Activities to develop new products relate to the preparations before their production launch. The group dedicates substantial resources to new product development activities and traditionally distinguishes between: ◊ technological research and development or ◊ applied research and development. The group’s active or completed development projects focus closely on products and, as such, mainly fall under the latter category. These activities are part of projects that are contractually governed with aircraft manufacturers. They are technically and economically very feasible. In certain cases, the group handles the complexity of the technological contributions necessary through joint ventures and partnerships with OEMs or leading companies in the aerospace structure and system integration industry. The group’s commitment to this investment plan is crucial to its growth strategy and has proven to be a decisive factor in increasing its expertise, internationalisation and gradual entry to market segments as a global competitor. In most cases, a development project begins with specific technologies provided by customers and moves forward to encompass the design stage, prototyping, tests and trials, then obtaining aerospace certification and beginning production. Certain projects receive government assistance aimed to support innovation and technological development, mainly under the following legislation: ◊ Law no. 808 of 24 December 1985; ◊ Law no. 46 of 17 February 1982; 96 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 97 ◊ Law no. 296 of 27 December 2006 (and Law no. 244 of 24 December 2007). These laws, and especially Law no. 808/85 which relates to the sector, perform the irreplaceable function of meeting high investment costs required by projects. The accounting treatment for these costs, which is detailed in the notes to the consolidated financial statements (see 4.1.1.1 Research and development costs), is in line with industry practice. It provides for the deferral of the costs until the results of development become available for use. When this condition is met, which is unequivocally upon final certification of the aerospace product by the relevant authorities, the costs are depreciated on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful life of each product. Moreover, the length of the cycle of innovation and actual economic prospects for products developed make it possible to separately identify, control and recover the investments from when they are incurred. If these aspects cannot be adequately demonstrated, as in the case of activities conducted primarily for applied research, the costs incurred are expensed in the same period. The areas in which the most recent new product development projects have been conducted coincide with certain specific segments under two operating segments: A) INTEGRATED AIRCRAFT SYSTEMS The first operating segment is divided into two divisions: Actuation and Landing Systems and Cabin Comfort Systems. The former mainly relates to landing systems, for which the group is committed to extending its ability to integrate and design certain strategic sub-systems, such as electromechanical feedback actuators, wheels and brakes, steering commands and, more generally, innovation in materials and processes. This division also includes actuators and flight controls, in relation to which the group is focused on expanding its offer to encompass hydraulic and electromechanical servoactuators, and, eventually, wire flight control. The second division has seen many advancements in vibration and sound reduction, infotainment and cabin comfort (i.e., air conditioning and humidity). The second operating segment includes, in addition to applying materials and components (CCS) innovations to interiors customisation, all ergonomics, style and industrial design solutions, where innovation is the core business of the Aircraft Services operating segment. purpose AW149. a complete hydraulic landing system for Bell Helicopter’s 525 Relentless, a medium lift two-turbine utility helicopter. Following AgustaWestland’s request, the group began examining the design of a complete light and adaptive flight control and damper system in 2006, i.e., a system capable of changing its damping characteristics depending on the flight conditions. The project, carried out in partnership with the Polytechnic University of Turin, is being completed and the first devices were produced during the year. a. ACTUATION AND LANDING SYSTEMS i. ELECTRO MECHANICAL ACTUATOR PROJECT The project’s objective is the study, design and testing of an electro mechanical actuator for retracting landing gear for helicopters weighing up to 4,500 kg, according to the EASA CS/FAR Parts 27 and 29 specifications. It is focused on the use of technologies (electromechanical) more reliable than the more traditional ones (hydraulic) and eco-friendly materials featuring high structure stability of parts combined with weight reduction and lower energy consumption. The project is being carried out in collaboration with an industrial partner and the Department of Aerospace Engineering, University of Pisa. The project obtained the assistance provided for by the “Bando Industria 2015” call for proposals (new technologies for made in Italy products) granted by the Ministry of Economic Development. During the year, the project was substantially completed with the integration of the electric engine with the electronic control unit and an extensive schedule of trials to obtain qualification for the retraction gear. ◊ Integrated Aircraft Systems, ◊ Aircraft Services. 98 Information is provided below on the progress of the main projects, which, at the reporting date, were still underway or had been recently completed. The following section provides additional information about the projects eligible for assistance under Law no. 808/85 and already completed in the years prior to 2014/15. The group is pursuing several commercial opportunities in respect of the project’s potential business applications. ii. BELL 429.PROJECT. LANDING SYSTEM This project relates to the development of retractable landing gear for Bell Helicopter Textron’s B429 aircraft and was completed in 2014 when the certification was received from Transport Canada (TC) and the Brazilian authorities (ANAC). Production began at the Canadian site in 2015. The first flight using MAG’s landing system took place in July 2015. Aircraft certification is scheduled for 2016. This project is eligible for government assistance pursuant to Law no. 808/85, as it relates to national security. At the reporting date, these systems were still unsold and, consequently, no royalties were recognised in this annual report. According to the aircraft manufacturer’s schedule for AW149 helicopters, the first deliveries will take place in 2017. iv. AW 609 CONVERTIPLANE PROJECT This project began as a partnership between AgustaWestland and Bell Helicopter, involving the study, design and development of a convertiplane, i.e., an aircraft with the mixed features of a helicopter and an airplane. The project draws on the group’s experience in the military tilt rotor helicopter field gained in Italy and the US. The project has been has stopped and started over the years and went through a stage in which its content was partially redefined. The group’s share consists of the pitch control system which the Agusta-Bell consortium assigned to the Hydraulic Research group (“HR”), the international leader of the primary and secondary hydraulic flight controls sector, along with control systems and flight commands with fly-by-wire actuator assist, given the complexity. The group’s work carried out to date was regulated by agreements with HR, which subsequently merged into the Woodward group. Later on, following the AgustaWestland’s acquisition of the entire project, a proposal was made to intensify The helicopter is a light twin-engine, previously equipped with skids, and its new configuration was certified in 2014. the collaboration with a view to expanding the group’s role, especially with reference to the landing system. The skills developed by the group to date as part of this project have a potentially interesting effect on both current projects and future projects to be acquired. At present, a waiver from the FAA is pending for the operation of heavier aircraft. This project is eligible for government assistance pursuant to Law no. 808/85, as it relates to national security. This project is self-financed, with the exception of work related to the revision of additional specifications and the construction of prototypes. At the reporting date, the project was still underway and no sales have been made. Consequently, no royalties were recognised in this annual report. iii. AW149 PROJECT. LANDING SYSTEMS v. BELL 525 (RELENTLESS). LANDING SYSTEM These projects cover different systems used on the multi- This project involves the study, design and development of MAG | Annual Report 2015 The group’s Canadian engineering department is mainly responsible for this project. vi. AH160 PROJECT. LANDING SYSTEM This project involves the study, design and development of the main systems of the hydraulic landing gear for the AH160 (formerly X4) Airbus Helicopters’ new generation aircraft, which should replace the EC155 in 2017. The AH160 helicopter is a twin engine aircraft of medium size, in the 9,000-11,000 pound category, and is highly innovative in terms of technology, with the use of by wire commands, and noise and fuel consumption. The group’s Canadian engineering department is mainly responsible for this project. vii.ELECTRO HYDROSTATIC ACTUATION FOR INDUSTRIAL AUTOMATION AND VIBRATION CONTROL (EHAINAVICO) MESAP PROJECT This project involved the development of a technology, based on hydraulic circuits (electrohydrostatic or “EHA”), with multiple applications in the aerospace industry and, in particular, the helicopter sector, because of the compactness and low weight to power ratio. The project, which was completed during the year, was carried out with three industrial partners and in collaboration with the Polytechnic University of Turin, and received a grant from the Piedmont Region. Since its industrial application is not immediate, no project costs have been expensed. viii.HYBRID FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM (HFCS) PROJECT The project involved the development of innovative solutions for small aircraft flight control, based on fly-by-wire functionalities, for the utilities, business, general aviation, aerobatics, trainers and UAV segments. In particular, it involves the construction of electromechanical actuators using optic fibre sensors. The group is pursuing some commercial opportunities which may come to fruition in 2016. The project, which was completed in 2015, is part of the Piedmont Region’s operating programme set out in FESR 2007/2013. MAG | Annual Report 2015 99 ix. ADVANCED FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM (AFCS) PROJECT The new technologies were subsequently installed on several helicopters (EC145-T2 and BELL 429). The project involved the development of a new primary flight control system for trainer aircraft (AFCS). The project is being carried out in collaboration with the Polytechnic University of Marche (Ancona). The project was carried out as a joint venture with Finmeccanica Selex ES (formerly Selex Galileo S.p.A.), under an agreement with the Ministry of Defence - General Directorate of Air Armaments, which provides that the latter covered 50% of the cost. The first stage was completed with Italian Air Force approval. iii. BELL 429 INTERIORS PROJECT The group also began the preliminary steps to patent certain parts of the device, as permitted by contract. x. BELL 505. SYSTEMS PROJECT The project relates to the development of a series of hydraulic gear (reservoir, servo-actuator) for the Bell 505 aircraft’s actuator gear and secondary mechanical flight controls. The Bell 505 helicopter, which was initially called SLS (Short Light Single) is a light single engine aircraft currently under development by Bell Helicopter Textron, with certification expected by early 2016. The group’s development project entails the customer’s contribution in the non-recurring investment. B) CABIN COMFORT SYSTEMS This project concerned the development of customised interiors for the Bell 429 aircraft, in several configurations that resulted in specific product brands, such as the Bell 429 MAGnificent. It was fully self-financed and was completed during the year when the related STC were received. iv. AW189 INTERIORS PROJECT This project concerned the development of customised interiors for the AW189 aircraft in several configurations. It was fully self-financed and was completed in November 2015 when the related STC were received Tale programma è stato completamente autofinanziato. v. AW139 INTERIORS RESTYLING PROJECT This project concerns the development of new configurations for the customised interiors of the AW139 aircraft. It began in the last few months of the year and is expected to be completed in 2016. B) i. EMS INTERIORS PROJECT AIRCRAFT SERVICES i. INDUSTRIAL DESIGN This project relates to customised installations of medical, auxiliary and support devices and structures, for EMS (Emergency Medical System) use in rescue helicopters, air ambulances and medical missions via air. It was fully self-financed and was completed during the year when the related STC were received starting from October 2014. During the year, the first HEMS interiors kits were delivered. These activities partly complement cabin comfort developments, integrating innovative systems (e.g., cabin management systems). However, they also express an industrial design often associated with specific product brands. Indeed, the group has launched a number of measures to protect brands and proprietary design. ii. CABIN MANAGEMENT SYSTEM PROJECT Created within the family of cabin comfort projects, the project is aimed at integrating new technologies in line with consumer technological content. In the aerospace industry, the transfer of these technologies is often a problem given the safety requirements imposed by sector regulations. During the year, progress was made, especially on proprietary software, in integrating wireless technologies, wireless remote control systems, mobile wifi, audio/video streaming and up-loading and position identification, in helicopters. The prototypes were subject to aviation standards (RTCA DO 160). 100 The Aircraft Services operating segment focuses on style and innovative design, developed as part of the research into customised solutions for the luxury interiors of both helicopters and fixed-wing aircraft. C) OTHER PROJECTS ELIGIBLE FOR ASSISTANCE UNDER LAW NO. 808/85 The following section provides information about some development projects completed in prior years which benefited from assistance under Law no. 808/85. i. AW101 UTILITY PROJECT. FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM nical flight controls for the mid-heavy EH101 military helicopter, which was built under a specific agreement between the Italian and English governments. The group currently provides the mechanical flight control system in a kit, comprising groups of rods, levers and rotors for this helicopter, in configurations that have undergone dramatic technological changes over time. This project benefited from government assistance under Law no. 808/85, as it related to national security. At the reporting date, total sales amounted to €23,879 thousand (2014/2015: €2,917 thousand), while royalties totalled €734 thousand (2014/2015: €65 thousand). ii. AIRBUS A380 PROJECT. STEERING CONTROL MANIFOLD This project was launched in 2002 for the customer UTAS (Goodrich Landing Gear) for the design of a hydraulic component for the main landing gear of the Airbus A380. The main project was completed with the aircraft’s certification by EASA and the US FAA in December 2006. Additional projects were subsequently carried out to improve the system’s functionalities, with changes to its configuration. Minor system upgrading activities are still underway. This project benefited from government assistance under Law no. 808/85 as it was of “European interest” as defined by CIPE resolution of 26 March 2006. At the reporting date, total sales amounted to €8,213 thousand (2014/2015: €1,426 thousand), while royalties totalled €365 thousand (2014/2015: €63 thousand). iii. AW139 PROJECT. INTEGRATED ENERGY DISSIPATION SYSTEMS The project, which refers to CCS division, concerned the development of solutions that reduce acoustic impact inside the AW149 military aircraft cabin. This project benefited from government assistance under Law no. 808/85, as it related to national security. At the reporting date, no sales incorporating the newly developed technology had been made. Consequently, no royalties were recognised in this annual report. Like for the systems for this aircraft, the customer AgustaWestland expected the first deliveries to take place in 2017. The AW101 project (formerly EH101 Utility), completed in 2001, concerned the definition and development of mecha- MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 101 Corporate governance disclosure Disclosure on management and coordination and transactions with group companies The following paragraphs provide corporate governance information. Additional information is given in the sections Corporate governance and business conduct and In accordance with the provisions of articles 2497 and 2497-septies of the Italian Civil Code, it is noted that MAG acts as holding company for the group companies in which it directly or indirectly owns 100% investments. Accordingly, it is required, inter alia, to prepare consolidated financial statements and it also manages and coordinates its subsidiaries. Risk management and compliance. Disclosure required by legislative decree No. 231/2001 on the administrative liability of companies The parent’s board of directors adopted the organisation, management and control model for the company and its group pursuant to Legislative decree no. 231/2001 with the resolution passed on 11 December 2007. The board of directors approved subsequent amendments thereto on 10 June 2011 and 21 February 2013. These principles are also found in the fair balancing of social and group interests, justification for the resolutions passed by the subsidiaries’ management bodies and the representation of the subsidiaries’ operations. By resolution of the board of directors on 30 March 2012, the supervisory board’s duties were entrusted to the board of statutory auditors in accordance with Law no. 183/2011, which amended article 6 of Legislative decree no. 231/2001. Where such decisions affect the group companies’ performance, they are fully disclosed in the financial statements. Four meetings were held during the year. Disclosure required by legislative decree No. 196/2003 on the protection of personal data In accordance with the provisions of paragraph 26 of the Technical Regulations regarding security, included as Appendix B to Legislative decree no. 196 of 30 June 2003 (Personal Data Protection Code), the group updated the Data Protection Document on 28 March 2011 in accordance with article 34.g) of Legislative decree no. 196 of 30 June 2004 and subsequent modifications and integrations. 102 These management and coordination activities, which are typical of group companies, ensure that the group companies’ decisions are consistent, coordinated and in line with the group’s strategic guidelines. Each of the methods in which the parent manages and coordinates its subsidiaries is based on the principles of integrity and transparency. MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG is not managed or coordinated by another entity pursuant to article 2497-bis of the Italian Civil Code. Intragroup transactions are of a trading and financial nature. Overall, they do not consist of significant amounts. The following table summarises amounts generated by the parent’s transactions with other group companies in the year and infragroup balances at 30 September 2015, which were eliminated in the preparation of the group’s consolidated financial statements. Furthermore, information relating to the related party SBI S.p.A. is presented. Data on other related parties is given in the specific section of the notes (see 9.2 Related party transactions). In accordance with the provisions of article 2497-bis of the Italian Civil Code, the statement of financial position and statement of comprehensive income highlights of MAG’s most recently approved financial statements are provided in the notes to the financial statements of the Italian companies that it controls. These consolidated financial statements are filed, along with the separate financial statements, with the Company Registrar, even for group companies that have opted to apply the exemption from mandatory preparation of consolidated financial statements under article 27.3 of Legislative decree no. 127/91. For additional details on the group’s structure and subsidiaries, reference should be made above (see Highlights of main consolidated companies). MAG | Annual Report 2015 103 (in thousands of Euros) SAT Mecaer America Inc. Mecaer Aviation Group Inc. Revenue from goods and services - 1.236 3.002 - Other revenue and income 3 340 53 20 Acquisition of intangible assets - 38 - - Purchase of raw materials - 1.850 615 - Services - 4.443 354 - 155 - - 1.386 Financial income - 79 148 - Loans and receivables due WITHIN one year 6 944 7.465 25 Loans and receivables due AFTER one year - 2.252 - - Liabilities due WITHIN one year - 1.726 982 - Use of third party assets MAG carries out trading transactions with the subsidiary Mecaer America, as the latter is the sub-contractor for the supply of hydraulic systems of the AW109, AW139 and AW380 landing systems. During the year, Mecaer America’s engineering unit carried out product development activities totalling €3,918 thousand on behalf of MAG. Since 2006/2007, MAG and Mecaer America have a service centre agreement in place whereby the Canadian subsidiary ensures repair and maintenance on MAG products in the North American market. These activities, which are part of the parent’s contractual commitments, are performed by Mecaer America, which holds valid airworthy certification for that market, for an annual fixed fee. Under the agreement, Mecaer America carries out the services under warranty and pays Mecaer a royalty of 7% of realised turnover for repair and maintenance activities covered by the agreement. In addition, under this agreement, MAG also supplies Mecaer America with parts and components for MRO activities on MAG’s proprietary products. Total sales of goods to the subsidiary Mecaer America in 2014/2015 amount to roughly €1,236 thousand and also include parts for the A380 project, which Mecaer America, sub-supplier of the final system, is required to buy from MAG. Financial transactions with Mecaer America are limited to the loan that the parent granted the Canadian subsidiary, which shows an outstanding amount of USD2,523 thousand at 30 September 2015. Interest accrues on the loan at market rates, linked to LIBOR. MAG supplies its subsidiary MAG Inc. with AW119 and AW139 interior aircraft kits, worth approximately €3,002 thousand in 2014/2015. SBI Information on treasury shares, group company shares and share capital No group company holds any treasury shares or those of their parents, either directly or indirectly through trustees or nominees, or acquired, sold or held any of these shares during the year. MAG’s share capital is fully subscribed and paid-up. At 30 September 2015, it totals €13,138 thousand and is divided into 13,138 thousand shares with a nominal amount of €1 (one) each. There are no stock option plans in place, nor are there securities granting special rights, employee equity interests or restrictions to MAG voting rights at 30 September 2015. arm’s length basis. In this respect, since 2010/2011, each year, MAG has prepared the internal transfer pricing documentation pursuant to article 1.2-ter of Legislative decree no. 471 of 18 December 1997, introduced into Italian legislation by article 26 of Law decree no. 78 of 31 May 2010, converted, as modified, by Law no. 122 of 30 July 2010 (the “Dossier”). The purpose of the Dossier is to document how transactions between the group companies are governed on an arm’s length basis in accordance with OECD guidelines. There are no other infragroup financial transactions or transactions involving royalties (other than those mentioned above) or management fees. Disclosure on transactions with related parties Reference should be made to the notes to the separate and consolidated financial statements for information on transactions with related parties 6.10 Current loans and receivables - Related parties, 6.15 Cash and cash equivalents - Related parties, 6.20 Loans and borrowings, 6.24 Current financial liabilities - Related parties, 7.2 Other revenue and income, 7.8 Use of related party assets, 7.12 Financial income and expense. The sections on Other Information in the notes to the consolidated financial statements and separate financial statements detail transactions with directors, statutory auditors and CEOs of MAG (see 9.2 Related party transactions). MAG has an airport services outsourcing agreement in place with SAT. This agreement entailed the payment of a fixed fee of €155 thousand in the year. Events after the reporting date This information is provided in the sections on Other Information in the notes to the consolidated and separate financial statements (see 9.4 Events after the reporting date; 7.3 Variation in finished products, work in progress and semi-finished goods). Outlook The year ended 30 September 2015 was a year of transition which reabsorbed the effects of the discontinuation after the peak of activities related to the AW101 line. Moreover, it was characterised by the substantial return to volumes of activities consistent with a steady development path. Furthermore, the Canadian production site is now fully up and running with adequate volumes and profits substantially in line with those recorded by the business lines of the reference segment. Finally, integration between operating sites continued in line with a consistent operating criterion. All transactions with group companies are carried out on an 104 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 105 The next few years, starting from the current one, will be focused on the consolidation of these results, by strengthening the sites’ ability to respond in order to support the production start-ups scheduled and anticipate the needs for quantitative growth, organically and with a view to possible acquisitions. As envisaged by the business plan, the 2015/16 investment plan provides for the completion of some important projects which are now in their final stage and increasing environmental certification. The group’s current order backlog adequately covers the budgets for 2015/2016 which forecast a further improvement in profitability, compared to the previous year, and a steady financial position. Proposal of the board of directors to rhe shareholders The Managing Director proposes that the board of directors ◊ submit the separate and consolidated financial statements included in this annual report to the shareholders for their approval during the ordinary meeting; ◊ with reference to the separate financial statements, considering the disclosures provided therein, submit the proposal for the allocation of the profit for the year of €5,288,155 to the legal reserve (€264,408) and other reserves (€5,023,747) to the shareholders. On behalf of the board of directors Claudio Brun Managing Director (signed on the original) 106 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 semptember 2015 Consolidated financial statements Statement of financial position (1/2) (in thousands of Euros) Description Note 30.09.2015 30.09.2014 Difference Intangible assets 6.1 33.348 30.652 2.696 Property, plant and equipment 6.2 15.556 15.602 (46) Equity investments 6.3 9 8 1 Deferred tax assets 6.4 2.796 2.455 341 Other non-current assets 6.5 2.231 3.351 (1.120) Other non-current assets - related parties 6.6 205 205 - 54.145 52.273 1.872 Total non-current assets 110 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Inventories 6.7 51.153 51.044 109 Contract work in progress 6.8 5.639 3.451 2.188 (9.540) Trade receivables 6.9 27.944 37.484 Current loans and receivables - related parties 6.10 25 28 (3) Tax assets 6.11 512 1.376 (864) Other current assets 6.12 7.107 9.598 (2.491) Current financial assets 6.13 - 2.967 (2.967) Cash and cash equivalents 6.14 16.261 14.887 1.374 Cash and cash equivalents - related parties 6.15 1.596 1.034 562 Assets classified as held for sale and directly associated liabilities 8 - - - Total current assets 110.237 121.869 (11.632) Total assets 164.382 174.142 (9.760) MAG | Annual Report 2015 111 Statement of financial position (2/2) (in thousands of Euros) Description Note Share capital Share premium reserve Other reserves Profit for the year Equity attributable to the owners of the parent Share capital and reserves attributable to non-controlling interests Loss for the year attributable to non-controlling interests Share capital and reserves attributable to non-controlling interests Difference 13.138 13.138 - 5.564 5.564 - 22.949 22.060 889 6.285 2.350 3.935 47.936 43.112 4.824 468 484 (16) (2) (3) 1 466 481 (15) Total equity and 6.16 48.402 43.593 4.809 6.17 1.791 2.200 (409) Provisions 6.18 2.532 1.985 547 Deferred tax liabilities 6.19 8.323 8.666 (343) Non-current loans and borrowings 6.20 24.281 24.370 (89) Non-current loans and borrowings - related parties 6.20 2.836 - 2.836 Other non-current liabilities 6.21 22.125 22.056 69 61.888 59.277 2.611 Advances from customers 6.22 2.228 1.259 969 Current loans and borrowings 6.20 17.076 26.270 (9.194) Current loans and borrowings - related parties 6.20 1.512 778 734 Trade payables 6.23 25.020 35.363 (10.343) Current financial liabilities - related parties 6.24 258 - 258 Tax liabilities 6.25 972 786 186 Other current liabilities 6.26 7.026 6.816 210 Liabilities directly associated with assets held for sale 8 - - - 54.092 71.272 (17.180) Total liabilities 115.980 130.549 (14.569) Total equity and liabilities 164.382 174.142 (9.760) Total current liabilities MAG | Annual Report 2015 30.09.2014 Employee benefits - post-employment benefits Total non-current liabilities 112 30.09.2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 113 Statement of comprehensive income (in thousands of Euros) Description Note 30.09.2015 30.09.2014 Net revenue 7.1 123.356 130.788 704 Other revenue and income 7.2 1.730 Other revenue and income - related parties 7.2 20 20 Variation in finished products, work in progress and semi-finished goods 7.3 2.039 (8.924) Increase in internal work capitalised 7.4 5.959 7.697 Raw materials, consumable and supplies 7.5 (43.419) (40.163) Services 7.6 (35.727) (41.898) Use of third party assets 7.7 (1.853) (1.630) Use of related party assets 7.8 (1.394) (1.393) Personnel expense 7.9 (33.384) (31.595) Amortisation, deprecation, accruals and impairment losses 7.10 (6.234) (5.258) Other operating costs 7.11 (1.114) (1.193) 9.979 7.155 Operating profit Financial income 7.12 2.219 1.310 Financial expense 7.12 (2.260) (2.572) Financial expense - related parties 7.12 Profit before tax Income taxes 7.13 (190) (229) 9.748 5.664 (3.465) (3.317) Profit for the year 6.283 2.347 - Attributable to the owners of the parent 6.285 2.350 - Attributable to non-controlling interests (2) (3) 0,48 0,18 Earnings per share 7.14 Other comprehensive income (expense) that will be subsequently reclassified to profit or loss Net exchange rate losses on the translation of foreign operations (1.598) (196) Income taxes on other comprehensive income (expense) - - Other comprehensive income (expense) that will not be subsequently reclassified to profit or loss - - 124 (217) Ias 19 effect recognised directly in equity 6.17 Other comprehensive expense, net of income taxes 114 MAG | Annual Report 2015 (1.474) (413) Total comprehensive income 4.809 1.934 - Attributable to the owners of the parent 4.811 1.937 - Attributable to non-controlling interests (2) (3) MAG | Annual Report 2015 115 Statement of cash flows (in thousands of Euros) Description Note 30.09.2015 30.09.2014 A 9.1 18.888 3.572 9.748 5.664 6.234 4.713 (251) (9.922) Opening net cash and cash equivalents Profit before tax Amortisation, depreciation and impairment losses 7.10 Variation in net working capital B Net variation in employee benefits - post-employement benefits 6.17 (285) 41 Net variation in the provision for risks and charges 6.18 (359) 462 Net variation in deferred taxes 6.4/6.19 (694) (554) Current taxes 7.13 (3.076) (4.555) Deferred taxes 7.13 694 562 12.011 (3.806) Cash flows from (used in) operating activities Net investments in non-current assets C 116 MAG | Annual Report 2015 - Intangible 6.1 (5.957) (7.011) - Property, plant and equipment 6.2 (2.560) (4.122) - Financial assets 6.3 (1) - - Other investing activities 6.5 1.120 1.319 - Assets/liabilities held for sale 8 - - (7.398) (9.814) Cash flows used in investing activities Variation in current loans and borrowings – new loans 6.20 937 19.368 Variation in current loans and borrowings - settlements 6.20 (9.397) (4.995) Variation in non-current loans and borrowings – new loans 6.20 13.324 18.408 Variation in non-current loans and borrowings - settlements 6.20 (10.577) (4.205) Variation in other non-current liabilities 6.21 69 360 Share capital increase 6.16 - - Variation in the hedging reserve 6.16 - - Ias 19 effect recognised directly in equity 6.16 - - Variation in translation and other reserves 6.16 - - (5.644) 28.936 D Cash flows from (used in) financing activities E Cash flows of the year 9.1 (1.031) 15.316 F Closing net cash and cash equivalents 9.1 17.857 18.888 MAG | Annual Report 2015 117 Statement of changes in equity (in thousands of Euros) Description Equity at 30.09.2013 Other Reserves Hedging reserve Profit for the year Equity attributable to the owners of the parent Equity attributable to non-controlling interests Total 13.138 5.564 19.090 1 3.399 41.192 467 41.659 - - 3.400 (1) (3.399) - - - Capital injections from noncontrolling owners - - - - - - - - Profit for the year - - - - 2.350 2.350 (3) 2.347 Reclassifications - - (17) - - (17) 17 - Translation differences - - (196) - - (196) - (196) Ias 19 effect recognised directly in equity - - (217) - - (217) - (217) Other comprehensive expense - - (413) - - (413) - (413) 13.138 5.564 22.060 - 2.350 43.112 481 43.593 Allocation of profit for the year - - 2.350 - (2.350) - - - Capital injections from noncontrolling owners - - - - - - - 6.283 Profit for the year - - - - 6.285 6.285 (2) Reclassifications - - 13 - - 13 (13) - Translation differences - - (1.598) - - (1.598) - (1.598) Ias 19 effect recognised directly in equity - - 124 - - 124 - 124 - - (1.474) - - (1.474) 13.138 5.564 22.949 - 6.285 47.936 Other comprehensive expense Equity at 30.09.2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Share premium reserve Allocation of profit for the year Equity at 30.09.2014 118 Share capital MAG | Annual Report 2015 (1.474) 466 48.402 119 Notes to the consolidated financial statements 1. Overview 2. Basis of preparation The parent, Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. (“MAG S.p.A.” or “MAG”) is a company limited by shares. It was set up in Italy and is registered with the company registrar of Novara. Under the option provided for by Legislative decree no. 38 of 28 February 2005 and as in previous years, the consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015 have been prepared in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”), endorsed by the European Commission and included in EU regulations. The MAG group supplies systems for helicopters and small aircraft and provides the related aircraft interiors and completions services, as well as maintenance and overhaul services. MAG S.p.A.’s registered office is in Via per Arona, 46, Borgomanero (Novara), where some corporate functions are also located. The group conducts its business activities in eight different locations, four of which in Italy [Borgomanero, Novara; Monteprandone, Ascoli Piceno; Vergiate, Varese and Rome] and four abroad [Laval, QC, Canada; Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, USA; Hagerstown, Maryland, USA and Irving, Texas, USA] as described in more detail in the directors’ report. Figures in these notes are provided in thousands of Euros. The board of directors submitted these consolidated financial statements to the shareholders for approval on 22 December 2015. The acronym IFRS also refers to all revised Standards (“IAS”) and the interpretations of the International Financial Interpretations Committee (“IFRIC”), formerly known as the Standing Interpretations Committee (“SIC”). The consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015 comply with IFRS. The section of these notes concerning Other Information includes the disclosures required by IAS 1.96(d). At the time when these notes were prepared, adjustments and interpretations by official bodies with respect to certain aspects were still pending. Accordingly, additional changes or integrations could be made to the Standards and interpretations that could require or allow the MAG group to change the recognition, measurement and classification criteria adopted in the preparation of these consolidated financial statements. As permitted by IAS 1, the statement of comprehensive income has been prepared presenting costs by nature, highlighting the operating profit and profit before taxes. To better measure the performance of continuing operations, expense and revenue arising from significant events or transactions are indicated separately. The statement of financial position has been prepared by separating current assets and liabilities from those that are non-current and by recognising any assets and liabilities held for sale and discontinued operations separately, in accordance with IFRS 5. 122 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 123 Specifically, an asset or liability is classified as current when it meets any of the following conditions: ◊ it is expected to be realised or settled or is held for sale or consumption in the normal course of the group’s operating cycle; ◊ it is held primarily for trading purposes; ◊ it is expected to be realised or settled within twelve months of the reporting date. If none of these conditions is met, the asset or liability is classified as non-current. The statement of cash flows has been prepared using the indirect method, whereby the operating profit is adjusted by the effect of non-monetary transactions, any deferrals or accruals of previous or future collections or payments in relation to operating activities and any expense or revenue relating to cash flows arising from investing or financing activities. Income and expense on non-current loans, the related hedging instruments and any dividends paid are included under operating activities. The statement of changes in equity shows the following changes in equity captions, where applicable: ◊ allocation of profit for the year; ◊ owner transactions (repurchase or sale of treasury shares); ◊ any gains or losses, net of the tax effect, recognised directly in equity (gains or losses on the repurchase/sale of treasury shares) or that have a balancing entry in an equity reserve (e.g., share-based payments for stock option plans); ◊ changes in the hedging reserve, net of any tax effect; ◊ changes in the fair value reserve; ◊ effects of any changes in the accounting policies. 3. Basis of consolidation 3.1 Consolidation methods and scope The consolidation scope includes the subsidiaries, i.e., entities for which the parent has the power to govern the financial and operating policies so as to obtain benefits from their activities98. In ascertaining whether or not the parent has control, potential voting rights that could be exercised are also considered. The group has not set up any special purpose entities as defined by SIC 12 nor has it carried out any business combinations as defined by IFRS 3. There are no associates, joint ventures or jointly controlled companies in which the group companies are investors. The consolidated financial statements at 30 September 2015 include the financial statements of the parent, MAG S.p.A., and its direct and indirect subsidiaries, which are detailed below. Their statement of financial position highlights are also provided.99100101102 Company Headquarters Company investor Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. Borgomanero (NO) – Italia - Mecaer America Inc.99 Laval (QC) – Canada MAG S.p.A. SAT Società aeroporto del Tronto S.p.A.100 Monteprandone (AP) - Italia MAG S.p.A. Mecaer Aviation Group Inc.101 Wilmington (DE) – USA102 MAG S.p.A. 98 Reference should also be made to the notes for details on the systematic criteria applied “4.1.3 Equity investments” on page 132 (see). 99 (“Mecaer America”) 100 “SAT S.p.A.” or “SAT”. 101 “MAG INC.”, formerly SEI of America Corp. 102 Operating sites in Philadelphia (Pennsylvania), Irving (Texas) and Hagerstown (Maryland). 124 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 125 Company MAG S.p.A. Mecaer America SAT S.p.A. MAG Inc. Owner ship % Share capital Currency Method of consolidation - 13.138.000 EUR Line-by-line 100,00 84.656.157103 CAD Line-by-line 93,94 8.250.000 EUR Line-by-line 100,00 1.467.000 USD Line-by-line The results of operations reported by any subsidiaries acquired or sold during the year are included in the statement of comprehensive income from the date of acquisition or up to the date of sale.103 There are no companies excluded from consolidation. The draft financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015, approved by the respective boards of directors have been used for consolidation purposes. They have been reclassified and, where necessary, adjusted for alignment with the group accounting policies. The subsidiaries’ financial statements are consolidated on a line-by-line basis, which entails taking the full amount of assets, liabilities, income and expense of each company, regardless of the investment held. The following main adjustments have been made to consolidate the statement of financial position and statement of comprehensive income captions: ◊ elimination of the carrying amount of the parent’s investments in companies included in the consolidation scope and corresponding portions of equity; ◊ elimination of intragroup receivables and payables and income and expense arising on intragroup transactions; ◊ gains and losses arising on intragroup equity transactions are also eliminated if material. All adjustments consider the related deferred tax effect, where applicable. The portion of equity of consolidated subsidiaries attributable to non-controlling interests is recognised separately from equity attributable to the owners of the parent. It is determined based on the percentage of ownership of assets and liabilities recognised at the date when the interest was originally acquired and considering variations in equity since that date. 103 Mecaer America’s equity also includes a contributed surplus of CAD2,735,782. 126 3.2 Translation of foreign currency captions and financial statements of foreign operations Balances included in the statement of financial position and statement of comprehensive income of each group company are recognised in the currency of the primary economic environment in which the company operates (functional currency). or losses relating to the ineffective portion of the hedge are taken to profit or loss. If the hedged portion of the foreign operation is sold, total exchange rate gains or losses relating to that foreign operation are removed from equity and taken to profit or loss as an adjustment to the gain or loss on the sale. The exchange rates applied in the translation of financial statements prepared in foreign currency are as follows: The group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in Euros, which is the parent’s functional currency. Amounts expressed in currencies other than the functional currency, whether they are monetary (cash and cash equivalents, assets and liabilities to be received or settled in established or determinable monetary amounts, etc.) or non-monetary (advances to suppliers of goods and/or services, goodwill, intangible assets, etc.) are initially recognised at the exchange rate ruling when the transaction is performed. Subsequently, monetary amounts are translated into the functional currency at the closing rate and any differences arising from translation are taken to profit or loss. Non-monetary amounts are maintained at the exchange rate ruling at the date of the transaction, unless continuing adverse economic trends affect the rate, in which case exchange rate gains or losses are recognised in profit or loss. The rules for the translation of captions from local foreign currency into the presentation currency, with the exception of currency in hyper-inflationary economies (which do not affect the group) are as follows: ◊ assets and liabilities, including the prior year corresponding figures, are translated at the closing rate; ◊ costs and revenue, income and expense, including the prior year corresponding figures, are translated at the average exchange rate of the year or at the rate ruling at the date of the transaction if this varies significantly from the average rate of the year; ◊ exchange rate gains or losses arising from the translation of statement of comprehensive income captions at a rate that differs from the closing rate and from the translation of opening equity at a rate that differs from the closing rate are taken to the translation reserve. Goodwill and fair value adjustments relating to the acquisition of foreign operations are recognised as assets and liabilities of the foreign operation and translated at the closing rate. Exchange rate gains or losses arising from the translation of a financial liability hedging a net investment in a foreign operation are taken directly to equity (translation reserve) to the extent that the hedge is effective. Exchange rate gains MAG | Annual Report 2015 Average rate of the year Closing rate 2014/2015 2013/2014 2014/2015 US dollar 1,1464 1,3564 1,1203 1,2583 Canadian Dollar 1,4025 1,4625 1,5034 1,4058 currency 3.3 2013/2014 Use of estimates The preparation of the consolidated financial statements and related notes in accordance with IFRS requires the group to make estimates and assumptions with an effect on the carrying amounts of recognised assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the reporting date. Actual results may differ from these estimates. The estimates and assumptions are periodically revised and the effects of any changes are taken to profit or loss. Estimates mainly relate to the captions listed below with reference to their section in the notes. Note Research and development costs 6.1 Goodwill 6.1 Inventories 6.7 Contract work in progress 6.8 Trade receivables 6.9 Derivatives 4.2.4 Income taxes 6.4 - 6.19 - 7.13 Employee benefits - post-employment bemefits 6.17 Provisions for risks and charges 6.18 3.4 The MAG group’s business activities may be divided into two main operating segments, which comprise organisational structures, including divisions. a) The Integrated Aircraft Systems related to the development and production of systems for OEMs104, which comprise, because of similarity, the pre-existing divisions: i. the Actuation and Landing Systems (“ALS”), whose product lines include safety critical systems, specifically landing gear, flight controls, actuators, dampening and hydraulic systems, ii. the Cabin Comfort Systems (“CCS”), whose product lines include cabin technical/functional systems (noise-vibration reduction systems, environmental optimisation systems, cabin management); b) Aircraft Services, che ha per oggetto un insieme di servizi destinati al velivolo standard, finalizzati a rendere disponibile al cliente od operatore una piattaforma customizzata e funzionale alla specifica missione (elaborazione di soluzioni stilistiche personalizzate, di installazione KIT, di manutenzione e riparazione di velivoli e loro parti). As permitted by IFRS 8.12, the ALS and the CCS divisions have been combined into one reportable segment (Integrated Aircraft Systems) because of their similarity. Their distinctive feature is essentially the type of offer (systems) and the target market. The Aircraft Services remains a segment and coincides with the relevant division. Its core activity comprises a range of services which includes installation kits as well as aircraft design, completion, refurbishment and MRO. Turnover analysed by operating and geographical segment is presented below. For the purposes of comparison, prior year figures were restated in accordance with IFRS 8.30. Segment reporting Information on the performance of the group’s operating and geographical segments is provided below, in accordance with IFRS 8, on the basis of available financial statements data and in line with the main policies used to periodically examine the segment results at the highest decision-making level in order to evaluate performance. 104 Original Equipment Manufacturer. MAG | Annual Report 2015 127 MAG group – revenue by operating and geographical segment (in thousands of Euros) 2014/2015 Int. Aircraft Systems Europe – eurozone Europe - non-eurozone North america Rest of the world Total 2013/2014 Eur/000 % Eur/000 % 70.091 68,1% 82.315 73,7% 1.862 1,8% 2.336 2,1% 30.213 29,4% 24.197 21,6% 730 0,7% 2.891 2,6% 102.896 100,0% 111.738 100,0% 2014/2015 Aircraft Services Europe – eurozone % Eur/000 % 7.702 37,6% 9.052 47,5% - - - - 12.758 62,4% 9.998 52,5% - - - - 20.460 100,0% 19.050 100,0% Europe - non-eurozone North america Rest of the world Total 2013/2014 Eur/000 2014/2015 Total Europe – eurozone Europe - non-eurozone North america Rest of the world Total Eur/000 % Eur/000 % 77.793 63,0% 91.367 69,9% 1.862 1,5% 2.336 1,8% 42.971 34,8% 34.194 26,1% 730 0,7% 2.891 2,2% 123.356 100,0% 130.788 100,0% MAG group – Performance by operating segment (in thousands of Euros) Integrated aircraft systems 2014/15 2013/14 Aircraft services 2014/15 2013/14 Unallocated 2014/15 2013/14 2014/15 2013/14 110.921 111.533 22.765 18.881 - - 133.596 130.415 segment expense (89.266) (93.893) (20.350) (15.686) (12.726) (12.247) (122.342) (121.826) 21.655 17.640 2.325 3.196 (12.726) 12.247) 11.254 8.589 20% 16% 10% 17% N/A N/A 8% 7% as a % of revenue 2013/14 Aircraft Services 2014/15 Unallocated 2013/14 2014/15 Total 2013/14 21.655 17.640 2.325 3.196 (12.726) 139 (161) - - - 68 - - net non-operating income/ (expense) (1.746) (1.181) (94) - 425 cons. operating profit (loss) 20.048 16.367 2.231 3.196 (12.301) (12.247) 2014/15 2013/14 11.254 8.589 - 139 (161) - - 68 (160) (1.415) (1.341) (12.407) 9.979 7.155 differences in accounting policies: development costs goodwill Non-operating income and expense mainly refer to non-core economic components, of an exceptional or non-recurring nature. The following table summarises assets and liabilities. Integrated Aircaft systems 2014/15 2013/14 Aircaft Services 2014/15 2013/14 Unallocated 2014/15 Total 2013/14 2014/15 2013/14 segment assets 105.874 112.719 26.809 24.475 31.699 36.948 164.382 174.142 segment liabilities (48.944) (56.597) (2.756) (3.986) (112.682) (113.559) (164.382) (174.142) segment investments 6.957 9.667 1.174 742 386 724 8.517 11.133 amortisation, depreciation and impairment losses 4.265 4.029 501 265 465 419 5.230 4.713 Prior year figures were restated in order to separately present the assets and liabilities related to the Aircraft Services segment, where possible. At 30 September 2014, the latter’s assets and liabilities – which coincide with the relevant division – were presented together with those of the CCS division (currently combined with the Integrated Aircraft Systems segment) since they were hardly separable. Total segment revenue segment operating profit/(loss) Integrated Aircraft Systems 2014/15 segment operating profit/ (loss) 2013/2014 The group’s results, in terms of the revenue and profitability of its operating segments, are summarised in the table on the following page. With respect to the previous year, the figures related to the Integrated Aircraft Systems segment were restated. Specifically, some overheads were reallocated. Description description The performance of the Integrated Aircraft Systems segment improved on the previous year end mainly following the achievement of an adequate level of operating profit by the Canadian site, which is now in line with the group’s sector standards. The performance of the Aircraft Services segment improved mainly thanks to the positive volumes recorded, in particular, by the US sites where the first VIP interiors were manufactured. “Other activities”, which included the investments and the assets under construction related to the airfield, were also combined with the Aircraft Services segment. Infrasegment transactions are immaterial and, accordingly, have not been shown separately. The above assets do not include current and non-current financial assets, other current and non-current assets, tax assets, deferred tax assets and cash and cash equivalents. Liabilities do not include equity, current and non-current borrowings, deferred tax liabilities, other current liabilities, tax liabilities and employee benefits. The trade payables related to the Aircraft Services segment are presented separately only to the extent of the portion which could be distinguished by supplier or type of transaction. The following table provides a reconciliation of the segment operating profits or losses, as calculated for decision-making purposes, with the operating profit recognised in the consolidated financial statements (see Statement of comprehensive income) 128 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 129 4. Main accounting policy The accounting policies applied to the most important captions are described below. 4.1 Non-current assets 4.1.1 Intangible assets Intangible assets are identifiable non-monetary assets without physical substance that generate future economic benefits for the group. They are recognised at purchase or production cost, including directly related charges incurred to prepare them for use, net of accumulated amortisation and any impairment losses. Amortisation begins when the asset becomes available for use and is calculated systematically over the residual useful life of each asset. Amortisation is calculated considering the actual use of the asset in the year in which an intangible asset is initially recognised. Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are not amortised. The amortisation periods of intangible assets are summarised in the table below. Reference should be made to the note to each caption for specific details on the identification criteria. amort. period (years) development costs product useful life industrial patents and intellectual property rights 5 licences 3 software 3 goodwill indefinite useful life other deferred costs term of agreement 4.1.1.1 Research and development costs Costs for research, undertaken to gain new scientific or technical knowledge and understanding, are taken to profit or loss when incurred. 130 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Costs for development provide for a plan or design for the production of new or substantially improved products or processes. Development costs are capitalised if, and only if, the cost can be reliably measured and estimated, the product or process are technically and commercially feasible, future economic benefits are probable and the group has the intention as well as adequate technical and financial resources to complete the development and use or sell it. Specifically, this caption entirely relates to costs incurred for the development of new aerospace products. These costs, which are identifiable and can be measured, relate to specific development projects commissioned by customers or arising from the group’s participation in international projects. They are highly technically and commercially feasible and the group can reasonably demonstrate that they will generate future economic benefits. The portion of internal and external development costs exceeding the related revenue to be received from customers is capitalised against each project as development costs and is amortised over the period in which the group reasonably expects that the future benefits will arise. In determining the useful life of each aerospace product developed, the group considers the following: ◊ the estimated useful life of the aircraft or the versions of the aircraft on which the product will be used, on the basis of sales plans provided by the manufacturer; ◊ the estimated useful life of the specific product, also considering its technological features and conditions of use. Amortisation is calculated on a straight-line basis. The amortisation period begins when the products become available for use, which unequivocally coincides with the definitive certification of the product or aircraft to which it refers by the relevant bodies and authorities. Costs incurred for projects eligible for the assistance provided by Law no. 808 of 24 December 1985105 and consi105 [Official Gazette ed. 005 of 8 January 1986] “Interventi per lo sviluppo e l’accrescimento di competitività delle industrie operanti nel settore aeronautico”. dered functional to “national security” and similar costs are recognised net of the related benefits (see 5. Significant matters - 5.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to Law No. 808/85). 4.1.1.2 Industrial patents and intellectual property rights Industrial patents and intellectual property rights are recognised at acquisition cost, net of amortisation and any impairment losses accumulated over time. They are amortised starting in the year in which the right that the group has acquired becomes available for use. Amortisation is calculated over the shorter of the period of expected use and the period for which the right has been acquired. 4.1.1.3 Licenses, concessions and trademarks These include the following: ◊ concessions, i.e., public administration measures giving private entities the right to exclusively use public assets or manage public services under regulated conditions; ◊ licences attributing the right to use patents or other intangible assets over a determined or determinable period of time; ◊ licences to use know-how, application software or the rights of others; ◊ trademarks identifying the origin of products from a specific company. The costs, including direct and indirect expenses incurred to obtain these rights, are capitalised after the rights have been acquired and are amortised systematically over the shorter of the period of expected use and the period for which the right has been acquired. 4.1.1.4 Goodwill Goodwill arises from business combinations and reflects an excess in the acquisition cost of the business or business unit over the total fair value of acquired assets and liabilities and identified contingent liabilities. MAG | Annual Report 2015 131 As it has an indefinite useful life, goodwill is not amortised. Instead, it is tested for impairment at least once a year to verify if it has undergone impairment losses, which are taken immediately to profit or loss and cannot be reversed, even within the limits of previous impairment. Goodwill on acquisitions that took place before transition to IFRS continues to be recognised at its carrying amount under Italian GAAP and is tested for impairment from that date. 4.1.2 Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are measured at purchase or production cost, net of accumulated depreciation and any impairment losses. Cost includes direct charges incurred to prepare assets for use and any dismantlement and removal costs incurred to restore the site to its original conditions. Costs for ordinary and/or routine maintenance and repairs are taken directly to profit or loss when incurred. Costs for improvements and maintenance that materially increase the production capacity or safety of assets or that prolong their useful lives are capitalised as an increase in the carrying amount of the assets to which they relate. Any government grants or grants relating to assets are taken as a direct decrease in the cost of the asset to which they relate. The carrying amount of each asset is depreciated on a systematic basis. Depreciation is calculated on a straight-line basis each year over the residual useful lives of assets. The useful lives and depreciation criteria are periodically reviewed and, where material changes are noted with respect to the assumptions previously made, the depreciation rate is adjusted on a prospective basis. An asset’s useful life is generally confirmed each year and adjusted if there have been improvements or replacements affecting its useful life. The rates applied to reflect useful lives are reduced by half in the year in which assets go into use, since this reduction is considered adequately indicative of the weighted average period of use from when the assets went into use to the end of the year. The following table lists depreciation periods for each item of property, plant and equipment. Deprec. period (years) land indefinite useful life buildings and airstrips 30 – 35 light constructions 10 generic plant – non-automated machines 10 automated machines 5–6 automated robotic machines 4–5 electrolyte and galvanic cells 5 furnaces and accessories 6–7 generic equipment 4 specific equipment 4 inspection and testing tools 3–5 electronic office machines 5 furniture and furnishings 8–9 motor vehicles 4 internal means of transport 5 If a depreciable asset is comprised of separately identifiable components with useful lives that differ significantly from the other components comprising the asset, depreciation is calculated separately for each component, using the component approach. Profits and losses on the sale of assets or groups of assets are measured by comparing the selling price with the related carrying amount. Costs incurred to expand, upgrade and improve structural components of third parties are capitalised solely to the extent to which they meet the requirements for separate classification as assets or components of assets. These costs are recognised as leasehold improvements and are classified under property, plant and equipment, according to their nature. The depreciation period is the shorter of the asset’s residual useful life and the term of the lease or free loan agreement. 4.1.3 Equity investments The group classifies its equity investments as follows: ◊ subsidiaries, over which the investor has the power to govern the financial and operating policies so as to obtain benefits from its activities and which are consolidated and, therefore, eliminated; ◊ associates, over which the investor has significant influence (at least 20% of votes in the ordinary shareholders’ meeting). Jointly controlled entities (e.g., joint ventures) are included in this category; ◊ parents, when the investor holds shares of its parent; ◊ other companies that do not fall into any of the above categories. Any equity investments held for sale, such as those that are acquired solely for the purpose of disposal within twelve 132 MAG | Annual Report 2015 months, are classified separately as “assets held for sale”. 4.1.5 Equity investments held for sale are measured at the lower of cost and fair value less costs to sell. Assets (or disposal groups) are defined as held for sale when their carrying amount will be recovered through disposal rather than through continuous use, as long as the sale is highly probable. The table in the first section of the notes to the consolidated financial statements summarises equity investments (see 3 BASIS OF CONSOLIDATION) and details the criteria used to identify the figures used for the purposes of consolidation. 4.1.4 Impairment losses At least once a year, the group tests the recoverability of the carrying amount of intangible assets, property, plant and equipment and investments in subsidiaries and associates to determine whether they have undergone impairment. If there is evidence of impairment, the carrying amount of the asset is reduced to its recoverable amount, which is the greater of fair value less costs to sell and the asset’s value in use. In particular, in evaluating whether there have been any impairment losses on investments in subsidiaries and associates106, the recoverable amount is defined as value in use, which is the present value of estimated cash flows based on the investee’s expected results and the estimated proceeds from the ultimate disposal, in accordance with the provisions of IAS 28. Assets classified as held for sale Assets (or disposal groups) remain classified as held for sale even if there are delays or postponements in the period necessary for the finalisation or conclusion of the sale, as long as the delays are caused by events or circumstances that are beyond the group’s control and there is sufficient evidence of the group’s commitment to implement the disposal plan. Assets that meet the criteria for classification as held for sale are measured at the lower of carrying amount and fair value less costs to sell. They are not amortised or depreciated. 4.2 Current assets 4.2.1 Inventories Inventories are measured at the lower of purchase or production cost, including directly related charges, net of discounts and allowances, and estimated realisable value. Cost is calculated using the weighted average cost method. When, subsequently, impairment losses decrease or no longer exist, the carrying amount of the asset is restored to the extent of the original cost, less any accumulated amortisation/depreciation. Reversals of impairment losses are never applied to goodwill, as recommended by IAS 36 (see also 4.1.1.4 Goodwill). Financial assets with fixed maturity are measured at amortised cost, which is calculated using the effective interest method. When financial assets do not have a fixed maturity, they are measured at cost. Loans and receivables due after one year that do not bear interest or that bear interest at below market rates are discounted using market rates. The group regularly measures financial assets to verify if there is objective evidence that they, taken individually or collectively, have undergone impairment losses. If there is evidence in this respect, the impairment losses are taken to profit or loss for the year. Finished products and work in progress are measured at the progressive average cost for materials, plus the average hourly cost of labour for internal processing and price paid for external processing. Estimated realisable value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business considering any costs of completion and the estimated costs necessary to make the sale. The carrying amount of inventories is adjusted through a specific allowance to consider slow-moving or obsolete items. The group classifies inventories as follows: ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ 4.2.2 raw materials, consumables and supplies, work in progress and semi-finished products, finished products and goods for resale, payments on account. Contract work in progress Contract work in progress is recognised considering contractual considerations accrued with reasonable certainty based on the percentage of completion. 106 If these are equity investments in unlisted companies for which fair value less costs to sell cannot be reliably measured. The stage of completion is calculated using the physical MAG | Annual Report 2015 133 measurement criterion, i.e., by measuring the size of the work completed. The cost method is used as a benchmark. The considerations calculated are based on contractually agreed prices, including claims for price revisions and any other reasonably expected additional fees. Contracts with considerations in currency other than the functional currency are measured by translating the portion of considerations accrued at the closing rate (see also 3.2 Translation of foreign currency captions and financial statements of foreign operations). The measurement reflects the best estimate of projects at the reporting date. The group periodically updates the assumptions underlying these measurements. Any effects are recognised in the year in which the adjustments are made. Contract work in progress is recognised net of any allowances and progress billings relating to the contract in progress. This analysis is performed individually for each contract, recognising: ◊ the positive difference (work in progress in excess of progress billings) under contract work in progress; ◊ the negative difference (work in progress less than progress billings) under other current liabilities; ◊ any advances are recognised under other current liabilities. 4.2.3 Trade receivables and other assets Trade receivables and other assets falling due within normal commercial terms are initially recognised at fair value, which generally corresponds with nominal amount, and subsequently measured at amortised cost, net of identified impairment losses. The group assesses their recoverability on the basis of the present value of estimated future cash flows. 4.2.4 Derivatives Derivatives are always classified as assets held for trading and measured at fair value through profit or loss, unless they qualify for hedge accounting and are effective in hedging the underlying assets, liabilities or commitments of the group. In specifically identified cases, the group occasionally uses derivatives exclusively as part of its strategies of hedging interest rate risk on loans that accrue interest at variable rates. The group companies do not make regular use of other types of derivatives, as management does not believe that there are significant risks of fluctuations in the fair value of recognised assets or liabilities or due to contractual commit- 134 ments (fair value hedges) or fluctuations in expected cash flows on contractual or highly probably transactions (cash flow hedges). The effectiveness of hedges is documented at the inception of the transaction, as well as periodically at each annual reporting date. Hedge effectiveness is measured by comparing the variations in the fair value of the hedging instrument with those of the hedged item, or, in the event of more complex instruments, using statistical analysis based on risk variations. The fair value of instruments listed on regulated markets is taken with reference to the respective bid prices at the reporting date. The fair value of instruments not listed on regulated markets is measured using financial calculation techniques. In particular, the fair value of interest rate swaps is measured by discounting estimated cash flows. Specifically, the fair value analysis is integrated by tests carried out to verify the prospective and retrospective effectiveness of the hedge, as required by IAS 39. 4.2.5 Cash and cash equivalents This caption includes cash on hand, deposits and current accounts with banks, post offices or other credit institutions available for current transactions and other equivalents. It also includes any current and highly liquid financial investments that are readily convertible into cash and not subject to significant risks of fluctuations in value. 4.3.4 Hedging reserve This reserve arises from recognising the effective portion of hedging transactions using derivatives directly in equity. 4.3.5 Earnings per share Basic earnings (losses) per share are calculated by dividing the profit (loss) attributable to the owners of the parent by the number of ordinary shares. In the event of transactions affecting share capital during the year, the number of shares is calculated as the weighted average of the year. All shares are ordinary. There are no dilutive effects to take into account. 4.4 Trade payables and other liabilities Furthermore, legislation ensures that employees can request a partial advance on post-employment benefits vested during employment. Only those employees who have worked for the company for at least eight years may request an advance, and they may only request up to 70% of their post-employment benefits vested at the date of the request. 4.3.1 Share capital 4.5.1 This reserve includes the amounts arising from capital increases against consideration in excess of the nominal amount of shares. 4.3.3 Other reserve These include retained earnings or losses carried forward from previous years, the legal reserve, the translation reserve and the consolidation reserve. MAG | Annual Report 2015 This amount is decreased by 0.5% to fund the Post-employment Benefit Guarantee Fund set up with INPS (the Italian social security institution), which replaces insolvent employers. In addition, any amounts that the employee has decided to allocate to a contractual pension fund are also deducted. They are classified as current liabilities, unless the group has a contractual right to settle its obligations after at least twelve months from the reporting date. 4.5 Employees benefits - Postemployment benefits Share premium reserve Italian post-employment benefits are governed by article 2120 of the Italian Civil Code and are each employee’s right upon termination of employment. The amount of postemployment benefits due by the employer is equal to the sum of 7.41% of annual remuneration valid for calculation purposes due for the year. They are subsequently measured at amortised cost, using the effective interest method (see 4.4 Trade payables and other liabilities). Equity 4.3.2 Post-employment benefits (called “TFR” in Italy) fall under the employee benefits regulated by IAS 19. For revaluation purposes, post-employment benefits are increased, with the exclusion of the portion accrued at 31 December of each year, by applying a rate comprised of a fixed rate of 1.50% and 75% of the inflation rate recorded by the cost of living index for December of the previous year. This revaluation is taxable at a rate of 11%. They are initially recognised at fair value, net of transaction costs. 4.3 Share capital is comprised of the parent’s subscribed and paid-in share capital. Any costs closely related to the issue of shares are classified as a decrease in share capital when they are directly related to such transaction. ming actuarial and investment risks in relation to the plan. Accordingly, the cost of the plan is not calculated based on contributions due for the year, but on the basis of demographic and statistical assumptions and salary increase trends. Post-employment benefits The group companies use two different types of post-employment (or integrative) benefits that take into account, for Italian companies, the pension reform introduced by Law no. 296 of 27 December 2006 with effect from 1 January 2007. Defined contribution plans The company pays fixed contributions to a separate entity (fund) and will not have a legal or constructive obligation to pay additional contributions if the mandated entity does not have sufficient assets to pay benefits for past service. The company recognises contributions to the plan when the employees provide service in exchange for the contributions. Defined benefit plans In this case, the company is obliged to pay agreed benefits for employees in service and former employees by assu- Unless internal labour agreements provide for more favourable conditions for employees, they may only obtain the advance once during employment for well-specified reasons (purchase of first home, medical expenses). Under Italian legislation, the carrying amount of post-employment benefits is equal to the amount accrued by each employee at the reporting date. Accordingly, the amount accrued is equal to the total that would be paid to all employees if they were all to terminate their employment at that date. Under IFRS and considering the indications provided by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) and the International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC), TFR is considered post-employment benefits under a defined-benefit plan and should be calculated using actuarial techniques. Before the pension reform took effect (1 January 2007), MAG | Annual Report 2015 135 the projected unit credit method (PUCM) provided for by IAS 19.64/66 was used. It is still applied by companies with fewer than 49 employees and calculates the average present value of benefit obligations vested through employee service up to the date of the valuation, using projected remuneration. To consider the effects of the reform on companies with more than 49 employees, at the reporting date, the group applied a different approach, which, in short, provides for, ◊ the projection of post-employment benefits already vested for each employee in service at the measurement date up to the estimated time of payment; ◊ the measurement of estimated post-employment benefit payments for each employee that the company will be required to make upon termination of employment due to dismissal, resignation, inability to work, death or retirement or requested advances; ◊ the discounting of each estimated payment at the measurement date. In accordance with the instructions provided by documents issued by the Italian Accounting Standard Setter (OIC)107, the group has applied this new approach, which provides that companies do not consider future vesting portions of post-employment benefits and apply amounts on a pro rata basis to reproportion the present value of the obligation, from the date when the pension reform took effect - 1 January 2007 - to measure the effects of curtailment, as specified in IAS 19.109. Following the amendment to IAS 19 (2011), the group changed the accounting treatment applied to calculate income and expense related to defined benefit plans. In accordance with IAS 19 (2011) amended, the group calculates the net financial expense (income) of the year from defined benefit plan liabilities (assets) by applying the discount rate used to measure the defined benefit obligation at the beginning of the year to the defined benefit plan liabilities (assets) at the beginning of the year, considering any changes to these defined benefit plan liabilities (assets) of the year arising from benefit contribution or payment. Based on the above, net financial expense on defined benefit plan liabilities (assets) now include: ◊ interest expense on the defined benefit obligation; ◊ interest income on plan assets; and ◊ interest on the effect of the asset ceiling. All gains and losses arising from the actuarial calculation at the reporting date are recognised in other comprehensive income. 4.5.2 Termination benefits Termination benefits are recognised as a liability and an expense when the group is demonstrably committed to terminating the employment of an employee or group of employees before the normal retirement date or providing termination benefits as a result of an offer made in order to encourage voluntary redundancy. Termination benefits do not generate future economic benefits for the group and, accordingly, are immediately expensed. 4.6 Provisions The provisions for risks and charges are recognised against certain or probable losses and expenses for which the group is uncertain of the timing and/or amount at the reporting date. They are recognised only if there is a current legal or constructive obligation that will lead to an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits as a result of past events and it is probable that the outflow will be required to settle the obligation. The amount recognised as a provision is the best estimate of the discounted expenditure required to settle the present obligation at the reporting date. The discount rate used reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the liability. Risks for which contingent liabilities are only possible are disclosed in a specific section of the notes on commitments and risks. They are not provided for. 4.7 Finance leases Leases are considered finance leases when, as specified by IAS 17, the risks and rewards incidental to ownership of the leased asset are transferred to the lessee. As lessee, at the date of initial recognition, the group recognises leased assets under non-current assets and recognises a financial liability at the same time equal to the lower of the asset’s fair value and the present value of minimum future payments due at inception of the lease, using the implicit interest rate of the lease or the marginal interest rate of the loan. Subsequently, the group takes the amortisation charge applied to the asset to profit or loss, along with interest separated from the payments of the year. 4.8 Operating leases All group leases that do not substantially transfer all the risks and rewards incidental to ownership of the leased asset are recognised as operating leases. 107 Appendix to Operating Guide 1 for transition to International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), chapter 13. “Consequences of Law no. 296/2006”. 136 Payments receivable or payable on operating leases are MAG | Annual Report 2015 taken to profit or loss over the term of the lease. dies whether local, national or international. 4.9 Recognition of revenue, income, costs and expense These benefits come in the form of transfers of resources in connection with the group’s compliance or commitment to comply with certain conditions relating to its operating activities. Grants are recognised on an accruals basis and in direct correlation with costs incurred when their allocation has been formally approved. 4.9.1 Revenue Revenue is the gross inflow of economic benefits in the course of the company’s ordinary activities. Revenue arising from transactions is measured at the fair value of the consideration received taking into account the amount of any trade discounts and volume rebates. Revenue also includes work in progress. The measurement criteria for work in progress are described in paragraph 4.2.2 Contract work in progress. Revenue relating to the sale of goods is recognised when all the following conditions have been met: ◊ the group has transferred to the buyer the significant risks and rewards of ownership of the goods; ◊ the group retains neither continuing managerial involvement to the degree usually associated with ownership nor effective control over the goods sold; ◊ the amount of revenue can be measured reliably; ◊ it is probable that the economic benefits associated with the transaction will flow to the group; ◊ the costs incurred or to be incurred in respect of the transaction can be measured reliably; ◊ the group has transferred to the buyer the significant risks and rewards of ownership of the goods, which generally coincides with transfer of ownership or possession to the buyer, or when the revenue can be measured reliably. Revenue from the rendering of services is recognised in the period when the services are provided. This recognition method makes reference to the stage of completion of the transaction at the reporting date, provided that the outcome of the transaction can be estimated reliably. The outcome of a transaction can be estimated reliably when all the following conditions are satisfied: ◊ the amount of revenue can be measured reliably; ◊ it is probable that the economic benefits associated with the transaction will flow to the entity; ◊ the stage of completion of the transaction at the reporting date can be measured reliably; and ◊ the costs incurred for the transaction and the costs to complete the transaction can be measured reliably. 4.9.2 Government grants Government grants refer to benefits flowing to the group from the government, government agencies and similar bo- Grants related to assets are government grants whose primary condition is that the group purchases, constructs or otherwise acquires long-term assets. Subsidiary conditions may also be attached restricting the type or location of the assets or the periods during which they are to be acquired or held. These grants are recognised in profit or loss in direct relation to the depreciation/amortisation of the assets to which they relate and are taken as a direct reduction in depreciation/amortisation. Grants related to income also relate to expenses of the year and are taken to profit or loss as a direct reduction in the related cost. Forgivable loans are loans which the lender undertakes to waive repayment of under certain conditions. Once these conditions are met they become grants recognised on an accruals basis in direct relation to the related costs incurred. 4.9.3 Costs Costs are recognised if they are pertinent to the group’s business and on an accruals basis. 4.9.4 Financial income and expense Financial income includes interest income on invested cash, including available-for-sale financial assets, dividend income, gains on the sale of available-for-sale financial assets, fair value gains on financial assets taken to profit or loss and gains on hedges taken to profit or loss. Interest income and expense are recognised on an accruals basis using the effective interest method, i.e., at the interest rate that makes all cash inflows and outflows (including any premiums, discounts, commissions, etc.) comprising the transaction financially equivalent. Financial expense includes interest expense on loans, interest expense arising on the discounting of provisions, fair value losses on financial assets at fair value through profit or loss, impairment losses on financial assets and losses on hedges at fair value through profit or loss. Borrowing costs are recognised as an expense in the year when incurred using the effective interest method. They are never capitalised under assets. MAG | Annual Report 2015 137 4.10 Income taxes Income taxes of the year reflect estimated current and deferred taxation. Current taxes are calculated for each company by applying the tax regulations currently in place to estimated taxable income, considering any tax subsidies. The group’s Italian companies have not participated in the domestic tax consolidation scheme provided for by articles 117 and 129 of Presidential decree no. 917/1986. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognised on an accruals basis on the temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities and their tax bases. 5. Significant matters They were not recognised on the following temporary differences: 5.1 New standards (IFRS) and interpretations (IFRIC) ◊ initial recognition of assets or liabilities in a transaction other than a business combination that does not affect either accounting profit or taxable income; ◊ investments in subsidiaries for which the difference is not likely to reverse in future years; ◊ initial recognition of goodwill. A list is provided below of new standards (IFRS) issued by the IASB that, at the preparation date of these consolidated financial statements, have been endorsed by the EU and published in the EU’s Official Gazette. IFRS/IFRIC description FTA date IAS n. 1 amendment Presentation of Financial Statements 2016/2017 IAS n. 16 amendment Property, plant and equipment 2016/2017 IAS n. 19 amendment Employee benefits 2016/2017 IAS n. 27 amendment Separate Financial Statements 2016/2017 IAS n. 28 amendment Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures 2016/2017 IAS n. 34 amendment Interim Financial Reporting 2016/2017 IAS n. 38 amendment Intangible assets 2016/2017 IAS n. 39 amendment Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement 2018/2019 IAS n. 41 amendment Agriculture 2016/2017 IFRS n. 5 amendment Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations 2016/2017 IFRS n. 7 amendment Financial instruments: disclosures 2016/2017 IFRS n. 9 Financial instruments 2018/2019 Deferred tax assets are recognised under “Non-current assets”. The notes to this caption provide a table summarising the temporary differences that gave rise to the recognition of deferred tax assets. IFRS n. 10 amendment Consolidated Financial Statements 2016/2017 IFRS n. 11 amendment Joint Arrangements 2016/2017 IFRS n. 12 amendment Disclosure of Interests in Other Entities 2016/2017 IFRS n. 14 Regulatory Deferral Accounts 2016/2017 IFRS n. 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers 2018/2019 The tax effects of temporary differences are due to the application of the tax rate that will apply when the differences reverse, or the application of the current tax rate as the best estimate of the rate that will be applicable if the time of reversal cannot be reasonably determined, and considering current tax legislation at the reporting date IFRS for SMEs amendment International Financial Reporting Standard for Small and Medium-sized Entities 2017/2018 Deferred tax liabilities are recognised under “Non-current liabilities”. The notes to this caption provide a table summarising the differences that gave rise to the recognition of deferred tax liabilities. Deferred tax assets are recognised only if it is probable that the group will have sufficient future taxable profit against which the assets can be used. The recoverability of deferred tax assets is reviewed at each reporting date. If it is no longer probable that the company will realise the related tax benefit, they are reduced accordingly. The “consolidation suite” became effective in 2015. It is comprised of the following documents endorsed by the European Union with Regulation (EU) no. 1254/2012 of 11 December 2012: ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ 138 MAG | Annual Report 2015 IFRS 10 Consolidated Financial Statements, IFRS 11 Joint Arrangements, IFRS 12 Disclosure of Interests in Other Entities, IAS 27 (2011) Separate Financial Statements, IAS 28 (2011) Investments in Associates and Joint MAG | Annual Report 2015 139 In June 2012 and October 2012, the IASB amended the above standards and published the two following documents endorsed by the European Union with Regulation (EU) no. 313/2013 of 4 April 2013 and Regulation (EU) no. 1174/2013 of 21 November 2013, respectively: lidated; ◊ Application of the equity method by a non-investment entity investor to an investment entity investee. ◊ The disclosure required by IFRS 12 for an investment entity measuring all of its subsidiaries at fair value. ◊ Transition Guidance (amendments to IFRS 10, 11, and 12), ◊ Investment Entities (amendments to IFRS 10, IFRS 12 and IAS 27 (2011)). The amendment to IAS 34 – “Interim Financial Reporting” clarifies the meaning of “elsewhere in the interim report” and requires the inclusion of a cross-reference from the interim financial statements to the location of this information. Mandatory application for investment entities only was postponed to financial statements of annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2014. The amendment to IAS 41 – “Agriculture” changes the financial reporting for bearer plants which are now included within the scope of IAS 16. Consequently, they are subsequently measured using the cost model or the revaluation model. A bearer plant is defined as a living plant that: Ventures. The most significant change introduced by IFRS 10 is the concept of one control model underlying consolidation, combining that previously set out in IAS 17 “Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements” and in SIC 12 “Consolidation - Special Purpose Entities”. The amendment to IAS 1 – “Presentation of Financial Statements” refers to the requirements for presenting information in terms of aggregation criteria and materiality, including the specific disclosure required by other standards. The amendments to IAS 16 – “Property, Plant and Equipment”- and IAS 38 - “Intangible Assets” – introduce additional specifications on depreciation and amortisation methodologies deemed acceptable. The amendment to IAS 19 – “Employee Benefits” modifies the criteria used to calculate the rate to discount post-employment benefits, clarifying that, upon measurement, said rate is to be denominated in the same currency in which the benefits are to be paid. The amendment to IAS 27 – “Separate Financial Statements” reinstates the equity method as an accounting option for equity investments. The amendment also clarifies that when a parent ceases to be an investment entity, or becomes an investment entity, it shall account for the change from the date when the change in status occurred. The amendment to IAS 28 – “Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures” (and IFRS 10 and IFRS 12) refers to investment entities that apply the consolidation exception and clarifies the following criteria and requirements: ◊ The exemption from preparing consolidated financial statements for an intermediate parent entity is available to a parent entity that is a subsidiary of an investment entity, even if the investment entity measures all of its subsidiaries at fair value; ◊ A subsidiary that provides services related to the parent’s investment activities should not be conso- 140 ◊ Is used in the production or supply of agricultural produce; ◊ Is expected to bear produce for more than one period; ◊ Has a remote likelihood of being sold as agricultural produce, except for incidental scrap sales. The amendment to IFRS 5 – “Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations” provides specific guidance in circumstances in which an entity reclassifies an asset from being held for sale to being held for distribution (or viceversa) and when it should cease held-for-distribution accounting. The amendment to IFRS 7 – “Financial Instruments: Disclosures – Hedge Accounting” relates to the disclosure requirements for hedging transactions in line with the introduction of the amendment to IFRS 9 about hedge accounting. Application of the amendment will become mandatory in tandem with the application of IFRS 9. IFRS 9 completes the step-by-step project to replace IAS 39 and includes requirements for the recognition, measurement, impairment, derecognition and general hedge accounting of financial instruments. Early application is permitted before 2018/2019. The previous version of IFRS 9 is applicable as of 2014/2015. The recent amendments to IFRS 10 – “Consolidated Financial Statements” relate to the accounting treatment applicable when control is lost over an investee that is not a business. Mandatory application starts from annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2016. The amendments to IFRS 11 (which, since this year, has replaced IAS 31 “Interests in Joint Ventures” and SIC 13 “Jointly Controlled Entities – Non Monetary Contributions by Venturers”) provide clarifications on how to account for the acquisition of an interest in a joint operation. MAG | Annual Report 2015 IFRS 14, published in January 2014, is an interim standard which permits an entity which is a first-time adopter of International Financial Reporting Standards to continue to recognise rate regulation amounts in accordance with its previous GAAP. This standard is applicable to annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2016. IFRS 15, which replaces IAS 11 (“Construction Contracts”), IAS 28 (“Revenue”) and the related interpretations (IFRIC 13 “Customer Loyalty Programmes”, IFRIC 15 “Agreements for the Construction of Real Estate”, IFRIC 18 “Transfer of Assets from Customers” and SIC 31 “Revenue-Barter Transactions Involving Advertising Services”), unifies the revenue recognition criteria applicable to contractually-based transactions. Its application becomes mandatory for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2018. The amendments to the IFRS for SMEs clarify existing requirements and are part of the three-year update and review cycle decided by the IASB. Their application becomes mandatory for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2017. Lastly, for illustrative purposes, the correlation between certain not yet applicable standards is summarised below. Standard description Applic. to annual periods beginning on or after IFRS n.1 Exemption from the requirement to restate comparative information for IFRS nr.9 Concurrent with adoption of IFRS 9 IFRS n.7 Additional Hedge accounting disclosures (and consequential amendments) resulting from the introduction of the hedge accounting chapter in IFRS nr.9 Concurrent with adoption of IFRS 9 IFRS n.9 Financial instruments 1 January 2018 IFRS n.10 Amendment to clarify the accounting for the loss of control of a subsidiary when the subsidiary does not constitute a business 1 January 2016 the competitiveness of companies operating in the aerospace industry and defence, under development costs in intangible assets, as they meet the requirements of paragraph 4.1.1.1 Research and development costs. Costs for projects that are legally considered108 relevant to “National security” or to be of “European interest” are shown net of the government assistance collected or to be collected under Law no. 808/85. Similarly, the royalties to be paid to the granting body, which substitute amortisation up to the offset cost, while any residual amount constitutes expense, are recognised in profit or loss as operating costs on an accruals basis when the conditions of current legislation have been met, which primarily consist of the sale of products incorporating the technology for which the government assistance was provided. Government assistance collected for projects that are not considered relevant to “National security” or of “European interest” is recognised under “Other liabilities” at nominal amount, and the current and non-current portions are separated on the basis of when repayment is due. In both cases, the costs recognised under intangible assets, in accordance with the above standards (see 4.1.1.1 Research and development costs) are: ◊ amortised over the estimated useful lives or the period in which future economic benefits are expected to be generated through the sale of products incorporating the technology developed; ◊ tested for impairment at least once a year until the development is completed and subsequently as soon as the potential realisation of future economic benefits changes. They are tested for impairment on the basis of estimated sales plans that consider the particularly long life cycles for products under development. 5.3 Financial risk management The group is exposed to the following financial risks: An examination of the group’s current situation showed that the effects of applying the above changes are not significant. 5.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to Law No. 808/85 The group classifies costs incurred for designs, prototypes and adjustments to technical/functional specifications for clearly identified potential customers that qualify for the government assistance provided for by Law no. 808 of 24 December 1985, regulating government assistance to support ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ credit risk; market risk; currency risk; interest rate risk; liquidity risk; business risk and uncertainties. Information is provided below on the group’s actual exposure to each of these risks, its risk management policies and processes, the methods used to assess the risks and how the group manages capital. 108 Reference is made to the provisions of Law no. 808/85 and subsequent amendments and the regulatory provisions which integrate and govern the specific aspects of the law (CIPE resolution no. 28/06 of 22 March 2006, Decrees of the Ministry of Economic Development nos. 173 and 174 of 14 September 2010). MAG | Annual Report 2015 141 These consolidated financial statements also include additional quantitative information. The board of directors has overall responsibility for the creation and supervision of the group’s risk management system. Using a system whereby duties are delegated, the group ensures the implementation of risk management guidelines and the periodic monitoring of risks. The finance department is responsible for monitoring risks, using information generated by the internal control system. The purpose of the group’s risk policy is not to speculate. Rather, it is exclusively aimed at minimising the financial risks of the core businesses of group companies. Risk management policies are based on the following: ◊ identifying and analysing the risks to which the group is exposed; ◊ setting limits and control tools; ◊ monitoring the tools. 5.3.1 Credit risk Credit risk is the risk that a customer or counterparty to a financial instrument generates a financial loss by failing to fulfil its obligation. Credit risk mainly relates to trade receivables and financial investments. The group’s exposure to credit risk largely depends on the specific characteristics of each customer. Demographic variables typical to the group’s customer portfolio, including default risk in the sector and country in which the customer operates, have a minimal influence on credit risk. A substantial part of the group’s turnover is generated with industrial companies that are part of corporate groups. This part has been falling dramatically (83% in 2013/14 and 75% in 2014/15, specifically 71% for the Integrated Aircraft Systems segment and 90% for the Aircraft Services segment), and, according to the business plan, it will fall below 50% over three years. The group has worked with over 90% of its customers for over four years. It has not had any cases of significant bad debts in the last ten years. Accordingly, no group company has set up an allowance for impairment other than the few isolated cases disclosed. For the purposes of providing clear information, due to the balances arising from the merger of SEI, which was merged into MAG in 2009/2010, MAG’s financial statements include certain bad debts arising from trading that took place before SEI’s acquisition in 2001. SEI’s seller is exclusively respon- 142 sible for these amounts, which are subject to insolvency proceedings or individual credit recovery processes. Their nominal amount has been fully impaired through a specific allowance set up when SEI was acquired. The group does not make financial investments. Accordingly, it is not subject to the risk of issuer default. The group’s policies provide for the issue of financial guarantees only in the interest of wholly-owned subsidiaries. At 30 September 2015, there are no guarantees issued on behalf of subsidiaries. There are no other financial guarantees. 5.3.2 Market risk Market risk is theoretically connected to fluctuations in the fair value and/or cash flows of a specific financial instrument due to changes in market prices. The group does not trade in financial instruments for speculative purposes. It does not hold financial assets for investment purposes and, accordingly, it does not have risk profiles connected to financial market volatility. Certain portions of debt exposed to interest rate risk could be hedged using derivatives, in accordance with the group’s risk management policy and where necessary. The group has agreed loans with banks on the normal credit market, which are mainly in Euros and are not secured by collateral or personal guarantees. 5.3.5 This risk relates to the group’s ability to meet its obligations with respect to financial liabilities. The group’s approach to managing liquidity provides that it always has sufficient funds to meet its obligations at the scheduled due dates, both in normal conditions and during times of financial tension, without having to incur charges at above market rates normally applied to group companies. The group monitors its financial position on a daily basis and periodically forecasts its financial requirements. ((figures in thousands of Euros; ratios in units)109110111 The group generated total turnover of approximately USD66 million and CAD0.4 million in 2014/2015. The group’s currency risk management policy is based on seeking to find a structural balance in transactions performed regularly (purchases and sales) in US dollars, with the aim of ensuring that net exposure in foreign currency remains at an acceptable level. During the year, the group did not need to enter into hedges and/or forward currency trading, as it pursued an overall substantial balance between exchange rate gains and losses. 5.3.4 currency original amount residual amount guarantees Non-current (at 30.09.2014) EUR 45,5 33,2 N/A Non-current (at 30.09.2015) EUR 45,4 34,8 N/A Certain non-current loans have a clause that requires the group to meet certain covenants. If it fails to meet these covenants, repayment of the loan could be requested. The ratios applied are summarised in the table below, along with the residual principal due and the actual ratios at the reporting date. The group has always met its obligations regularly. 5.3.3 These transactions are mainly in US dollars (USD) and, to a lesser extent, in Canadian dollars (CAD). (in millions of Euros) type With respect to specific hedges, the group has one derivative hedging interest rate risk for which reference should be made to the specific note (see 5.3.4 Interest rate risk). The group is exposed to currency risk on sales, purchases and loans in currencies other than the functional currency of the various group companies. However, the variable rate loans are indexed to the Euribor (generally the three-month rate), plus spreads in line with the best market averages. Liquidity risk The following table provides information on the group’s loans, credit lines and facilities in place at the reporting date, which the group has not secured with collateral or personal guarantees other than its commitment to comply with certain covenants detailed below. Currency risk Most non-current loans bear interest at flat rates. outstanding amount at 30.09.2015 5.036 354 At 30 September 2015, all ratios are within contractual limits. ratio limit 30.09.2015 30.09.2014 NFD /GROSS OPERATING PROFIT 3,5 1,72 2,62 NFD/EQUITY 1,2 0,58 0,75 NFD/ADJ. GROSS OPERATING PROFIT 4,0 1,70 2,39 NFD/EQUITY 2,5 0,58 0,75 ADJ.GROSS OPERATING PROFIT/NFE 4.839 1.695 2.083 7.000 Min. 4,0 7,64 5,60 NFD/GROSS OPERATING PROFIT 3,5 1,72 2,62 NFD/EQUITY 2,0 0,58 0,75 NFD/GROSS OPERATING PROFIT 3,5 1,72 2,62 NFD/EQUITY 2,0 0,58 0,75 NFD/GROSS OPERATING PROFIT 3,5 1,72 - 1,0 0,58 - GROSS OPERATING PROFIT/NFE NFD/EQUITY Min. 3,5 7,55 - NFD/GROSS OPERATING PROFIT 3,5 1,72 - NFD/EQUITY 2,0 0,58 - Interest rate risk This risk relates to fluctuations in market interest rates with respect to interest expense paid on loans in place. The group is marginally exposed to interest rate risk as it has agreed an insignificant portion of financing on which interest accrues at variable rates indexed to the Euribor. MAG | Annual Report 2015 109 Net financial debt, excluding other non-current liabilities as per Law no. 808/85 on projects that are not eligible for “National security” or “European interest” assistance (see also 5. Significant matters - 5.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to Law No. 808/85). 110 The concept of gross operating profit substantially refers to adjusted EBITDA, as discussed in the alternative performance indicators section of the directors’ report. 111 Net financial expense, excluding exchange rate gains and losses MAG | Annual Report 2015 143 (in millions of Euro) type current lines current FCT currency limit utilisation guarantees EUR 26,5 8,3 N/A CAD 0,8 - N/A EUR 79,0 33,2 N/A These credit lines include facilities available for the factoring without recourse of trade receivables, which are recognised separately. On occasion, the group has factored receivables, thereby transferring title thereto and default risk. These transactions are legally and substantially considered without recourse, as they do not provide for any guarantees, repurchase or recourse clauses. 6. Notes to the statement of financial position Overall, the group’s short-term facilities total approximately €106 million and the percentage of utilisation at the reporting date is 31% for credit lines and bank facilities, while approximately 42% of the available facilities for the factoring without recourse of trade receivables were used. 6.1 5.3.6 The following table provides variations in intangible assets. Business risk and uncertainties Reference should be made to the various sections of the annual report for information on business risk and uncertainties (see The external context, Risk management and compliance, Group performance). Intagible assets Development costs Ind. patents and int. prop. rights Concessions, licences and trademarks 29.318 - 617 610 5.596 31 156 (15) - (236) Assets under development Other Total 19 88 30.652 - 4 185 5.972 - - - - (15) - 19 - (19) (174) (410) (1.825) (6) (423) - - (46) (2.300) (547) - (2) - - (2) (551) 47.808 66 4.215 680 4 1.473 54.246 (15.517) (41) (3.848) (70) - (1.422) (20.898) 32.291 25 367 610 4 51 33.348 Goodwill 30 September 2014: Carrying amount Increases Cost offsetting (Laws no. 808/85 and 46/82) Reclassifications/Impairment losses Amortisation Net exchange rate losses 30 September 2015: Historical cost Accumulated amortisation Carrying amount The offsetting of the historical cost of “Development costs” with government assistance under Laws nos. 808/85 and 46/82 relates to the recognition of costs that meet the requirements for capitalisation under intangible assets, net of the related amounts of government assistance provided under the above laws. For information on the recognition of the government assistance provided under Law no. 808/85, reference should be made to paragraph 5.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to Law No. 808/85. For information on the recognition of the government assistance provided under Law no. 46/82, reference should be made to paragraph 4.9.2 Government grants. 144 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 145 There are seven main groups of completed development projects that have not yet been completely amortised. They relate to products used in seven different types of aircraft. In accordance with the criteria described above relating to the identification of the useful lives of products developed (see 4.1.1.1 Research and development costs), amortisation is calculated on a straight-line basis over the useful lives of such assets, which at 30 September 2015 are not shorter than ten years in most cases. Development costs that are capitalised under assets at the reporting date relate to groups of projects that can be summarised based on the aircraft in which the related product will be used as follows. Development costs for new products 2014/2015 AW109 projects 2.830 AW139/AW149/A149 projects 7.054 AW169 projects 251 Bell 429 projects 3.991 Bell 505 projects 298 Bell 525 projects 5.045 EADS X4 projects 3.745 G5/G650 projects 2.313 Electromechanical actuator systems (fixed-wing and helicopters) 2.990 AW189 interiors projects 683 AW139 restyling projects 170 Other projects 2.921 Total 32.291 “Goodwill” is analysed below. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Acquisition of the interiors business activity 610 610 Total 610 610 Goodwill is tested for impairment once a year. For the purposes of impairment testing, goodwill was initially allocated to the investee Mecaer America and the relevant operating segment (Integrated Aircraft Systems), which are the most detailed level at which the group monitors goodwill for internal reporting purposes. The recoverable amount of the cash-generating units is determined by calculating value in use. These calculations use projected future cash flows based on actual operating profit and figures estimated in the 2015/2016 approved budget and the 2014/2015 – 2018/2019 business plan approved in 2014 and currently being updated. The long-term plan, compared to which the 2014/2015 actual figures and the 2015/2016 budget show an improvement, was prepared using figures which include the revenue, costs and volumes of each project, projected on the basis of the available or potential order backlog, cost configurations and known or reasonably estimable cost and revenue. Statement of financial position figures are estimated for the years covered by the plan considering investments needed to sustain the trend in business volumes and maintain an appropriate renewal rate of assets used in operations and product innovation. Property Plant and machinery Industrial and commercial equipment Other assets Leasehold improvements Assets under construction Total 2.310 3.979 1.734 621 1.359 5.599 15.602 Increases - 615 458 286 337 864 2.560 Net decreases - (2) - - - - (2) Reclassifications/imp. - - 40 7 33 (80) - (10) (1.160) (735) (278) (342) - (2.525) - (97) 53 7 (42) - (79) 30 September 2014: Carrying amount Depreciation Net exchange rate gains/ (losses) 30 September 2015: Historical cost 2.440 17.309 9.376 3.033 4.132 6.383 42.673 Accumulated depreciation (140) (13.974) (7.826) (2.390) (2.787) - (27.117) Carrying amount 2.300 3.335 1.550 643 1.345 6.383 15.556 The figures in the business plan adequately support the goodwill allocated to the production of interiors carried out by the CCS division line of the Integrated Aircraft Systems operating segment. For additional information on the characteristics of the production lines, their organisational structure and impact on group revenue, reference should be made to the directors’ report (see Group performance). 6.3 No impairment losses were recognised on goodwill in previous years, except for that indicated with respect to Mecaer America Inc.. This caption includes small amounts relating to non-controlling interests, including the interest held in the I-LAN association of small airports, which amounts to €3 thousand. 6.2 Property, plant and equipment 6.4 Equity investments Deferred tax assets The following tables provide an analysis of asset balances at 30 September 2015 and 30 September 2014 for each caption, with indication of amounts recoverable within and after one year. This airstrip is subject to a specific investment plan to enlarge it and subsequently build an airport. Assets under construction at the reporting date amount to €6,352 thousand. These balances reflect the estimated tax charge arising on temporary differences between the profit for the year and taxable profit in relation to captions that are deductible in future years. Increases in these captions relate to investments to upgrade the production structures and insource activities that were previously subcontracted. Assets under construction and payments on account include increases in the year due to costs incurred for the longterm investment plan to build the above-mentioned airstrip. No property, plant and equipment were pledged as collateral at 30 September 2015. The tax rates applied in the calculation for the Italian companies are IRES of 27.5% and IRAP of approximately 4.2%. The Canadian company used a tax rate in the region of 31.0%, which is the result of combining the provincial tax rate (Quebec) with the federal tax rate. This company’s tax position includes prior year tax losses carried forward112 totalling CAD33,715 thousand (in addition to CAD11,219 thousand relating to development costs) in relation to federal taxes and CAD32,958 thousand (in addition to CAD12,647 thousand relating to development costs) for provincial tax purposes. The possibility of using these losses expires between 2026 and 2034, while a portion (including that relating to development costs) does not expire. In the tax period of these financial statements, the company has generated a taxable profit for the first time. For reasons 112 At the date of filing the latest tax return (2013/2014). 146 Having completed the start-up stage, the US company MAG Inc. has systematically recorded taxable profit, absorbing all the tax losses carried forward that it had initially recognised. Property includes €2,278 thousand relating to the carrying amount of the land used for the “Tronto” airstrip located within the Monteprandone (AP) industrial site and the carrying amount of the airstrip. Plant and machinery and industrial and commercial equipment at 30 September 2015 include carrying amounts of €437 thousand and €98 thousand, respectively, relating to assets under finance lease for which current financial liabilities of €77 thousand and non-current financial liabilities of €207 thousand have been recognised. MAG | Annual Report 2015 of prudence the valuation allowance was maintained in order to offset the estimable deferred tax assets related to prior year tax losses; consequently, no benefit was recognised in this respect. MAG Inc. operates in five US states; however, most of its income is generated in two of them (Pennsylvania and Maryland). Consequently, the company is subject to a tax rate which combines federal and state rates of approximately 41%. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Unrealised exchange rate losses 94 145 Fair value losses 144 38 Cash-deductible expenses 13 111 Expenses deductible on an accruals basis 23 14 Taxed provisions for risks 54 - Prior year interest expense on discounting 12 15 Total deferred tax assets recoverable WITHIN one year 340 323 2014/2015 2013/2014 Taxed provisions for risks 1.825 1.566 Royalties 467 388 Impairment losses on loans and receivables - Prior year interest expense on discounting 53 65 Expenses deductible on an accruals basis 73 38 Post-employment benefits recognised under IAS 19 38 75 Total deferred tax assets recoverable AFTER one year 2.456 2.132 Total deferred tax assets 2.796 2.455 MAG | Annual Report 2015 147 6.5 Other non-current assets requiring back-up inventories usually for fairly long periods of time. Deferred receivables for projects under Law no. 808/85 include the present value of government assistance to be collected from the Ministry of Economic Development for projects under Law no. 808/85 concerning national security and similar matters for which collection is deferred. The portion expected to be collected within one year is classified under other current assets (see 6.12 Other current assets). 2014/2015 2014/2015 2013/2014 Raw materials, consumables and supplies 24.593 23.833 Work in progress and semi-finished products 13.131 10.992 Finished products and goods for resale 19.774 21.411 57.498 56.236 (6.457) (5.451) 2013/2014 Allowance for inventory write-down 51.041 50.785 Advances to suppliers 112 259 Total inventories 51.153 51.044 Deferred receivables from the Ministry of Economic Development for projects under Law no. 808/85 2.108 3.243 Guarantee deposits and other noncurrent assets 123 108 Total other non-current assets 2.231 3.351 6.8 6.6 Other non-current assets - Related parties Guarantee deposits and other non-current assets include non-interest bearing guarantee deposits of €206 thousand given to the related party S.B.I. S.p.A. for the lease of the properties in Borgomanero (NO) and Monteprandone (AP). 6.7 Inventories Contract work in progress 2014/2015 2013/2014 Projects to develop new products 724 416 Aircraft interiors 3.063 642 Aircraft and component maintenance 1.852 2.393 Total contract work in progress 5.639 3.451 Contract work in progress comprises three main components that are part of different business lines, operating separately. The first one includes long-term contracts for the development of new products, which are entirely or partially funded by revenue from the customer. This caption is analysed in the table below. Overall, there was a modest increase in all categories of inventories, despite the growth in production volumes. This was due to the constant monitoring of procurement levels and turnover rates. The allowance for inventory write-down includes: ◊ specific write-downs for given situations, which total approximately €3,691 thousand at the reporting date. These include roughly €3,301 thousand for write-downs specifically and prudently recognised on products, systems and components of the E550 aircraft for the customer One Aviation (Eclipse Aerospace); ◊ collective write-downs based on statistical analyses of back-up components inventory trends, such as movements that presumably reflect obsolescence and/or excessive items, which total approximately €2,766 thousand. These analyses are updated each year on the basis of actual figures reported and integrated by technical analyses carried out to justify the need for write-downs. Interiors include contracts for customised VVIP interiors, while maintenance relates to overhaul of helicopters and components carried out at the Monteprandone site. Trade receivables This caption is analysed in the table below. Carrying amounts are in line with fair value. The allowance for impairment consists of approximately €510 thousand adjusting receivables of SEI, which arose prior to its merger into the parent, MAG, in 2009/2010, as detailed in note 5.3.1 Credit risk. Trade receivables at the reporting date reflect the natural monetary cycle. As noted above (5.3.1 Credit risk), with a payment schedule that better meets the needs of the main customer, the group occasionally factors trade receivables without recourse which are collectable and due at the factoring date. The increase in the balance is attributable to a transaction that was carried out last year near the reporting date. There are no significant bad debts. Although a portion of past due receivables remains, mostly due to the complexity of the procurement process for large customers, the average DSO continue to be approximately 85 days and 180 days for residential and institutional customers, respectively. Receivables remain highly concentrated (roughly 54%) with the group’s key customer, Finmeccanica group. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Trade receivables 28.543 38.188 Allowance for impairment (599) (704) Total trade receivables 27.944 37.484 At the reporting date, trade receivables may be analysed by geographical segment as follows. Geographical segment Amount Europe – Eurozone 14.050 Europe - non-Eurozone 169 North America Considering the contractual terms, these contracts are of a long-term nature and provide for contractual considerations that the group measures on the basis of the percentage of completion at the reporting date. This method considers technical progress (physical measurement) and financial progress (cost method). 12.608 Rest of the world 1.117 Total trade receivables 27.944 At the reporting date, past due receivables total €7,829 thousand. A breakdown of past due receivables by ageing is set out below. Interiors contracts are the main component at the reporting date. Work in progress is recognised under assets if, based on an analysis conducted on each contract, the gross value of work in progress exceeds progress billings. It is recognised under liabilities if the progress billings exceed work in progress. If the progress billings have not been collected at the reporting date, the relevant amount is classified as trade receivables This method is necessary given the specific nature of the group’s industry, also considering contractual restrictions 148 6.9 MAG | Annual Report 2015 6.10 Current loans and receivables Related parties At 30 September 2015, current loans and receivables from the related party S.B.I. S.p.A. amount to €25 thousand (for additional details see 9.2 Related party transactions). Their carrying amount is in line with their fair value. 6.11 Tax assets Tax assets include advances on income taxes paid for the year in excess of the total balance due. The IRES (corporate income tax) tax asset includes the excess IRES of €512 thousand for tax years for which the parent has claimed reimbursement pursuant to article 2.1-quater of Decree law no. 201/2011, as detailed in the note to Income taxes (7.13 Income taxes). They are due within one year 2014/2015 2013/2014 IRES 512 574 Foreign taxes - 473 IRAP - 329 Total tax assets 512 1.376 6.12 Other current assets Advances to suppliers relate to payments for orders primarily outside the EU. This caption, which was particularly high for the CCS division at the end of the previous year, fell considerably. The VAT (and other equivalent indirect taxes) receivable mainly comprises the Italian VAT, whose trend is correlated with the invoicing system applied to the key customer, which, as a frequent exporter, makes purchases not subject to VAT by issuing letters of intent for time brackets. The balance includes the receivable of roughly €935 thousand of SAT for VAT paid on investments. Nominal amount Impairment Carrying amount 3.070 - 3.070 31< x < 60 475 - 475 61 < x < 90 978 - 978 91 < x < 120 679 - 679 x > 120 3.226 (599) 2.627 Total past due 8.428 (599) 7.829 Days < 30 Receivables for projects under Law no. 808/85 include the present value of government assistance to be collected from the Ministry of Economic Development for projects under Law no. 808/85 concerning national security and similar matters for which collection is deferred. The portion expected to be collected after one year is classified under other non-current assets (see 6.5 Other non-current assets). Deferred charges include portions of costs and charges paid in advance but not pertaining to the year. These mainly refer to costs for supplies. MAG | Annual Report 2015 149 Tax credits include €458 thousand due from the Canadian tax authorities for research and development costs incurred by the Canadian subsidiary. Transfer credits to be received relate to trading transactions and include certain items of modest amounts due from Finmeccanica group, which is also a supplier of the group. Receivables due from the liquidator of HT S.p.A. reflect the outstanding balance due from the subsidiary Hydraulic Technologies S.p.A. as a result of its liquidation and which the liquidator withheld on a precautionary basis. 2014/2015 2013/2014 VAT/GST/QST/HST 3.705 5.567 Contributions to be collected 1.226 1.518 Deferred charges 830 1.155 Advances to suppliers 491 434 Tax credits 495 384 Other 105 304 - 216 250 15 5 5 7.107 9.598 Receivables from the Ministry of Economic Development for deferred projects under Law no. 808/85 Transfer credits to be received Receivables due from the liquidator of HT S.p.A. Total other current assets The fair value of the items comprising other current assets is in line with the carrying amount. 2013/2015 2013/2014 - 2.967 Current financial assets In the previous year, this caption exceptionally comprised a loan entered into on 30 September 2014 which became effective on 1 October 2014. Cash and cash equivalents This caption reflects the balance of bank and postal accounts. It is calculated as the nominal amount of current accounts held with banks. Bank deposits Cash Total cash and cash equivalents 2014/2015 2013/2014 16.250 14.878 11 9 16.261 14.887 The carrying amount is in line with fair value. 150 adequate credit ratings. Certain group companies factor trade receivables, usually every quarter. However, the factoring does not alter the nature of collection times in terms of method or amounts. The group constantly monitors developments in its debt to equity ratio and, in particular, the level of net debt and the generation of cash flows from operating activities. These transactions are legally and substantially considered without recourse, as they do not provide for any guarantees, repurchase or buy-back clauses. To achieve these objectives, the group looks to constantly improve the profitability of its businesses. 6.15 Cash and cash equivalents Related parties This caption reflects the balance of bank deposits. It is calculated as the nominal amount of current accounts held with banks that are related parties (Credito Valtellinese group – see also 9.2 Related party transactions). The carrying amount is in line with fair value. Total cash and cash equivalents 2014/2015 2013/2014 1.596 1.034 6.16 Equity At 30 September 2015, paid-in and subscribed share capital amounts to €13,138 thousand, divided into 13,138 thousand shares with a nominal amount of €1 (one Euro) each. No treasury shares are held directly or indirectly via trustees or nominees. 6.13 Current financial assets 6.14 Variations in this caption relate to monetary cycles. For information on changes and an analysis of equity, reference should be made to the statement of changes in equity (see Statement of changes in equity). At the reporting date, other comprehensive expense recognised in equity (translation reserve, profits and losses arising from the application of IAS 19) totals €2,860 thousand. No dividends have been distributed to the owners of the parent during the last two years. There are no significant restrictions arising from loan agreements or legal provisions limiting the subsidiaries’ ability to transfer funds to the parent in the form of dividends, the repayment of loans or advances, with the exception of compliance with the limits established in article 2426.1.5 of the Italian Civil Code for companies that capitalise development costs under intangible assets. The group’s capital management objectives are to create value for shareholders, safeguard business continuity and support the group’s development. Accordingly, the group seeks to maintain an adequate level of market capitalisation, at the same time enabling it to realise satisfactory returns for shareholders and guarantee accessibility to outside sources of funding, including the achievement of MAG | Annual Report 2015 financial parameters113114115 The board of directors can make proposals to the shareholders to increase share capital or, if legally permitted, distribute reserves. In this way, the group may also repurchase treasury shares within the limits authorised by the shareholders, with the same aims of creating value while achieving financial balance and improving the group’s rating. 2014/2015 2013/2014 a113 1,46 % 1,23 % Inflation rate i 2,00 % 2,00 % Annual rate of increase in postemployment benefits r 3,00% 3,00% is114 1,00 % 1,00 % Discount rate Annual rate of salary increase demographic parameters Mortality RG48 Tables115 Inability INPS tables by age and gender Retirement age Achievement of requirements for mandatory general insurance annual employee turnover and advances on post-employment benefits Equity means the value contributed by shareholders (share capital and share premium reserve totalling €18,702 thousand) and the value generated by the group through the results of operations (retained earnings and other reserves, before the profit for the year and the translation reserve, totalling €22,949 thousand). 2014/2015 2013/2014 advances 2,0 % 2,0 % turnover 3,0 % 3,0 % Post-employment benefits at 30 September 2015 and 2014 are analysed below. 6.17 Employee benefits – Postemployment benefit 2014/2015 The group companies grant post-employment benefits to their employees both directly and by contributing to funds outside the group. These benefits are granted in a variety of ways, depending on the legal, tax and economic conditions of each country in which the group operates. In particular, for the Italian companies, the pension reform under Law no. 296/2006 has been considered (see 4.5 Employees benefits - Post-employment benefits). The benefits are usually based on remuneration and years of employee service. The group companies grant post-employment benefits through defined contribution and defined benefit plans. Under defined contribution plans, the group pays contributions to public or private insurance companies on the basis of a legal or contractual obligation, or voluntarily. When the group pays the contributions, it fully meets its obligations. The cost of the period is accrued on the basis of employee service and is recognised by function under personnel expense. Defined benefit plans include the post-employment benefits of Italian companies, which reflect accruals for all employees in service at the reporting date, calculated using the projected unit credit method and actuarial techniques. The techniques used for these calculations are shown in the following tables. 2013/2014 MAG 1.791 2.200 total 1.791 2.200 The carrying amount is in line with fair value. Changes in net liabilities for defined benefit obligations are provided in the following table. Liabilities for defined benefit plans at 30.09.2014 2.200 Current service cost and interest 8 Actuarial losses (124) Plan benefits paid (293) Liabilities for defined benefit plans at 30.09.2015 1.791 Amounts taken to other comprehensive income in the two consecutive years are detailed in the following table. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Current service cost Interest cost 8 49 (124) 217 (116) 266 Curtailment Actuarial (gains)/losses (OCI) - 113 Rate indexed to the 7 to 10-year Iboxx Eurozone Corporate AA index. 114 Following the new pension reform for companies with more than 49 employees, the future portions accruing no longer remain with the company. Instead, they are transferred to a supplementary pension fund or the INPS treasury fund. Accordingly, the Italian companies are no longer required to project future salaries using specific growth rates by professional position. 115 RG 48 mortality tables published by the government’s general accounting department. MAG | Annual Report 2015 151 They are taken to the following statement of comprehensive income captions according to their nature. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Personnel expense - - Financial expense 8 49 (124) 217 (116) 266 Other comprehensive income (expense) 6.18 Provisions The following tables provide an analysis of the composition of and changes in this caption. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Provision for product warranties 2.010 1.388 Early retirement provision - 166 Provision for litigation 522 431 Total provisions for risks and charges 2.532 1.985 Provisions for risks and charges at 30.09.2014 1.985 Accruals 1.096 Utilisation (549) Provisions for risks and charges at 30.09.2015 2.532 The provision for litigation has been accrued specifically to cover pending litigation, including certain cases with former group employees. Details are not provided as this could weaken the group’s position in the litigation. The €1,096 thousand accrual of the year includes €801 thousand covering the expense to be incurred for retrofit activities involving a specific element of the E550 aircraft landing gear whose tolerances were redefined by the engineering. This expense mainly comprises the estimated costs to rework a component (trunion assy) and the costs for the disassembly and inspection activities carried out by the aircraft maker during aircraft scheduled maintenance. The estimate of said expense is based on an agreement reached with the customer and a statistical analysis of the inspections carried out starting from August 2015. 2013/2014 7.780 7.984 Allowance for impairment 166 166 Unrealised exchange rate gains 186 256 Amortisation of goodwill 120 108 Leases 27 45 Accelerated depreciation 44 107 8.323 8.666 Total deferred tax liabilities Deferred tax liabilities for research and development costs arise from the temporary differences relating to the tax deduction of these costs in the year in which they were incurred. This creates a reversal effect in the related amortisation (see 7.13 Income taxes). Changes in this caption are shown in the following table. Deferred tax liabilities at 30.09.2014 Net accruals The following table provides a breakdown of deferred tax liabilities. 6.21 Other non-current liabilities 6.25 Tax liabilities This caption is entirely comprised of “Other liabilities under Law no. 808/85” which include the difference between assistance received or to be received under Law no. 808/85, relating to projects considered relevant to “National security and similar”, and the portion of subsidised costs classified under intangible assets as development costs, the difference between royalties charged to the projects and the liability actually accrued at the conditions for which payment is provided for, as well as assistance under Law no. 808/85 for projects not considered relevant to “National security and similar” (see 5.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to Law No. 808/85). Tax liabilities include balances due for accrued income taxes, net of payments on account. - Reversals/reclassifications (343) Deferred tax liabilities at 30.09.2015 8.323 The caption includes advances from customers for the provision of assets. Loans and borrowings at 30 September 2015 are analysed below, in comparison with those at the previous year end, with indication of those that are current and non-current. The carrying amount is in line with fair value. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Bank loans 17.653 25.701 Other loans 935 1.347 18.588 27.048 The carrying amount is in line with fair value. including: third parties 17.076 26.270 related parties 1.512 778 2014/2015 2013/2014 25.020 35.363 Bank loans 26.334 23.807 Other loans 783 563 Total non-current loans and borrowings 27.117 24.370 including: third parties 24.281 24.370 related parties 2.836 - Financial debt is detailed in the notes to the group’s net financial debt (see 9.1 Net financial debt). Other direct taxes IRAP 302 316 4 972 1 786 Total tax liabilities 6.26 Other current liabilities Current and deferred remuneration shows the variable components of remuneration recognised on an accruals basis and accrued additional month pay and untaken holidays. Deferred income mainly refers to revenue relating to contract work in progress for product development and interiors contracts that has been deferred under the percentage of completion method. Other liabilities under Law no. 808/85 include royalties charged to profit or loss, which are expected to be paid within one year (see 5.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to Law No. 808/85). 2014/2015 At the reporting date, trade payables may be analysed by geographical segment as follows. Geographical segment importo Europe – Eurozone Non-current loans MAG | Annual Report 2015 Total trade payables 469 The caption does not include overdue amounts. This caption is comprised of payables to suppliers of goods and services. The balance decreased on the previous year end due to the effect of the temporary suspension of some AW101 line interior contracts (India) which were then regularly completed in the first half of the year. Bank facilities and current loans Total current loans and borrowings 2013/2014 666 Social security charges payable are consistently proportionate to personnel expense. 6.23 Trade payables 6.20 Loans and borrowings 2014/2015 IRES Other current liabilities, whose carrying amount is in line with fair value, are analysed in the following table. 6.22 Advances from customers 8.666 Information on the main terms and conditions of bank loans in place are provided in the notes on financial risk management (see 5.3.5 Liquidity risk). 6.19 Deferred tax liabilities 152 2014/2015 Research and development costs 20.714 Europe - non-Eurozone 823 North America 3.299 Rest of the world 184 Total trade payables 25.020 2013/2014 Current and deferred remuneration 3.996 3.558 Social security charges payable 1.208 1.340 782 951 Deferred income Directors’ fees and expenses 84 74 Statutory auditors’ fees 174 166 Other liabilities under Law no. 808/85 238 122 Withholdings to be paid 22 63 Property tax 49 5 473 537 7.026 6.816 Other financial liabilities Total other current liabilities 6.24 Current financial liabilities Related parties General information on captions affected by related party transactions is provided in paragraph 9.2 Related party transactions (see). The carrying amount is in line with fair value. MAG | Annual Report 2015 153 7. Notes to the statement of comprehensive income 7.4 Increase in internal work capitalised 7.1 This caption mainly relates to internal and external costs incurred for long-term investment programmes to develop new products. These costs are recognised under intangible assets when they meet capitalisation requirements (see 6.1 Intagible assets). Net revenue Revenue from sales decreased by roughly 6% over the previous year. More detailed information on trends in revenue is provided in the directors’ report. Revenue - goods and processing, repair and maintenance services Design revenue 2014/2015 2013/2014 Variazione % 121.107 127.865 (5,3%) 2.249 2.923 (23,1%) 123.356 130.788 (5,7%) 7.5 Raw materials, consumables and supplies The use of raw materials, consumables and supplies is, overall, consistent with the mix of products and services, as demonstrated by the breakdown of revenue. Production values are down considerably in absolute terms. Net revenue Raw materials, consumables and supplies 7.2 2014/2015 2013/2014 43.419 40.163 Other revenue and income The caption mainly comprises grants related to income (€102 thousand), social security cuts on personnel bonuses paid in prior years (€63 thousand) and smaller personnel leaving incentives compared to 2013/2014 (€135 thousand) and the release of the provision for legal disputes with employees (€90 thousand). 7.3 Variation in finished products, work in progress and semi-finished goods This caption was directly affected by the factors described in the notes to the statement of financial position (see 6.7 Inventories). 7.6 Services The following table provides an analysis of services. Sub-contracting and third-party processing relate to outsourced production, the extent of which varies depending on production volumes. In any case, the use of these services is for non-strategic industrial processes. The decrease over the previous year is due to the fall in production volumes of the interiors segment and insourcing. The cost of temporary staff and contractors fell mainly as a consequence of the closure of the Yeovil site (UK), where the AW10 customised interiors were mostly produced using temporary staff. This caption is a significant variable cost given the group’s need for flexibility and the peaks of activity which characterise some operating segments. 154 MAG | Annual Report 2015 The cost of advisory services are in line with the previous year. External engineering activities for the various segments are provided to complement the activities of the group’s internal units. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Third party processing and subcontracting 16.842 18.384 Advisory and sundry assistance services 5.229 5.485 Temporary staff, consultants and contractors 2.292 5.141 Electricity, telephone, canteen and utilities 2.023 2.100 Travel expenses 1.972 2.093 Transport costs 1.820 1.871 Maintenance, repairs and technical assistance 1.347 1.480 Insurance 1.183 1.041 Plant services and security 667 595 Directors’ fees 501 713 Participation in conferences and trade fairs 393 414 Royalties 385 1.333 Royalties on Law no. 808/85 projects 309 424 Statutory auditors’ fees 135 124 Other services 629 700 Total services 35.727 41.898 Travel expenses had a significant impact, principally due to the fact that operating units are located in different geographical segments. Transport costs remain high as activities take place at several operating sites. Insurance mainly relates to the cost of covering aerospace risks, both in terms of third party liability on products and the many risks arising from the inspection and maintenance of aircraft and parts, mostly related to the AS division. In MAG | Annual Report 2015 155 this respect, the group has always pursued a prudent risk coverage policy by agreeing adequate policies with leading insurance companies. Royalties are those due to UTAS (Goodrich Landing Gear) for the AW139 LGS project, the Woodward group for assistance with certain types of hydraulic flight controls and AgustaWestland for maintenance activities on some hydraulic products (dampers). Royalties on Law no. 808/85 projects include the accrued benefits under this law on projects that are eligible for “National security” or “European interest” assistance. They are calculated on a straight-line basis in proportion to the relevant sales for the year (see also above 5. Significant matters, 5.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to Law No. 808/85 and 6.21 Other non-current liabilities). newals on expiry were not considered. 2015/2016 2016/2017 2017/2018 2018/2019 2019/2020 1.116 831 810 202 - 7.9 This caption rose in line with the slight increase in the average headcount which remains overall modest. 2014/2015 2013/2014 25.013 23.771 Social security contributions 6.366 5.741 Post-employment benefits and pension funds 1.031 994 Pension and similar costs 504 434 Other 469 655 33.384 31.595 Total personnel expense 7.7 Use of third party assets This caption is mainly comprised of operating lease payments for the industrial sites where the foreign operations’ factories (Laval, Philadelphia, Hagerstown and Irving) are located and for the Rome office. It also includes rent for cars, equipment and software. 2014/2015 2013/2014 1.853 1.630 Use of third party assets The minimum future payments due for the main leases broken down by residual annual payment over the minimum contractual term are summarised in the following table. Renewals on expiry were not considered. 2015/2016 2016/2017 2017/2018 2018/2019 2019/2020 510 413 414 415 416 7.8 Use of related party assets This caption includes operating lease payments to the related party SBI S.p.A. for industrial sites where the Italian companies’ factories are located. They amount to: The following table summarises the average headcount during the year and the total at year end by category. Headcount Managers 2014/2015 2013/2014 1.394 1.393 156 30/09/2015 30/09/2014 30/09/2015 30/09/2014 27 26 26,5 27,0 240 234 237,0 234,0 Blue collars 270 261 265,5 264,0 Total 537 521 529,0 525,0 7.10 Amortisation, depreciation, accruals and impairment losses For information on captions relating to amortisation, depreciation, accruals and impairment losses, reference should be made to the tables on changes in property, plant and equipment (see 6.2 Property, plant and equipment), in intangible assets (see 6.1 Intagible assets) and the provisions for risks and charges (see 6.18 Provisions) in the notes to the statement of financial position. The following table summarises this caption. The minimum future payments due for the main leases broken down by residual annual payment over the minimum contractual term are summarised in the following table. Re- MAG | Annual Report 2015 Other 5 223 2.055 Net exchange rate gains - - Depreciation of property, plant and equipment 2.525 2.508 Total financial expense 2.450 2.801 Total amortisation and depreciation 4.825 4.563 third parties 2.260 2.572 related parties 190 229 405 - - 150 98 - Accruals for risks 1.021 224 Other accruals (115) 321 Total amortisation and depreciation, accruals and impairment losses 6.234 5.258 Impairment losses on property, plant and equipment Impairment losses on trade receivables The following table provides an analysis of other operating costs. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Prior year expense 304 502 Indirect taxes and duties 274 253 Membership dues 112 121 50 51 374 266 1.114 1.193 Books, publications, texts, databases Other Total other operating costs 7.12 Financial income and expense The following table provides a breakdown of financial income and expense, with indication of amounts relating to transactions with related parties. For additional information on related parties, reference should be made to the specific paragraph 9.2 Related party transactions (see). Interest income on discounting 2014/2015 2013/2014 295 353 Interest income on deposits with banks 6 18 Other - - Net exchange rate gains 1.918 939 Total financial income 2.219 1.310 third parties 2.219 1.310 related parties - - 2014/2015 2013/2014 including: Interest expense on discounting Current account interest expense Interest expense on loans Bank fees and commissions including: The following table provides an analysis of the net exchange rate gains and losses shown above. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Exchange rate gains 5.112 2.997 Exchange rate losses 3.194 2.058 Total net exchange rate gains 1.918 939 The captions include unrealised exchange rate gains and losses of €1,640 thousand and €665 thousand, respectively. 7.11 Other operating costs Average Junior managers and white collars ◊ €809 thousand for the Borgomanero (NO) site; ◊ €585 thousand for the Montaprandone (AP) sites. Use of related party assets Year end 2013/2014 2.300 Impairment losses on intangible assets Personnel expense Wages and salaries 2014/2015 Amortisation of intangible assets 23 47 543 838 1.383 1.306 496 387 7.13 Income taxes This caption includes income taxes and similar amounts accrued for the tax period of these financial statements, along with amounts arising from the adjustment of deferred tax assets and liabilities, which are detailed in the notes to the related statement of financial position captions (see 6.4 Deferred tax assets and 6.19 Deferred tax liabilities). In 2011/2012, the parent recognised IRES tax assets of €570 thousand for tax periods from 2007/2008 to 2011/2012, which it claimed for reimbursement on 18 February 2013. It recognised said tax assets in 2011/2012, when the law converting Legislative decree no. 201/58 of 28 December 2011 became effective – as recommended by best practices (Assonime circular no. 1 of 15 January 2013). During the year, €58 million was collected; consequently, at the reporting date, the above tax asset amounts to €512 thousand. The following table provides an analysis of total tax expense. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Current tax expense 4.158 3.828 Deferred tax income (195) (470) Deferred tax expense (498) (92) Income taxes relative to prior years Total taxes of the year - 51 3.465 3.317 The following table provides a reconciliation of the theoretical and effective tax expense. MAG | Annual Report 2015 157 Taxable profit Description Codes Current average national tax rate q Profit before tax U Taxable base IRAP Tax Taxable base Total 31,6% The tax rate applied to the deductible and taxable temporary differences varies depending on the specific situation, generally in relation to whether or not the item is relevant for the purposes of Italian IRAP. (2) (198) They have been calculated at a tax rate that combines the federal tax rate with those of the states (Pennsylvania, Maryland and Texas) where the profit was earned. 21 609 (21) (9) Tax 27,5% Tax 4,2% 9.748 9.748 Income taxes Theoretical tax expense T=Uxq Taxable temporary differences 2.681 A (714) Unrealised exchange rate gains 410 (196) (38) (676) Amortisation of goodwill - (38) Deductible temporary differences B 2.140 Other cash-deductible expenses Accruals to provisions and other allowances (38) 588 497 70 - 1.518 497 146 -- 65 - Expenses relative to more than one year Lease surplus prior to fta Unrealised exchange rate losses 341 Reversals of prior year temporary differences C 45 12 (506) Prior year items taxed in the year 859 - Prior year depreciation and amortisation to be taxed 782 (270) (757) (236) Reversal of taxed provisions/allowances Prior year items deducted in the year (838) Current taxes paid during the year are summarised below. 2014/2015 - Permanent differences D (32) (9) (4.607) (194) (203) Taxable differences and foreign tax rates E (250) (77) (906) (38) (115) Permanent differences - irap (calculated based on q’) Total temporary and permanent differences Effective current tax expense F The Canadian subsidiary did not recognise deferred tax assets on the significant tax losses by adjusting the valuation allowance. The effect of the line-by-line consolidation of Mecaer America Inc. on the profit before tax and the related theoretical tax expense is set out in the reconciliation of current tax expense (code “E”). - - 23.353 982 982 G=Σ (A:F) 1.189 319 17.793 748 1.067 T’=T+ G 10.937 3.000 27.541 1.159 4.158 Income taxes (2013/2014 balance, 2014/2015 payments on account) 1.971 Other (IRAP) – 2013/2014 balance, 2014/2015 payments on account 1.105 Line offsetting (700) Net payments of the year 2.376 116117 Taxable profit Description Codes Taxable temporary differences V Taxable base Tax IRAP Taxable base 7.14 Earnings per share Total Tax Tax (1.366) (277) Prior year development costs (646) (205) Accelerated amortisation and depreciation - deduction/ (reversal) (707) (57) Prior year interest expense on discounting Unrealised exchange rate losses 56 15 (68) (19) Other/tax effects of consolidation entries and other captions Deductible temporary differences Basic earnings per share, calculated using the profit for the year ended 30 September 2015 of €6,285 thousand and the 13,138,000 ordinary shares of the year, amount to €0.478. At 30 September 2014, basic earnings per share amounted to €0.179, calculated using the profit for the year of €2,350 thousand, divided by the same number of ordinary shares. (12) W Royalties on law no. 808/85 Projects Actuarial losses on post-employment benefits Cash-deductible expenses Excess maintenance expenses Accruals to taxed provisions Other (goodwill) Prior year leases (1.983) (323) (250) (79) 135 37 308 98 (160) (44) (1.989) (329) 39 12 (65) (18) (193) (53) Other/tax effects of consolidation entries and other captions Tax losses carried forward X Reversal of prior-year deferred tax assets Y - Recovery of income taxes relative to prior years Z (41) Total tax expense of the year T’’= T’+V+W+X+Y+Z 3.465 116 This caption is the sum of the differential between the US tax rate (average 44%) applicable to the taxable base of MAG Inc. and the Italian tax effect (27.5% +4.2%) on the taxable base of Mecaer America Inc. which does not include lower taxes offsetting losses carried forward. 117 These differences consider the different IRAP tax bases, including the effect of non-deductible personnel expenses for employees, net of admissible deductions. 158 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 159 8. Assets classified as held for sale and directly associated liabilities The group does not have assets classified as held for sale or directly associated liabilities at the reporting date. 9. Reconciliation of the parent’s profit for the year and equity with consolidated figures Equity at 30 September 2015 Equity and profit for the year of the parent 54.676 Elimination of the carrying amount of consolidated investments (6. 382) Other adjustments/reclassifications Riclassification* 13 (358) Equity and profit for the year attributable to the owners of the parent 47.936 Non-controlling interests Totale patrimonio netto e risultato consolidati 13 Profit For 2014/2015 Equity at 30 September 2014 5.288 49.388 **(203) (6.192) (274) (84) 4.811 43.112 466 (13) (2) 481 48.402 - 4.809 43.593 * Reclassification of the majority shareholder’s nominal reserves (in thousands of Euros) 2014/2015 A Cash on hand B Cash equivalents C Securities held for trading D Cash and cash equivalents (a)+(b)+(c) E Financial assets F Current bank loans and borrowings G Current portion of non-current financial debt H Other current loans and borrowings I Current financial debt (f)+(g)+(h) J Net current financial debt (i)-(e)-(d) K Non-current bank loans and borrowings L Bonds M Other non-current loans and borrowings 2013/2014 11 9 17.846 15.912 - - 17.857 15.921 - 2.967 7.274 16.304 10.379 9.397 935 1.347 18.588 27.048 731 8.160 26.334 23.807 - - 783 563 N Non-current financial debt (k)+(l)+(m) 27.117 24.370 O Net financial debt (j)+(n) 27.848 32.530 9.2 Related party transactions Transactions and balances between consolidated companies have been eliminated on consolidation. In accordance with IAS 24, the following information is provided on transactions and balances with other related parties. The details provided relate to the parent’s directors and statutory auditors. There are no other positions that fall under the definition of key management personnel as per the relevant accounting standard. Non-monetary benefits have not been included in the analysis as they are immaterial. The following data refer to 1 October 2014 – 30 September 2015. from third parties. (in thousands of Euros) ** Including the decrease in the translation reserve (€1,598 thousand). 9.1 Net financial debt The following table analyses net financial debt in accordance with the recommendations of the Consob communication of 28 July 2006, using the format provided for in the CESR recommendations of 10 February 2005 “Recommendation for the consistent implementation of the European Commission regulation on prospectuses”. 160 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Name Position Fixed fees Variable fees Other fees Total Alberto Ribolla Chairman 108 - 9 117 Valter Pasqua Deputy chairman 146 - 9 155 Corrado Monti Deputy chairman 104 - 9 113 Claudio Brun Managing director 30 - 9 39 Massimiliano Boschini Director 6 - 5 11 Emanuele Vignoli Director 4 - 6 10 Ruggero Manciati Director 10 - 9 19 Enrico Ricotta Director 10 - 8 18 Rocco Di Leo Chairman of the board of stat. Auditors 48 - 6 54 Luisa Marzoli Standing stat. Auditor 23 - 3 26 Guido Riccardi Standing stat. Auditor 30 - 3 33 MAG | Annual Report 2015 161 Related parties include: ◊ S.B.I. S.p.A., which owns the industrial properties in which MAG and SAT have their operating offices. Since 11 June 2008, it had held 60.37% of MAG; ◊ the Credito Valtellinese Group, whose subsidiaries Credito Artigiano and Mediocreval carry out transactions with group companies and share one director with MAG. The following table summarises figures (in thousands of Euros) generated by related party transactions and balances matched with the respective consolidated financial statements captions All transactions with related parties are contractually governed on an arm’s length basis. (in thousand of Euros) SBI Current loans and receivables - related parties Credito Valtellinese 25 Other non-current assets - 205 - - 1.596 - 2.836 Cash and cash equivalents - related parties Financial payables: Non-current loans and borrowings - related parties - 1.512 Other revenue and income Current loans and borrowings - related parties 20 - Use of related party assets 1.394 - Financial income - - Financial expense - 190 9.3 Directors’, statutory auditors’ and independent auditors’ fees IThe Directors’ fees total €457 thousand.The Statutory Auditors’ fees for the year total €101 thousand.The Independent auditors’ fees total €90 thousand. 9.4 Events after the reporting date There is nothing to report. On behalf of the Board of Directors Claudio Brun - Managing Director (signed on the original) 162 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Separate financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 semptember 2015 Translation from the Italian original which remains the definitive version Report of the auditors in accordance with article 14 of Legislative decree no. 39 of 27 January 2010 To the shareholders of Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. 1. We have audited the separate financial statements of Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015, comprising the statement of financial position, statement of comprehensive income, statement of changes in equity, statement of cash flows and notes thereto. The company’s directors are responsible for the preparation of these financial statements in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards endorsed by the European Union. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audit. 2. We conducted our audit in accordance with the auditing standards recommended by Consob, the Italian Commission for Listed Companies and the Stock Exchange. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the separate financial statements are free of material misstatement and are, as a whole, reliable. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by directors. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion. Reference should be made to the report dated 23 December 2014 for our opinion on the prior year separate financial statements, which included the corresponding figures presented for comparative purposes. 3. In our opinion, the separate financial statements of Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015 comply with the International Financial Reporting Standards endorsed by the European Union. Therefore, they are clearly stated and give a true and fair view of the financial position of Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A., the results of its operations and its cash flows for the year then ended. 4. The directors of Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. are responsible for the preparation of a directors’ report on the financial statements in accordance with the applicable laws. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the consistency of the directors’ report with the financial statements to which it refers, as required by the law. For this purpose, we have performed the procedures required by the Italian Standard on Auditing 001 issued by the Italian Accounting Profession and recommended by Consob. In our opinion, the directors’ report is consistent with the separate financial statements of Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015. Novara, 23 December 2015 KPMG S.p.A. Marco Boniardi - Director of Audit (signed on the original) Financial statements Statement of financial position (1/2) (in Euros) Description Note Intangible assets 5.1 Property, plant and equipment 5.2 3.556.303 3.996.438 (440.135) Equity investments 5.3 41.293.937 35.043.937 6.250.000 Deferred tax assets 5.4 2.597.723 2.416.517 181.206 Other non-current assets 5.5 2.195.736 3.322.009 (1.126.273) Other non-current assets - Related parties 5.6 2.458.102 2.994.318 (536.216) 8.151.721 Total non-current assets Difference 21.598.974 3.823.139 77.523.914 69.372.193 5.7 36.581.685 37.294.746 (713.061) Contract work in progress 5.8 5.639.310 3.447.563 2.191.747 Trade receivables 5.9 17.485.987 29.768.906 (12.282.919) Current loans and receivables - related parties 5.10 8.439.200 9.366.735 (927.535) Tax assets 5.11 512.486 1.372.626 (860.140) Other current assets 5.12 5.094.651 7.764.715 (2.670.064) Current financial assets 5.13 - 2.967.000 (2.967.000) Cash and cash equivalents 5.14 14.322.175 14.374.359 (52.184) Cash and cash equivalents - related parties 5.15 1.595.809 1.033.771 562.038 Assets classified as held for sale and directly associated liabilities 7 - - - 89.671.303 107.390.421 (17.719.118) 167.195.217 176.762.614 (9.567.397) Total current assets MAG | Annual Report 2015 30.09.2014 25.422.113 Inventories Total assets 168 30.09.2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 169 Statement of financial position (2/2) (in Euros) Description Note Share capital MAG | Annual Report 2015 30.09.2014 Difference 13.138.000 - Share premium reserve 5.563.684 5.563.684 - Other reserves 30.810.264 26.482.250 4.328.014 Profit for the year 5.164.079 4.203.937 960.142 Equity 54.676.027 49.387.871 5.288.156 1.791.329 2.200.018 (408.689) Total equity 5.16 Employee benefits – post-employment benefits 5.17 Provisions 5.18 2.457.091 1.984.927 472.164 Deferred tax liabilities 5.19 8.281.485 8.565.996 (284.511) Non-current loans and borrowings 5.20 23.810.644 24.089.428 (278.784) Non-current loans and borrowings - related parties 5.20 2.836.291 - 2.836.291 Other non-current liabilities 5.21 Total non-current liabilities 170 30.09.2015 13.138.000 22.125.407 22.055.703 69.704 61.302.247 58.896.072 2.406.175 Advances from customers 5.22 2.227.739 1.258.612 969.127 Current loans and borrowings 5.20 17.075.827 26.269.817 (9.193.990) Current loans and borrowings - related parties 5.20 663.709 - 663.709 Trade payables 5.23 21.821.403 31.256.750 (9.435.347) Current financial liabilities - related parties 5.24 2.966.477 3.740.660 (774.183) Tax liabilities 5.25 669.102 468.838 200.264 Other current liabilities 5.26 5.792.686 5.483.994 308.692 Liabilities directly associated with assets held for sale 7 - - - Total current liabilities 51.216.943 68.478.671 (17.261.728) Total liabilities 112.519.190 127.374.743 (14.855.553) Total equity and liabilities 167.195.217 176.762.614 (9.567.397) MAG | Annual Report 2015 171 Statement of comprehensive income (in Euros) Description Note 30.09.2015 30.09.2014 Net revenue 6.1 89.161.226 105.667.402 Net revenue - related parties 6.2 4.391.506 3.922.192 Other revenue and income 6.3 651.148 551.118 Other revenue and income - related parties 6.4 23.000 122.503 Variation in finished products, work in progress and semi-finished goods 6.5 764.790 (8.677.585) Increase in internal work capitalised 6.6 5.813.811 7.328.689 Raw materials, consumables and supplies 6.7 (28.505.832) (29.790.297) Raw materials, consumables and supplies - related parties 6.8 (2.459.572) (3.983.070) Services 6.9 (26.993.633) (33.677.567) Services - related parties 6.10 (4.795.052) (4.447.784) Use of third party assets 6.11 (763.176) (819.503) Use of related party assets 6.12 (1.541.201) (1.539.689) Personnel expense 6.13 (21.752.525) (21.422.047) Amortisation, depreciation, accruals and impairment losses 6.14 (4.059.496) (3.391.942) Other operating costs 6.15 (690.514) (853.778) Other operating costs - related parties 6.16 Operating profit - - 9.244.480 8.988.638 sFinancial income 6.17 1.487.507 903.616 Financial income - related parties 6.17 227.046 47.859 Financial expense 6.17 (2.229.219) (2.533.716) Financial expense - related parties 6.17 (142.159) (169.053) 8.587.655 7.237.344 6.18 (3.423.576) (3.033.407) 5.164.079 4.203.937 6.19 0,3931 0,3200 Profit before tax Income taxes Profit for the year Earnings per share Other comprehensive income (expense) that will be subsequently reclassified to profit or loss Income taxes on other comprehensive income Other comprehensive income (expense) that will not be subsequently reclassified to profit or loss Ias 19 effect recognised directly in equity 172 MAG | Annual Report 2015 124.076 (217.214) Other comprehensive income (expense), net of income taxes 5.17 124.076 (217.214) Total comprehensive income 5.288.155 3.986.723 MAG | Annual Report 2015 173 Statement of cash flows (in Euros) Description Note 30.09.2015 30.09.2014 A 7.1 18.375.130 2.370.292 8.587.655 7.237.344 4.059.496 3.391.942 1.482.946 (10.409.033) Opening net cash and cash equivalents Profit before tax Amortisation, depreciation and impairment losses 6.14 Variation in net working capital Net variation in employee benefits - post-employment benefits 5.17 (284.613) (176.492) Net variation in provisions 5.18 (434.076) (110.024) Net variation in deferred taxes 5.4/5.19 (465.717) (551.841) Current taxes 6.18 (3.075.503) (4.554.819) 860.140 (801.811) 465.717 551.841 11.196.045 (5.422.893) Variation in tax assets Deferred taxes B 6.18 Cash flows from (used in) operating activities Net investments in non-current assets C - Intangible assets 5.1 (5.656.579) (6.523.486) - Property, plant and equipment 5.2 (879.681) (2.133.764) - Financial assets 5.3 (1.993.826) (250.000) - Other investing activities 5.5/5.6 779.965 813.414 - Assets/liabilities held for sale 7 - - (7.750.121) (8.093.836) Cash flows used in investing activities Variation in current loans and borrowings – new loans 5.20 866.649 20.056.294 Variation in current loans and borrowings - settlements 5.20 (9.396.930) (4.994.869) Variation in non-current loans and borrowings – new loans 5.20 13.324.364 18.408.089 Variation in non-current loans and borrowings - settlements 5.20 (10.766.857) (4.307.328) Variation in other non-current liabilities 5.21 69.704 359.383 Share capital increase 5.16 - - - - Net exchange rate gains (losses) on the translation of foreign operations Ias 19 effect recognised directly in equity 174 MAG | Annual Report 2015 - - D Cash flows from (used in) financing activities 5.17 (5.903.070) 29.521.569 E Cash flows of the year (2.457.146) 16.004.838 F Closing net cash and cash equivalents 15.917.984 18.375.130 7.1 MAG | Annual Report 2015 175 Statement of changes in equity (in Euros) 176 MAG | Annual Report 2015 Description Share capital Share premium reserve Other reserves Heading reserve Profit for the year Equity Equity at 01.10.2013 13.138.000 5.563.684 19.454.427 742 7.244.295 45.401.148 Allocation of profit for the year - - 7.244.635 (340) (7.244.295) - Capital injections - - - - - Ias 19 effect recognised directly in equity - - (217.214) - - (217.214) Profit for the year - - - - 4.203.937 4.203.937 Equity at 30.09.2014 13.138.000 5.563.684 26.481.848 402 4.203.937 49.387.871 Allocation of profit for the year - 4.204.324 (387) (4.203.937) - Capital injections - - - - - Ias 19 and ias 39 effect recognised in equity - - 124.076 - - 124.076 Rounding reserve - - 1 - - 1 Profit for the year - - - - 5.164.079 5.164.079 Equity at 30.09.2015 13.138.000 5.563.684 30.810.249 15 5.164.079 54.676.027 MAG | Annual Report 2015 177 Notes to the separate financial statements 1. Overview 2. Basis of preparation Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A. (“MAG S.p.A.” or “MAG”) is a company limited by shares. It was set up in Italy and is registered with the company registrar of Novara. Under the option provided for by Legislative decree no. 38 of 28 February 2005 and as in the previous year, the separate financial statements as at and for the year ended 30 September 2015 have been prepared in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”), endorsed by the European Commission and included in EU regulations. MAG supplies systems for helicopters and small airplanes and provides the related aircraft interiors and completions services, as well as maintenance and repair services. MAG S.p.A.’s registered office is in Via per Arona, 46, Borgomanero (Novara), where some corporate functions are also located. The company conducts its business activities in four different locations (Borgomanero, Novara; Monteprandone, Ascoli Piceno, Vergiate, Varese and Rome), as described in more detail in the directors’ report. The Yeovil site in the United Kingdom was closed during the year. Figures in these notes are provided in Euros. The board of directors submitted these consolidated financial statements to the shareholders for approval on 22 December 2015. The acronym IFRS also refers to all revised Standards (“IAS”) and the interpretations of the International Financial Interpretations Committee (“IFRIC”), formerly known as the Standing Interpretations Committee (“SIC”). The 2013/2014 corresponding figures presented for comparative purposes also comply with the IFRS. At the time when these notes were prepared, adjustments and interpretations by official bodies with respect to certain aspects were still pending. Accordingly, additional changes or integrations could be made to the Standards and interpretations that could require or allow MAG to change the recognition, measurement and classification criteria adopted in the preparation of these separate financial statements. As permitted by IAS 1, the statement of comprehensive income has been prepared presenting costs by nature, highlighting operating profit and profit before taxes. To better measure the performance of continuing operations, expense and revenue arising from significant events or transactions are indicated separately. The statement of financial position has been prepared by separating current assets and liabilities from those that are non-current and by recognising any assets and liabilities held for sale and discontinued operations separately, in accordance with IFRS 5. Specifically, an asset or liability is classified as current when it meets any of the following conditions: ◊ it is expected to be realised or settled or is held for 180 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 181 sale or consumption in the normal course of the company’s operating cycle; ◊ it is held primarily for trading purposes; ◊ it is expected to be realised or settled within twelve months of the reporting date. ◊ If none of these conditions is met, the asset or liability is classified as non-current. Il The statement of cash flows has been prepared using the indirect method, whereby operating profit is adjusted by the effect of non-monetary transactions, any deferrals or accruals of previous or future collections or payments in relation to operating activities and any expense or revenue relating to cash flows arising from investing or financing activities. Income and expense on non-current loans, the related hedging instruments and any dividends paid are included under operating activities. The statement of changes in equity shows the following changes in equity captions, where applicable: ◊ allocation of profit for the year; ◊ owner transactions (repurchase or sale of treasury shares); ◊ any gains or losses, net of the tax effect, recognised directly in equity (gains or losses on the repurchase/sale of treasury shares) or that have a balancing entry in an equity reserve (e.g., share-based payments for stock option plans); ◊ changes in the hedging reserve, net of any tax effect; ◊ changes in the fair value reserve; ◊ effects of any changes in the accounting policies. 2.1 Use of estimates The preparation of the separate financial statements and related notes in accordance with IFRS requires the company to make estimates and assumptions with an effect on the carrying amounts of recognised assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the reporting date. Actual results may differ from these estimates. The estimates and assumptions are periodically revised and the effects of any changes are taken to profit or loss. Estimates mainly relate to the captions listed below with reference to their section in the notes. note Research and development costs 5.1 Goodwil 5.1 Inventories 5.7 Contract work in progress 5.8 Trade receivables 5.9 Derivatives 3.2.4 Income taxes 5.4 - 5.19 - 6.18 Employee benefits – post-employment benefits 5.17 Provisions 5.18 2.2 Segment reporting Information on the performance of the company’s operating and geographical segments is provided below, in accordance with IFRS 8, on the basis of available financial statements data and in line with the main policies used to periodically examine the segment results at the highest decision-making level in order to evaluate performance. MAG’s business activities may be divided into two main operating segments, which comprise organisational structures, including divisions. a) The Integrated Aircraft Systems related to the development and production of systems for OEMs118, which comprise, because of similarity, the pre-existing divisions: i. The Actuation and Landing Systems (“ALS”) whose product lines include safety critical systems, specifically landing gear, flight controls, actuators, dampening and hydraulic systems, ii. The Cabin Comfort Systems (“CCS”), whose product lines include cabin technical/functional systems (noise-vibration reduction systems, environmental optimisation systems, cabin management); b) The Aircraft Services, which relates to services for standard aircraft, providing customers or operators with a customised platform for the specific mission (development of customised design solutions, installation kits, maintenance and repair of aircraft and parts thereof). As permitted by IFRS 8.12, the ALS and the CCS divisions have been combined into one reportable segment (Integrated Aircraft Systems) because of their similarity. Their distinctive feature is essentially the type of offer (systems) and the target market. The Aircraft Services remains a segment and coincides with the relevant division. Its core activity comprises a range of services which includes installation kits as well as aircraft design, completion, refurbishment and MRO. Turnover analysed by operating and geographical segment is presented below, in comparison with the previous year. Revenue by operating and geographical segment (in Euros) Integrated Aircraft Systems 2014/2015 2013/2014 Eur % Eur % Europe – eurozone 70.048 81,6% 82.233 81,8% Europe - non-eurozone 1.862 2,2% 2.321 2,3% North america 13.267 15,5% 14.405 14,3% Rest of the world 674 0,7% 1.579 1,6% Total 85.851 100,0% 100.538 100% Aircraft Services 2014/2015 2013/2014 Eur % Eur % Europe – eurozone 7.702 100,0% 9.052 100,0% Europe - non-eurozone - - - - North america - - - - Rest of the world - - - - Total 7.702 100,0% 9.052 100,0% 2014/2015 2013/2014 Eur % Eur % Europe – eurozone 77.750 83,1% 91.285 83,3% Europe - non-eurozone 1.862 2,0% 2.321 2,1% North america 13.267 14,2% 14.405 13,1% Rest of the world 674 0,7% 1.579 1,5% Total 93.553 100,0% 109.590 100,0% Total The company’s results, in terms of the revenue and profitability of its operating segments, are summarised in the table on the following page. With respect to the previous year, some industrial costs were reallocated. Performance by operating segment (in Euros) Description Integrated Aircraft Systems 2014/2015 2013/2014 2014/2015 2013/2014 2014/2015 2013/2014 2014/2015 2013/2014 Segment revenue 92.774.082 99.799.092 7.415.466 8.558.426 - - 100.189.549 108.357.518 Aircraft Services Unallocated Total Segment expense (74.634.437) (82.035.242) (6.271.306) (7.246.954) (9.536.307) (9.622.272) (90.442.051) (98.904.468) Segment operating profit/ (loss) 18.139.645 17.763.850 1.144.160 1.311.472 (9.536.307) (9.622.272) 9.747.498 9.453.050 As a % of revenue 20% 18% 15% 15% N/A N/A 10% 9% Despite the slight decrease in volumes, the Integrated Aircraft Systems segment recorded a significant improvement in operating profit as the result of the process improvement and structure efficiency plan. Similarly, the Aircraft Services segment recorded slightly lower volumes and a constant operating profit. The following table provides a reconciliation of the segment operating profits or losses, as calculated for decision-making purposes, with the operating profit recognised in the separate financial statements. Description Integrated Aircraft Systems Aircraft Services Unallocated Total 2014/2015 2013/2014 2014/2015 2013/2014 2014/2015 2013/2014 2014/2015 2013/2014 18.139.645 17.763.850 1.144.160 1.311.472 (9.536.307) (9.622.272) 9.747.498 9.453.050 Development costs 217.784 (85.592) - - - - 217.784 (85.592) Leases (35.689) (24.906) - - - - (35.689) (24.906) Goodwill - 68.006 - - - - - 68.006 Net non-operating income (1.110.405) (158.945) - - 425.292 (314.699) (685.113) (473.644) Other differences - - - - Operating profit (loss) 17.211.335 17.562.413 1.144.160 1.311.472 Segment operating profit/(loss) Differences in accounting policies: 51.725 (9.111.015) (9.885.247) 51.725 9.244.480 8.988.638 118 Original Equipment Manufacturer. 182 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 183 Non-operating income and expense mainly refer to non-core economic components, of an exceptional or non-recurring nature. The following table summarises assets and liabilities by operating segment. Integrated Aircraft Systems Aircraft Services Unallocated 2014/2015 2013/2014 2014/2015 2013/2014 2014/2015 2013/2014 2014/2015 2013/2014 Segment assets 120.648.539 122.600.462 16.809.452 16.875.022 29.737.226 35.287.130 167.195.217 176.762.614 Segment liabilities (50.215.420) (57.496.575) (1.177.697) (2.720.077) (115.802.099) (116.545.962) (167.195.217) (176.762.614) Segment investments 6.125.584 7.857.839 24.645 5.200 386.031 794.211 6.536.260 8.657.250 Amortisation, depreciation and impairment losses 2.668.754 2.373.121 19.608 24.147 464.895 422.990 3.153.256 2.820.258 Description Total Infrasegment transactions are immaterial and, accordingly, have not been shown separately. The above assets do not include current and non-current financial assets, other current and non-current assets, tax assets, deferred tax assets and cash and cash equivalents. Liabilities do not include equity, current and non-current borrowings, deferred tax liabilities, other current liabilities, tax liabilities and employee benefits. The trade payables related to the Aircraft Services segment are presented separately only to the extent of the portion which could be distinguished by supplier or type of transaction. The Integrated Aircraft Systems segment’s investment includes the financial expense on equity investments (Mecaer America Inc.) and development costs for new products. The latter is net of the assistance granted under Law no. 808/85 to eligible projects. The Aircraft Services segment includes the financial expense on equity investments (MAG Inc. and S.A.T. S.p.A.). Il settore Aicrafts Services comprende la componente finanziaria, costituita dalle partecipazioni (MAG Inc. e S.A.T. S.p.A.). 3. Main accounting policies The accounting policies applied to the most important captions are described below. 3.1 Non-current assets 3.1.1 Intangible assets Intangible assets are identifiable non-monetary assets without physical substance that generate future economic benefits for the company. They are recognised at purchase or production cost, including directly related charges incurred to prepare them for use, net of accumulated amortisation and any impairment losses. Amortisation begins when the asset becomes available for use and is calculated systematically over the residual useful life of each asset. Amortisation is calculated considering the actual use of the asset in the year in which an intangible asset is initially recognised. Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are not amortised. The amortisation periods of intangible assets are summarised in the table below. Reference should be made to the note to each caption for specific details on the identification criteria. Amort. period (years) Development costs Product useful life Industrial patents and intellectual property rights 5 Licences 3 Software 3 Goodwill Indefinite useful life Other deferred costs Term of agreement 3.1.1.1 Research and development costs Costs for research, undertaken to gain new scientific or technical knowledge and understanding, are taken to profit 184 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 185 or loss when incurred. Costs for development provide for plan or design for the production of new or substantially improved products or processes. Development costs are capitalised if, and only if, the cost can be reliably measured and estimated, the product or process are technically and commercially feasible, future economic benefits are probable, the company has the intention as well as adequate technical and financial resources to complete the development. starting in the year in which the right that the company has acquired becomes available for use. Amortisation is calculated over the shorter of the period of expected use and the period for which the right has been acquired. 3.1.1.3 Licences, concessions and trademarks These include the following: These costs, which are identifiable and can be measured, relate to specific development projects commissioned by customers or arising from the company’s participation in international projects. They are highly technically and commercially feasible and the group can reasonably demonstrate that they will generate future economic benefits. ◊ concessions, i.e., public administration measures giving private entities the right to exclusively use public assets or manage public services under regulated conditions; ◊ licences attributing the right to use patents or other intangible assets over a determined or determinable period of time; ◊ licences to use know-how, application software or the rights of others; ◊ trademarks identifying the origin of products from a specific company. The portion of internal and external development costs exceeding the related revenue to be received from customers is capitalised against each project as development costs and is amortised over the period in which the company reasonably expects that the future benefits will arise. The costs, including direct and indirect expenses incurred to obtain these rights, are capitalised after the rights have been acquired and are amortised systematically over the shorter of the period of expected use and the period for which the right has been acquired. In determining the useful life of each aerospace product developed, the company considers the following: 3.1.1.4 Goodwill Specifically, this caption entirely relates to costs incurred for the development of new aerospace products. ◊ the estimated useful life of the aircraft or the versions of the aircraft on which the product will be used, on the basis of sales plans provided by the manufacturer; ◊ the estimated useful life of the specific product, also considering its technological features and conditions of use. Amortisation is calculated on a straight-line basis. Goodwill arises from business combinations and reflects an excess in the acquisition cost of the business or business unit over the total fair value of acquired assets and liabilities and identified contingent liabilities. As it has an indefinite useful life, goodwill is not amortised. Instead, it is tested for impairment at least once a year to verify if it has undergone impairment losses, which are taken immediately to profit or loss and cannot be reversed, even within the limits of previous impairment. The amortisation period begins when the products become available for use, which unequivocally coincides with the definitive certification of the product or aircraft to which it refers by the relevant bodies and authorities. Goodwill on acquisitions that took place before transition to IFRS continues to be recognised at its carrying amount under Italian GAAP and is tested for impairment on an annual basis. Costs incurred for projects eligible for the assistance provided by Law no. 808 of 24 December 1985119 and considered functional to “national security” and similar costs are recognised net of the related benefits (see 4. Significant 3.1.2 matters, 4.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to law no. 808/85). 3.1.1.2 Industrial patents and intellectual property rights Industrial patents and intellectual property rights are recognised at acquisition cost, net of amortisation and any impairment losses accumulated over time. They are amortised 119 [Official Gazette ed. 005 of 8 January 1986] “Interventi per lo sviluppo e l’accrescimento di competitività delle industrie operanti nel settore aeronautico”. 186 Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are measured at purchase or production cost, net of accumulated depreciation and any impairment losses. Cost includes direct charges incurred to prepare assets for use and any dismantlement and removal costs incurred to restore the site to its original conditions. Costs for ordinary and/or routine maintenance and repairs are taken directly to profit or loss when incurred. Costs for improvements and maintenance that materially increase the production capacity or safety of assets or that MAG | Annual Report 2015 prolong their useful lives are capitalised as an increase in the carrying amount of the assets to which they relate. Any government grants or grants relating to assets are taken as a direct decrease in the cost of the asset to which they relate. The carrying amount of each asset is depreciated on a systematic basis. Depreciation is calculated on a straight-line basis each year over the residual useful lives of assets. The useful lives and depreciation criteria are periodically reviewed and, where material changes are noted with respect to the assumptions previously made, the depreciation rate is adjusted on a prospective basis. An asset’s useful life is generally confirmed each year and adjusted if there have been improvements or replacements affecting its useful life. The rates applied to reflect useful lives are reduced by half in the year in which assets go into use, since this reduction is considered adequately indicative of the weighted average period of use from when the assets went into use to the end of the year. The following table lists depreciation periods for each item of property, plant and equipment. Deprec. period (years) Light constructions 10 Generic plant – non-automated machines 10 Automated machines 5–6 Automated robotic machines 4–5 Electrolyte and galvanic cells 5 Furnaces and accessories 6–7 Generic equipment 4 Specific equipment 4 Inspection and testing tools 3–5 Electronic office machines 5 Furniture and furnishings 8–9 Motor vehicles 4 Internal means of transport 5 These costs are recognised as leasehold improvements and are classified under property, plant and equipment, according to their nature. The depreciation period is the shorter of the asset’s residual useful life and the term of the lease or free loan agreement. 3.1.3 Equity investments The company classifies its equity investments as follows: ◊ subsidiaries, over which the investor has the power to govern the financial and operating policies so as to obtain benefits from its activities; ◊ associates, over which the investor has significant influence (at least 20% of votes in the ordinary shareholders’ meeting). Jointly controlled entities (e.g., joint ventures) are included in this category; ◊ parents, when the investor holds shares of its parent; ◊ other companies that do not fall into any of the above categories. Any equity investments held for sale, such as those that are acquired solely for the purpose of disposal within twelve months, are classified separately as “assets held for sale”. Subsidiaries, including jointly-controlled subsidiaries, and associates, with the exception of those that are classified as “assets held for sale”, are measured at acquisition or incorporation cost. This cost remains in subsequent financial statements unless there are impairment losses or reversals of impairment losses following a variation in the purpose of the company or equity transactions. Equity investments held for sale are measured at the lower of cost and fair value less costs to sell. 3.1.4 Impairment losses At least once a year, the company tests the recoverability of the carrying amount of intangible assets, property, plant and equipment and investments in subsidiaries and associates to determine whether they have undergone impairment losses. If a depreciable asset is comprised of separately identifiable components with useful lives that differ significantly from the other components comprising the asset, depreciation is calculated separately for each component, using the component approach. Profits and losses on the sale of assets or groups of assets are measured by comparing the selling price with the related carrying amount. Costs incurred to expand, upgrade and improve structural components of third parties are capitalised solely to the extent to which they meet the requirements for separate classification as assets or components of assets. If there is evidence of impairment, the carrying amount of the asset is reduced to its recoverable amount, which is the greater of fair value less costs to sell and the asset’s value in use. In particular, in evaluating whether there have been any impairment losses on investments in subsidiaries and associates120, the recoverable amount is defined as value in use, which is the present value of estimated cash flows based on the investee’s expected results and the estimated proceeds from the ultimate disposal, in accordance with the provisions of IAS 28. 120 If these are equity investments in unlisted companies for which fair value less costs to sell cannot be reliably measured. MAG | Annual Report 2015 187 When, subsequently, impairment losses decrease or no longer exist, the carrying amount of the asset is restored to a new estimate of the recoverable amount that can be reliably measured. Reversals of impairment losses are never applied to goodwill, as recommended by IAS 36 (see also 3.1.1.4 Goodwill). Financial assets with fixed maturity are measured at amortised cost, which is calculated using the effective interest method. When financial assets do not have a fixed maturity, they are measured at cost. Loans and receivables due after one year that do not bear interest or that bear interest at below market rates are discounted using market rates. paid for external processing. Estimated realisable value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business considering any costs of completion and the estimated costs necessary to make the sale. The carrying amount of inventories is adjusted through a specific allowance to consider slow-moving or obsolete items. The company classifies inventories as follows: ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ raw materials, consumables and supplies; work in progress and semi-finished products; finished products and goods for resale; payments on account. The company regularly measures financial assets to verify if there is objective evidence that they, taken individually or collectively, have undergone impairment losses. If there is evidence in this respect, the impairment losses are taken to profit or loss for the year. 3.2.2 3.1.5 Attività classificate come possedute per la vendita The stage of completion is calculated using the physical measurement criterion, i.e., by measuring the size of the work completed. The cost method is used as a benchmark. Assets (or disposal groups) are defined as held for sale when their carrying amount will be recovered through disposal rather than through continuous use, as long as the sale is highly probable. Assets (or disposal groups) remain classified as held for sale even if there are delays or postponements in the period necessary for the finalisation or conclusion of the sale, as long as the delays are caused by events or circumstances that are beyond the company’s control and there is sufficient evidence of the company’s commitment to implement the disposal plan. Assets that meet the criteria for classification as held for sale are measured at the lower of carrying amount and fair value less costs to sell. They are not amortised or depreciated. 3.2 Current assets 3.2.1 Inventories Contract work in progress is recognised considering contractual considerations accrued with reasonable certainty based on the percentage of completion. The considerations calculated are based on contractually agreed prices, including claims for price revisions and any other reasonably expected additional fees. Contracts with considerations in currency other than the functional currency are measured by translating the portion of considerations accrued at the closing rate. The measurement reflects the best estimate of projects at the reporting date. The company periodically updates the assumptions underlying these measurements. Any effects are recognised in the year in which the adjustments are made. Contract work in progress is recognised net of any allowances and progress billings relating to the contract in progress. This analysis is performed individually for each contract, recognising: Inventories are measured at the lower of purchase or production cost, including directly related charges, net of discounts and allowances, and estimated realisable value. Cost is calculated using the weighted average cost method. Finished products and work in progress are measured at the progressive average cost for materials, plus the average hourly cost of labour for internal processing and price 188 Contract work in progress ◊ the positive difference (work in progress in excess of progress billings) under contract work in progress; ◊ the negative difference (work in progress less than progress billings) under other current liabilities; ◊ any advances are recognised under other current liabilities. 3.2.3 Trade reveivables and other assets which generally corresponds with nominal amount, and subsequently measured at amortised cost, net of identified impairment losses. The company assesses their recoverability on the basis of the present value of estimated future cash flows. 3.2.4 Derivatives Derivatives are always classified as assets held for trading and measured at fair value through profit or loss, unless they qualify for hedge accounting and are effective in hedging the underlying assets, liabilities or commitments of the company. In specifically identified cases, the company occasionally uses derivatives exclusively as part of its strategies of hedging interest rate risk on loans that accrue interest at variable rates. The company generally does not use other types of derivatives, as management does not believe that there are significant risks of fluctuations in the fair value of recognised assets or liabilities or due to contractual commitments (fair value hedges) or fluctuations in expected cash flows on contractual or highly probably transactions (cash flow hedges). 3.3 Equity 3.3.1 Share capital Share capital is comprised of the company’s subscribed and paid-in share capital. Any costs closely related to the issue of shares are classified as a decrease in share capital when they are directly related to such transaction. 3.3.2 Share premium reserve This reserve includes the amounts arising from capital increases against consideration in excess of the nominal amount of shares. 3.3.3 Other reserves These include retained earnings or losses carried forward from previous years and the legal reserve. 3.3.4 Heading reserve This reserve arises from recognising the effective portion of hedging transactions using derivatives directly in equity. 3.3.5 Earnings per share The effectiveness of hedges is documented at the inception of the transaction, as well as periodically at each annual reporting date. Hedge effectiveness is measured by comparing the variations in the fair value of the hedging instrument with those of the hedged item, or, in the event of more complex instruments, using statistical analysis based on risk variations. Basic earnings (losses) per share are calculated by dividing the profit (loss) for year the by the number of ordinary shares. The fair value of instruments listed on regulated markets is taken with reference to the respective bid prices at the reporting date. All shares are ordinary. There are no dilutive effects to take into account. The fair value of instruments not listed on regulated markets is measured using financial calculation techniques. In the event of transactions affecting share capital during the year, the number of shares is calculated as the weighted average of the year. 3.4 Financial and other liabilities In particular, the fair value of interest rate swaps is measured by discounting estimated cash flows. Specifically, the fair value analysis is integrated by tests carried out to verify the prospective and retrospective effectiveness of the hedge, as required by IAS 39. Financial and other liabilities are initially recognised at fair value, net of transaction costs. 3.2.5 They are classified as current liabilities, unless the company has a contractual right to settle its obligations after twelve months from the reporting date. Cash and cash equivalent This caption includes cash on hand, deposits and current accounts with banks, post offices or other credit institutions available for current transactions and other equivalents. They are subsequently measured at amortised cost, using the effective interest method. It also includes any current and highly liquid financial investments that are readily convertible into cash and not subject to significant risks of fluctuations in value. Trade receivables and other assets falling due within normal commercial terms are initially recognised at fair value, MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 189 3.5 Employee benefits - Postemployment benefits 3.5.1 Unless internal labour agreements provide for more favourable conditions for employees, they may only obtain the advance once during employment for well-specified reasons (purchase of first home, medical expenses). Post-employment benefits The company uses two different types of employment (or integrative) benefits that take into account, for the Italian companies, the pension reform introduced by Law no. 296 of 27 December 2006 with effect from 1 January 2007. Defined contribution plans The company pays fixed contributions to a separate entity (fund) and will not have a legal or constructive obligation to pay additional contributions if the mandated entity does not have sufficient assets to pay benefits for past service. The company recognises contributions to the plan when the employees provide service in exchange for the contributions. Defined benefit plans In this case, the company is obliged to pay agreed benefits for employees in service and former employees by assuming actuarial and investment risks in relation to the plan. Accordingly, the cost of the plan is not calculated based on contributions due for the year, but on the basis of demographic and statistical assumptions and salary increase trends. Post-employment benefits (called “TFR” in Italy) fall under the employee benefits regulated by IAS 19. Italian post-employment benefits are governed by article 2120 of the Italian Civil Code and are each employee’s right upon termination of employment. The amount of postemployment benefits due by the employer is equal to the sum of 7.41% of annual remuneration valid for calculation purposes due for the year. This amount is decreased by 0.5% to fund the Post-employment Benefit Guarantee Fund set up with INPS (the Italian social security institution), which replaces insolvent employers. In addition, any amounts that the employee has decided to allocate to a contractual pension fund are also deducted. For revaluation purposes, post-employment benefits are increased, with the exclusion of the portion accrued at 31 December of each year, by applying a rate comprised of a fixed rate of 1.50% and 75% of the inflation rate recorded by the cost of living index for December of the previous year. This revaluation is taxable at a rate of 11%. Furthermore, legislation ensures that employees can request a partial advance on post-employment benefits vested during employment. Only those employees who have worked for the company for at least eight years may request an advance, and they may only request up to 70% of their post-employment benefits vested at the date of the request. 190 Under Italian legislation, the carrying amount of post-employment benefits is equal to the amount accrued by each employee at the reporting date. Accordingly, the amount accrued is equal to the total that would be paid to all employees if they were all to terminate their employment at that date. Under IFRS and considering the indications provided by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) and the International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC), TFR is considered post-employment benefits under a defined-benefit plan and should be calculated using actuarial techniques. Before the pension reform took effect (1 January 2007), the projected unit credit method (PUCM) provided for by IAS 19.64/66 was used. It is still applied by companies with fewer than 49 employees and calculates the average present value of benefit obligations vested through employee service up to the date of the valuation, using projected remuneration. To consider the effects of the reform on companies with more than 49 employees, at the reporting date, the company applied a different approach, which, in short, provides for: ◊ the projection of post-employment benefits already vested for each employee in service at the measurement date up to the estimated time of payment; ◊ the measurement of estimated post-employment benefit payments for each employee that the company will be required to make upon termination of employment due to dismissal, resignation, inability to work, death or retirement or requested advances; ◊ the discounting of each estimated payment at the measurement date. In accordance with the instructions provided by documents issued by the Italian Accounting Standard Setter (OIC)121, the company has applied this new approach, which provides that companies do not consider future vesting portions of post-employment benefits and apply amounts on a pro rata basis to reproportion the present value of the obligation, from the date when the pension reform took effect - 1 January 2007 - to measure the effects of curtailment, as 121 Appendix to Operating Guide 1 for transition to International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), chapter 13 “Consequences of Law no. 296/2006”. MAG | Annual Report 2015 specified in IAS 19.109. 3.7 Following the amendment to IAS 19 (2011), the company changed the accounting treatment applied to calculate income and expense related to defined benefit plans. Leases are considered finance leases when, as specified by IAS 17, the risks and rewards incidental to ownership of the leased asset are transferred to the lessee. In accordance with IAS 19 (2011) amended, the company calculates the net financial expense (income) of the year from defined benefit plan liabilities (assets) by applying the discount rate used to measure the defined benefit obligation at the beginning of the year to the defined benefit plan liabilities (assets) at the beginning of the year, considering any changes to these defined benefit plan liabilities (assets) of the year arising from benefit contribution or payment. As lessee, at the date of initial recognition, the company recognises leased assets under non-current assets and recognises a financial liability at the same time equal to the lower of the asset’s fair value and the present value of minimum future payments due at inception of the lease, using the implicit interest rate of the lease or the marginal interest rate of the loan. Based on the above, net financial expense on defined benefit plan liabilities (assets) now include: ◊ interest expense on the defined benefit obligation; ◊ interest income on plan assets; and ◊ interest on the effect of the asset ceiling. Financial leases Subsequently, the company takes the amortisation charge applied to the asset to profit or loss, along with interest separated from the payments of the year. 3.8 Operating leases All gains and losses arising from the actuarial calculation at the reporting date are recognised in other comprehensive income. Company leases that do not substantially transfer all the risks and rewards incidental to ownership of the leased asset are recognised as operating leases. 3.5.2 Payments receivable or payable on operating leases are taken to profit or loss over the term of the lease. Termination benefits Termination benefits are recognised as a liability and an expense when the company is demonstrably committed to terminating the employment of an employee or group of employees before the normal retirement date or providing termination benefits as a result of an offer made in order to encourage voluntary redundancy. Termination benefits do not generate future economic benefits for the company and, accordingly, are immediately expensed.o. 3.6 Provisions for risks and charges The provisions for risks and charges are recognised against certain or probable losses and expenses for which the company is uncertain of the timing and/or amount at the reporting date. They are recognised only if there is a current legal or constructive obligation that will lead to an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits as a result of past events and it is probable that the outflow will be required to settle the obligation. The amount recognised as a provision is the best estimate of the discounted expenditure required to settle the present obligation at the reporting date. The discount rate used reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the liability. Risks for which contingent liabilities are only possible are disclosed in a specific section of the notes on commitments and risks. They are not provided for. 3.9 Recognition of revenue, income, costs and expense 3.9.1 Revenue Revenue is the gross inflow of economic benefits in the course of the company’s ordinary activities. Revenue arising from transactions is measured at the fair value of the consideration received taking into account the amount of any trade discounts and volume rebates. Revenue also includes work in progress. The measurement criteria for work in progress are described in paragraph 3.2.2 Contract work in progress. Revenue relating to the sale of goods is recognised when all the following conditions have been met: ◊ the company has transferred to the buyer the significant risks and rewards of ownership of the goods; ◊ the company retains neither continuing managerial involvement to the degree usually associated with ownership nor effective control over the goods sold; ◊ the amount of revenue can be measured reliably; ◊ it is probable that the economic benefits associated with the transaction will flow to the company; ◊ the costs incurred or to be incurred in respect of the transaction can be measured reliably; ◊ the company has transferred to the buyer the signi- MAG | Annual Report 2015 191 ficant risks and rewards of ownership of the goods, which generally coincides with transfer of ownership or possession to the buyer, or when the revenue can be measured reliably. 3.9.3 Revenue from the rendering of services is recognised in the period when the services are provided. This recognition method makes reference to the stage of completion of the transaction at the reporting date, provided that the outcome of the transaction can be estimated reliably. 3.9.4 The outcome of a transaction can be estimated reliably when all the following conditions are satisfied: ◊ the amount of revenue can be measured reliably; ◊ it is probable that the economic benefits associated with the transaction will flow to the entity; ◊ the stage of completion of the transaction at the reporting date can be measured reliably; and ◊ the costs incurred for the transaction and the costs to complete the transaction can be measured reliably. 3.9.2 Government grants Government grants refer to benefits flowing to the company from the government, government agencies and similar bodies whether local, national or international. These benefits come in the form of transfers of resources in connection with the company’s compliance or commitment to comply with certain conditions relating to its operating activities. Grants are recognised on an accruals basis and in direct correlation with costs incurred when their allocation has been formally approved. Grants related to assets are government grants whose primary condition is that the company purchases, constructs or otherwise acquires long-term assets. Subsidiary conditions may also be attached restricting the type or location of the assets or the periods during which they are to be acquired or held. These grants are recognised in profit or loss in direct relation to the depreciation/amortisation of the assets to which they relate and are taken as a direct reduction in depreciation/amortisation. Grants related to income also relate to expenses of the year and are taken to profit or loss as a direct reduction in the related cost. Forgivable loans are loans which the lender undertakes to waive repayment of under certain conditions. Once these conditions are met they become grants recognised on an accruals basis in direct relation to the related costs incurred. 192 Costs Costs are recognised if they are pertinent to the company’s business and on an accruals basis. Financial income and expense Financial income includes interest income on invested cash, including available-for-sale financial assets, dividend income, gains on the sale of available-for-sale financial assets, fair value gains on financial assets taken to profit or loss and gains on hedges taken to profit or loss. Interest income and expense are recognised on an accruals basis using the effective interest method, i.e., at the interest rate that makes all cash inflows and outflows (including any premiums, discounts, commissions, etc.) comprising the transaction financially equivalent. Financial expense includes interest expense on loans, interest expense arising on the discounting of provisions, fair value losses on financial assets at fair value through profit or loss, impairment losses on financial assets and losses on hedges at fair value through profit or loss. deferred tax liabilities. Deferred tax assets are recognised only if it is probable that the company will have sufficient future taxable profit against which the assets can be used. The recoverability of deferred tax assets is reviewed at each reporting date. If it is no longer probable that the company will realise the related tax benefit, they are reduced accordingly. Deferred tax assets are recognised under “Non-current assets”. The notes to this caption provide a table summarising the temporary differences that gave rise to the recognition of deferred tax assets. The tax effects of temporary differences are due to the application of the tax rate that will apply when the differences reverse, or the application of the current tax rate as the best estimate of the rate that will be applicable if the time of reversal cannot be reasonably determined, and considering current tax legislation at the reporting date. Borrowing costs are recognised as an expense in the year when incurred using the effective interest method. They are never capitalised under assets. 3.10 Income taxes Income taxes of the year reflect estimated current and deferred taxation. Current taxes are calculated for each company by applying the tax regulations currently in place to estimated taxable income, considering any tax subsidies. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognised on an accruals basis on the temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities and their tax bases. They were not recognised on the following temporary differences: ◊ initial recognition of assets or liabilities in a transaction other than a business combination that does not affect either accounting profit or taxable income; ◊ investments in subsidiaries for which the difference is not likely to reverse in future years; ◊ initial recognition of goodwill. Deferred tax liabilities are recognised under “Non-current liabilities”. The notes to this caption provide a table summarising the differences that gave rise to the recognition of MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 193 4. Significant matters 4.1 New standards (IFRS) and interpretations (IFRIC) A list is provided below of new standards (IFRS) issued by the IASB that, at the preparation date of these separate financial statements, have been endorsed by the EU and published in the EU’s Official Gazette. IFRS/IFRIC Description FTA date Amendment to IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements 2016/2017 Amendment to IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment 2016/2017 Amendment to IAS 19 Employee Benefits 2016/2017 Amendment to IAS 27 Separate Financial Statements 2016/2017 Amendment to IAS 28 Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures 2016/2017 Amendment to IAS 34 Interim Financial Reporting 2016/2017 Amendment to IAS 38 Intangible Assets 2016/2017 Amendment to IAS 39 Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement 2018/2019 Amendment to IAS 41 Agriculture 2016/2017 Amendment to IFRS 5 Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations 2016/2017 Amendment to IFRS 7 Financial Instruments: Disclosures 2016/2017 IFRS 9 Financial Instruments 2018/2019 Amendment to IFRS 10 Consolidated Financial Statements 2016/2017 Amendment to IFRS 11 Joint Arrangements 2016/2017 Amendment to IFRS 12 Disclosure of Interests in Other Entities 2016/2017 IFRS 14 Regulatory Deferral Accounts 2016/2017 IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers 2018/2019 IFRS for SMEs amendment International Financial Reporting Standard for Small and Medium-sized Entities 2017/2018 The “consolidation suite” became effective in 2014. It is comprised of the following documents endorsed by the European Union with Regulation (EU) no. 1254/2012 of 11 December 2012: ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ 194 IIFRS 10 Consolidated Financial Statements, IFRS 11 Joint Arrangements, IFRS 12 Disclosure of Interests in Other Entities, IAS 27 (2011) Separate Financial Statements, IAS 28 (2011) Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures. MAG | Annual Report 2015 In June 2012 and October 2012, the IASB amended the above standards and published the two following documents endorsed by the European Union with Regulation (EU) no. 313/2013 of 4 April 2013 and Regulation (EU) no. 1174/2013 of 21 November 2013, respectively: vestment entity investor to an investment entity investee. ◊ The disclosure required by IFRS 12 for an investment entity measuring all of its subsidiaries at fair value. ◊ Transition Guidance (amendments to IFRS 10, 11, and 12), ◊ Investment Entities (amendments to IFRS 10, IFRS 12 and IAS 27 (2011). The amendment to IAS 34 – “Interim Financial Reporting” clarifies the meaning of “elsewhere in the interim report” and requires the inclusion of a cross-reference from the interim financial statements to the location of this information. Mandatory application for investment entities only was postponed to financial statements of annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2014. The amendment to IAS 41 – “Agriculture” changes the financial reporting for bearer plants which are now included within the scope of IAS 16. Consequently, they are subsequently measured using the cost model or the revaluation model. A bearer plant is defined as a living plant that: The most significant change introduced by IFRS 10 is the concept of one control model underlying consolidation, combining that previously set out in IAS 17 “Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements” and in SIC 12 “Consolidation - Special Purpose Entities”. The amendment to IAS 1 – “Presentation of Financial Statements” refers to the requirements for presenting information in terms of aggregation criteria and materiality, including the specific disclosure required by other standards. The amendments to IAS 16 – “Property, Plant and Equipment”- and IAS 38 - “Intangible Assets” – introduce additional specifications on depreciation and amortisation methodologies deemed acceptable. The amendment to IAS 19 – “Employee Benefits” modifies the criteria used to calculate the rate to discount post-employment benefits, clarifying that, upon measurement, said rate is to be denominated in the same currency in which the benefits are to be paid. The amendment to IAS 27 – “Separate Financial Statements” reinstates the equity method as an accounting option for equity investments. The amendment also clarifies that when a parent ceases to be an investment entity, or becomes an investment entity, it shall account for the change from the date when the change in status occurred. The amendment to IAS 28 – “Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures” (and IFRS 10 and IFRS 12) refers to investment entities that apply the consolidation exception and clarifies the following criteria and requirements: ◊ LThe exemption from preparing consolidated financial statements for an intermediate parent entity is available to a parent entity that is a subsidiary of an investment entity, even if the investment entity measures all of its subsidiaries at fair value; ◊ A subsidiary that provides services related to the parent’s investment activities should not be consolidated; ◊ Application of the equity method by a non-in- ◊ Is used in the production or supply of agricultural produce; ◊ Is expected to bear produce for more than one period; ◊ Has a remote likelihood of being sold as agricultural produce, except for incidental scrap sales. The amendment to IFRS 5 – “Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations” provides specific guidance in circumstances in which an entity reclassifies an asset from being held for sale to being held for distribution (or viceversa) and when it should cease held-for-distribution accounting. The amendment to IFRS 7 – “Financial Instruments: Disclosures – Hedge Accounting” relates to the disclosure requirements for hedging transactions in line with the introduction of the amendment to IFRS 9 about hedge accounting. Application of the amendment will become mandatory in tandem with the application of IFRS 9. IFRS 9 completes the step-by-step project to replace IAS 39 and includes requirements for recognition and measurement, impairment, derecognition and general hedge accounting of financial instruments. Early application is permitted before 2018/2019. The previous version of IFRS 9 is applicable as of 2014/2015. The recent amendments to IFRS 10 – “Consolidated Financial Statements” relate to the accounting treatment applicable when control is lost over an investee that is not a business. Mandatory application starts from annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2016. The amendments to IFRS 11 (which, since this year, has replaced IAS 31 “Interests in Joint Ventures” and SIC 13 “Jointly Controlled Entities – Non Monetary Contributions by Venturers”) provide clarifications on how to account for the acquisition of an interest in a joint operation. IFRS 14, published in January 2014, is an interim standard which permits an entity which is a first-time adopter of In- MAG | Annual Report 2015 195 ternational Financial Reporting Standards to continue to recognise rate regulation amounts in accordance with its previous GAAP. This standard is applicable to annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2016. IFRS 15, which replaces IAS 11 (“Construction Contracts”), IAS 28 (“Revenue”) and the related interpretations (IFRIC 13 “Customer Loyalty Programmes”, IFRIC 15 “Agreements for the Construction of Real Estate”, IFRIC 18 “Transfer of Assets from Customers” and SIC 31 “Revenue-Barter Transactions Involving Advertising Services”), unifies the revenue recognition criteria applicable to contractuallybased transactions. Its application becomes mandatory for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2018. The amendments to the IFRS for SMEs clarify existing requirements and are part of the three-year update and review cycle decided by the IASB. Their application becomes mandatory for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2017. Lastly, for illustrative purposes, the correlation between certain not yet applicable standards is summarised below. Standard Description Applic. to annual periods beginning on or after IFRS 1 Exemption from the requirement to restate comparative information for IFRS 9 Concurrent with adoption of IFRS 9 IFRS 7 Additional hedge accounting disclosures (and consequential amendments) resulting from the introduction of the hedge accounting chapter in IFRS 9 Concurrent with adoption of IFRS 9 IFRS 9 Financial instruments 1 January 2018 IFRS 10 Amendment to clarify the accounting for the loss of control of a subsidiary when the subsidiary does not constitute a business 1 January 2016 intangible assets, as they meet the requirements of paragraph 3.1.1.1 Research and development costs. Costs for projects that are legally considered122 relevant to “National security” or to be of “European interest” are shown net of the government assistance collected or to be collected under Law no. 808/85. Similarly, the royalties to be paid to the granting body, which substitute amortisation up to the offset cost, while any residual amount constitutes expense, are recognised in profit or loss as operating costs on an accruals basis when the conditions of current legislation have been met, which primarily consist of the sale of products incorporating the technology for which the government assistance was provided. Government assistance collected for projects that are not considered relevant to “National security” or of “European interest” is recognised under “Other liabilities” at nominal amount, and the current and non-current portions are separated on the basis of when repayment is due. In both cases, the costs recognised under intangible assets, in accordance with the above standards (see 3.1.1.1 Research and development costs) are: ◊ amortised over the estimated useful lives or the period in which future economic benefits are expected to be generated through the sale of products incorporating the technology developed; ◊ tested for impairment at least once a year until the development is completed and subsequently as soon as the potential realisation of future economic benefits changes. They are tested for impairment on the basis of estimated sales plans that consider the particularly long life cycles for products under development. 4.3 Financial risk management The company is exposed to the following financial risks: An examination of the company’s current situation showed that the effects of applying the above changes are not significant. 4.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to law no. 808/85 The company classifies costs incurred for designs, prototypes and adjustments to technical/functional specifications for clearly identified potential customers that qualify for the government assistance provided for by Law no. 808 of 24 December 1985, regulating government assistance to support the competitiveness of companies operating in the aerospace industry and defence, under development costs in 196 ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ ◊ credit risk; market risk; currency risk; interest rate risk; liquidity risk; business risk and uncertainties. Information is provided below on the company’s actual exposure to each of these risks, its risk management policies and processes, the methods used to assess the risks and how the company manages capital. The separate financial statements also include additional 122 Reference is made to the provisions of Law no. 808/85 and subsequent amendments and the regulatory provisions which integrate and govern the specific aspects of the law (CIPE resolution no. 28/06 of 22 March 2006, Decrees of the Ministry of Economic Development nos. 173 of 14 September 2010 and 174 of 14 September 2010) MAG | Annual Report 2015 nominal amount has been fully impaired through a specific allowance set up when SEI was acquired. quantitative information. The board of directors is responsible overall for the creation and supervision of the company’s risk management system. Using a system whereby duties are delegated, the company ensures the implementation of risk management guidelines and the periodic monitoring of risks. The finance department is responsible for monitoring risks, using information generated by the internal control system. The purpose of the MAG’s risk policy is not to speculate. Rather, it is exclusively aimed at minimising the financial risks of its core business. Risk management policies are based on the following: ◊ identifying and analysing the risks to which the company is exposed; ◊ setting limits and control tools; ◊ monitoring the tools. 4.3.1 Credit risk Credit risk is the risk that a customer or counterparty to a financial instrument generates a financial loss by failing to fulfil its obligation. Credit risk mainly relates to trade receivables and financial investments. The company’s exposure to credit risk largely depends on the specific characteristics of each customer. Demographic variables typical to the company’s customer portfolio, including default risk in the sector and country in which the customer operates, have a minimal influence on credit risk. A substantial part of the company’s turnover is generated with industrial companies that are part of one corporate group. This part has been falling dramatically (89% in 2013/14 and 84% in 2014/15, specifically 78% for the Integrated Aircraft Systems segment and 92% for the Aircraft Services segment), and, according to the business plan, it will fall below 50% over three years. The company has worked with 90% of its customers for over four years. It has not had any cases of significant bad debts in the last ten years. Accordingly, the company has not set up an allowance for impairment other than the few isolated cases disclosed. For the purposes of providing clear information, due to the balances arising from the merger of SEI, which was merged into MAG in 2009/2010, MAG’s financial statements include certain bad debts arising from trading that took place before SEI’s acquisition in 2001. SEI’s seller is exclusively responsible for these amounts, which are subject to insolvency proceedings or individual credit recovery processes. Their The company does not make financial investments. Accordingly, it is not subject to the risk of issuer default. The company’s policies provide for the issue of financial guarantees only in the interests of wholly-owned subsidiaries. At 30 September 2015, there are no guarantees issued on behalf of subsidiaries. 4.3.2 Market risk Market risk is theoretically connected to fluctuations in the fair value and/or cash flows of a specific financial instrument due to changes in market prices. To this end, the company does not trade in financial instruments for speculative purposes. It does not hold financial assets for investment purposes and, accordingly, it does not have risk profiles connected to financial market volatility. With respect to specific hedges, the company has one derivative hedging interest rate risk for which reference should be made to the specific note (see 4.3.4 Interest rate risk). 4.3.3 Currency risk The company is exposed to currency risk on sales, purchases and loans in currencies other than the functional currency. These transactions are only in US dollars (USD), in which currency the company generated total turnover of approximately USD26.9 million (approximately €23.4 million) in 2014/2015. The company’s currency risk management policy is based on seeking to find a structural balance in transactions performed regularly (purchases and sales) in US dollars, with the aim of ensuring that net exposure in foreign currency remains at an acceptable level. During the year, the company did not need to enter into hedges and/or forward currency trading, as it pursued an overall substantial balance between exchange rate gains and losses. 4.3.4 Interest rate risk This risk relates to fluctuations in market interest rates with respect to interest expense paid on loans in place. The company is marginally exposed to interest rate risk as it has agreed an insignificant portion of financing on which interest accrues at variable rates indexed to the Euribor. MAG | Annual Report 2015 197 Certain portions of debt exposed to interest rate risk could be hedged using derivatives, in accordance with the company’s risk management policy and where necessary. The company has agreed loans with banks on the normal credit market, which are mainly in Euros and are not secured by collateral or personal guarantees. 4.3.5 Liquidity risk This risk relates to the company’s ability to meet its obligations with respect to financial liabilities. The company’s approach to managing liquidity provides that it always has sufficient funds to meet its obligations at the scheduled due dates, both in normal conditions and during times of financial tension, without having to incur charges at above market rates normally applied to the company. The company monitors its financial position on a daily basis and periodically forecasts its financial requirements. gnised separately. On occasion, the company has factored receivables, thereby transferring title thereto and default risk. These transactions are legally and substantially considered without recourse, as they do not provide for any guarantees, repurchase or recourse clauses. Overall, the company’s short-term facilities total approximately €105.5 million, and the percentage of utilisation at the reporting date is 31% for credit lines and bank facilities (€26.6 million), while approximately 42% of the facilities for the factoring without recourse of trade receivables was used. 4.3.6 Business risk and uncertainties Reference should be made to the various sections of the annual report for information on business risk and uncertainties (see The external context, Risk management and compliance, Group performance). 5. Notes to the statement of financial position The company has always met its obligations regularly. 5.1Intangible assets The following table provides information on the company’s loans, credit lines and facilities in place at the reporting date, which the company has not secured with collateral or personal guarantees. The following table provides variations in intangible assets. Most non-current loans bear interest at flat rates. (in millions of Euros) Noncurrent (at 30.09.2014) Noncurrent (at 30.09.2015) Currency € € Original 45,5 45,4 Residual amount Guarantees AMOUNT 34,8 N/A N/A (in millions of Euros) Residual amount Type Currency Current lines € 26.5 8.3 N/A Current FCT € 79.0 33.2 N/A Guarantees These credit lines include facilities available for the factoring without recourse of trade receivables, which are reco- 198 Concessions, licences and trademarks Carrying amount 20.352.704 - 615.330 612.054 18.886 21.598.974 Increases 5.465.241 30.726 156.419 - 4.192 5.656.578 Cost offsetting (Law no. 808/85) - - - - - - Reclassifications/Impairment losses (235.671) - 18.886 - (18.886) (235.671) Amortisation (1.168.309) (6.145) (423.314) - - (1.597.768) Historical cost 33.176.066 65.715 4.214.808 612.054 4.192 38.072.835 Accumulated amortisation (8.762.102) (41.134) (3.847.486) - - (12.650.722) Carrying amount 24.413.964 24.581 367.322 612.054 4.192 25.422.113 Goodwill Assets under development Total 30 September 2015: Certain non-current loans have clauses that require the company to meet certain covenants. If it fails to meet these covenants, repayment of the loan could be requested. The ratios applied refer to the consolidated figures and are therefore summarised in the notes to the group’s consolidated financial statements at 30 September 2015, to which reference is made (see 5.3.5 Liquidity risk). At 30 September 2015, all ratios are within contractual limits. Original Ind. patents and int. prop. rights 30 September 2014: However, the variable rate loans are indexed to Type Development costs MAG | Annual Report 2015 The offsetting of the historical cost of “Development costs” with government assistance under Laws no. 808/85 and 46/82 relates to the recognition of costs that meet the requirements for capitalisation under intangible assets, net of the related amounts of government assistance provided under the above laws. For information on the recognition of the government assistance provided under Law no. 808/85, reference should be made to paragraph 4.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to law no. 808/85. For information on the recognition of the government assistance provided under Law no. 46/82, reference should be made to paragraph 3.9.2 Government grants. There are five main groups of completed development projects that have not yet been completely amortised. They relate to products used in five types of aircraft. MAG | Annual Report 2015 199 In accordance with the criteria described above relating to the identification of the useful lives of products developed (see 3.1.1.1 Research and development costs), amortisation is calculated on a straight-line basis over the useful lives of such assets, which at 30 September 2015 are not shorter than 10 years in most cases. Development costs that are capitalised under assets at the reporting date relate to groups of projects that can be summarised based on the aircraft in which the related product will be used as follows. Development costs for new products 5.3 Equity investments Considering the materiality of investments in subsidiaries, reference should be made to the consolidated financial statements prepared pursuant to article 25 of Legislative decree no. 127/91 for greater disclosures. As required by the Italian Civil Code, the key data about equity investments are set out below.123124 2014/2015 Bell 525 projects 5.045.225 Share capital Equity Profit (loss) for the year ended 30.09.2015 % of holding Carrying amount at 30.09.2015 (€) AW139/AW149/A149 projects 4.499.119 EADS X4 projects 3.744.907 Mecaer America Inc. (Laval – Quebec)123 84.656.157 36.455.527 1.270.048 100,00% 33.058.418 Electromechanical actuator systems (fixed-wing and helicopters) 2.989.622 AW109 projects 2.830.343 MAG Inc. (Philadelphia – Pennsylvania ) 124 1.467.000 3.020.638 589.810 100,00% 78.976 Other projects 2.599.903 Bell 429 projects 1.303.337 Società Aeroporto del Tronto S.p.A. (Monteprandone – AP) 8.250.000 8.430.965 (28.082) 93,94% 8.153.460 AW189 Interiors projects 682.805 Bell 505 projects 297.572 AW169 projects 251.048 AW139 projects restyling 170.083 Total 24.413.964 The following table shows changes that occurred during the year and the carrying amounts at the reporting date, as required by article 2427.5 of the Italian Civil Code. Since the impairment test carried out at 30 September 2015 in accordance with IAS 36 did not identify any impairment losses, the company has maintained the carrying amount of its investment in Mecaer America Inc., without adding adjustments to those made in previous years. Goodwill arose from the acquisition of the interiors business. Goodwill is tested for impairment once a year. The recoverable amount was calculated using a financial approach based on the profits and cash flows set out in the 2015/2016 budget approved and, for the three subsequent years, set out in the 2014/2015 – 2018/2019 business plan approved in 2014 and currently being updated. The figures in the business plan adequately support the goodwill allocated to the production of interiors carried out by the CCS division. For additional information on the characteristics of the production lines, their organisational structure and impact on revenue, reference should be made to the directors’ report (see 2.2 Segment reporting and Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A.). The 2014/2015 actual figures and those estimated in the budget for the year currently underway are better than those for the first two years of the above plan. 5.2 With respect to the period covered by the plan, the estimates point to a progressive increase in volumes and a consolidation of profitability levels for the company in line with the group’s standards for the operating segment. The subsidiary ended the year with a profit and its operating profit exceeded expectations. Property, plant and equipment Property Plant and machinery Industrial and commercial equipment 41.763 Other assets Leasehold improvements Assets under construction Total In a sensitivity analysis, Mecaer America’s cash flows were discounted using a rate ranging from 8.5% to 9.5%, taking into account the specific conditions of the company and its reference market. MAG has extrapolated the cash flows for the period following the explicit period using a growth rate of 0.5-1.5%, given the substantial investments in the plan and the time period considered. 30 September 2014: Carrying amount 1.714.931 1.284.386 442.957 432.662 79.739 3.996.438 Increases 76.622 437.563 157.967 191.357 18.874 882.383 Net decreases (1.797) (405) (500) 39.571 7.200 32.968 (79.739) Reclassifications (2.702) - The recoverable amount calculated in this way is consistent with the carrying amount of the equity investment.The company carried out the impairment test based on information available at the preparation date of these separate financial statements and reasonable estimate of future cash flows and other figures used. Changes in the variables used in the test are constantly monitored in order to adjust the estimated recoverable amount of the Impairment losses Depreciation (8.255) (429.254) (575.342) (160.965) (146.000) 150.745 7.611.369 8.364.658 1.986.135 2.286.242 (1.319.816) 30 September 2015: Historical cost 18.874 20.418.023 Mecaer America Inc. MAG Inc. Accumulated depreciation (117.237) (6.250.867) (7.178.885) (1.539.476) (1.775.255) - (16.861.720) Carrying amount 33.508 1.360.502 1.185.773 446.659 510.987 18.874 3.556.303 Property solely comprises light constructions manufactured at the production facilities. Plant and machinery and industrial and commercial equipment at 30 September 2015 include carrying amounts of €437 thousand and €98 thousand, respectively, relating to assets under finance lease for which current financial liabilities of €76 thousand and non-current financial liabilities of €207 thousand have been recognised. Increases in these captions relate to investments that are part of an ongoing plan to upgrade the production structures. (Impairment losses)/ reversals of imp. losses 30.09.2014 (decreases) 30.09.2015 valore di bilancio al 30.09.2015 Increases/ 5.000.000 78.976 33.058.418 78.976 Società Aeroporto del Tronto S.p.A. 6.903.460 1.250.000 8.153.460 Total investments in subsidiaries 35.040.854 6.250.000 41.290.854 Other companies 3.083 Total other companies 3.083 - 3.083 35.043.937 6.250.000 41.293.937 Total equity investments 3.083 No property, plant and equipment were pledged as collateral at 30 September 2015. 123 Amounts in Canadian dollars (CAD). 124 Amounts in US dollars (USD). 200 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 201 5.4 Deferred tax assets The following tables provide an analysis of asset balances at 30 September 2015 and 30 September 2014 for each caption, with indication of amounts recoverable within and after one year. These balances reflect the estimated tax charge arising on temporary differences between the profit for the year and taxable profit in relation to captions that are deductible in future years. The tax rates applied in the calculation are IRES of 27.5% and IRAP of 4.09%. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Unrealised exchange rate losses 93.773 144.994 Interest expense on discounting 11.875 15.290 Excess maintenance expenses 22.764 13.896 Cash-deductible expenses 58.833 Variable components of cash-ded. remuneration 13.079 51.838 Total deferred tax assets recoverable WITHIN one year 141.491 284.851 2014/2015 2013/2014 Taxed provisions for risks 1.825.103 1.565.843 Interest expense on discounting and actuarial losses on post-employment benefits 90.867 139.778 Royalties 467.275 388.081 Excess maintenance expenses 72.987 37.964 Total deferred tax assets recoverable AFTER one year 2.456.232 2.131.666 Total deferred tax assets 2.597.723 2.416.517 5.5 Other non-current assets Deferred receivables from the Ministry of Economic Development for projects under Law no. 808/85 include the present value of government assistance to be collected from the Ministry of Economic Development for projects under Law no. 808/85 concerning national security and similar matters for which collection is deferred. The portion expected to be collected within one year is classified under other current assets (see 5.12 Other current assets). The carrying amount is in line with fair value. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Deferred receivables from the Ministry of Economic Development for projects under Law no. 808/85 2.107.951 3.242.766 Guarantee deposits and other noncurrent assets 87.785 79.243 Total other non-current assets 2.195.736 3.322.009 5.6 Other non-current assets - related parties 2014/2015 2013/2014 Credit facility - Mecaer America (USD line) 2,252,109 2,185,488 Credit facility - Mecaer America (€ line) - 602,837 Guarantee deposits 205,993 205,993 Total other non-current assets 2,458,102 2,994,318 Specifically, the credit facilities were granted to the subsidiary Mecaer America at market conditions. Reference 202 should be made to the directors’ report for further information on intragroup transactions (see Disclosure on transactions with related parties). Guarantee deposits mostly include non-interest bearing guarantee deposits of €206 thousand given to the related party S.B.I. S.p.A. for the lease of the properties in Borgomanero (NO) and Monteprandone (AP). 5.7 Inventories This caption is analysed in the table below. There was a considerable increase in inventories, mainly due to the growth in volumes of the main operating segments. Inventory turnover remained at normal rates, considering procurement and production levels. The allowance for inventory write-down includes collective write-downs based on statistical analyses of inventory trends, such as variables that presumably reflect obsolescence and/or excessive items, which total approximately €2,857 thousand. These analyses are updated each year on the basis of actual figures reported and integrated by technical analyses carried out to justify the need for write-downs. This method is necessary given the specific nature of the company’s industry, also considering contractual restrictions requiring back-up inventories, usually for fairly long periods of time. MAG | Annual Report 2015 2014/2015 2013/2014 Raw materials, consumables and supplies 21.890.479 21.107.328 Work in progress and semifinished products 6.474.006 6.977.960 Finished products and goods for resale 10.962.529 11.333.451 Allowance for inventory writedown (2.856.826) (2.383.891) Advances to suppliers 111.497 259.898 Total inventories 36.581.685 37.294.746 5.8 Contract work in progress 2014/2015 2013/2014 Projects to develop new products 724.107 412.047 Aircraft interiors 3.063.010 642.394 Aircraft and component maintenance 1.852.193 2.393.122 Total contract work in progress 5.639.310 3.447.563 Contract work in progress comprises three main components that are part of different businesses, operating separately. The first one includes long-term contracts for the development of new products, which are entirely or partially funded by revenue from the customer. Interiors includes contracts for VVIP customised interiors, while maintenance relates to the overhaul of helicopters and components carried out at the Monteprandone site. Considering the contractual terms, these contracts are of a long-term nature and provide for contractual considerations that the company measures on the basis of the percentage of completion at the reporting date. This method considers technical progress (physical measurement) and financial progress (cost method). Contracts for VVIP customised interiors are the main component at the reporting date. Work in progress is recognised under assets if, based on an analysis conducted on each contract, the gross value of work in progress exceeds progress billings. It is recognised under liabilities if the progress billings exceed work in progress. If the progress billings have not been collected at the reporting date, the relevant amount is classified as trade receivables. 5.9 Trade receivables thousand adjusting receivables of SEI, which was merged into MAG in 2009/2010. Trade receivables remain consistent with the natural monetary cycle. With a schedule for the most responsive to the needs of the main customer, the company occasionally factors trade receivables without recourse which are collectable and due at the factoring date. There are no significant bad debts. Although a portion of past due receivables remains, mostly due to the complexity of the procurement process for large customers, the average DSO continue to be approximately 90 days and 180 days for residential and institutional customers, respectively. Receivables remain highly concentrated (71% if intragroup transactions are excluded) with the company’s key customer, Finmeccanica group. Overall, the impact is equal to 48%. Trade receivables 2014/2015 2013/2014 17.995.917 30.462.884 Allowance for impairment (509.930) (693.978) Total trade receivables 17.485.987 29.768.906 At the reporting date, trade receivables may be analysed by geographical segment as follows. Geographical segment Amount Europe – Eurozone 14.003.126 Europe - non-Eurozone 168.898 North America 2.199.367 Rest of the world 1.114.596 Total trade receivables 17.485.987 At the reporting date, past due receivables total €4,418 thousand. A breakdown of past due receivables by ageing is set out below. Days Nominal amount <30 1.744.132 1.744.132 31<X<60 - - 61<X<90 954.386 954.386 91<X<120 297.104 X>120 1.932.428 (509.930) 1.422.498 Total past due 4.928.050 (509.930) 4.418.120 Impairment Carrying amount 297.104 This caption is analysed in the table below. Its carrying amount is in line with fair value. The allowance for impairment includes approximately €510 MAG | Annual Report 2015 203 5.10 Current loans and receivables related parties Trade receivables from related parties at the reporting date are summarised in the following table. The carrying amount is in line with fair value. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Mecaer Aviation Group Inc. 7.464.660 5.198.696 Mecaer America Inc. 928.078 4.114.406 SAT S.p.A. 5.870 7.049 S.B.I. S.p.A. 24.664 26.533 Unrealised exchange rate gains on foreign currency receivables 15.928 20.050 Total trade receivables - related parties 8.439.200 9.366.735 Trade receivables from the subsidiary Mecaer Aviation Group Inc. were generated by the sale of kits for interiors activities, totalling €3,002 thousand during the year. Trade receivables from the subsidiary Mecaer America Inc. were mainly generated by trading transactions. Changes during the year relate to sales of goods (e.g., spare parts for maintenance activities under the service centre agreement), recharges (insurance premiums, interest on loans and seconded personnel costs) and collections. Reference should be made to the specific section of the directors’ report for additional information on transactions with subsidiaries (see Disclosure on transactions with related parties). 5.11 Tax assets Tax assets include the excess IRES for the 2007/2008 2011/2012 tax years for which the company has claimed reimbursement pursuant to article 2.1-quater of Decree law no. 201/2011, as detailed in the note to Income taxes (see 6.18 Income taxes); 5.14 Cash and cash equivalents The VAT receivable mainly comprises domestic VAT, whose trend is correlated with the invoicing system applied to the key customer, which, as a frequent exporter, makes purchases not subject to VAT by issuing letters of intent for time brackets. This caption, which is in line with its fair value, reflects the balance of bank and postal accounts. It is calculated as the nominal amount of current accounts held with banks. Deferred charges include portions of costs and charges paid in advance but not pertaining to the year. These mainly refer to costs for supplies. Transfer credits to be received relate to trading transactions and include certain items of modest amounts due from Finmeccanica group, which is also a supplier of the company. Tax credits include various individually insignificant items relating to domestic and foreign indirect taxes. Receivables due from the liquidator of HT S.p.A. reflect the outstanding balance due from the subsidiary Hydraulic Technologies S.p.A. as a result of its liquidation and which the liquidator withheld on a precautionary basis. 2014/2015 2013/2014 VAT receivable 2.706.230 4.713.062 Contributions to be collected 1.225.580 1.518.327 Deferred charges 358.838 486.633 Tax credits 37.405 175.201 Advances to suppliers 490.963 433.950 Receivables from the Ministry of Economic Development - 216.014 for projects under Law no. 808/85 8.179 176.945 Other 12.344 24.588 Advances to employees for travel expenses 250.484 15.367 Transfer credits to be received 4.628 4.628 Receivables due from the liquidator of HT S.p.A. 5.094.651 7.764.715 Total other current assets 5.12 Other current assets 5.13 Current financial assets Advances to suppliers relate to payments for orders primarily outside the EU. The decrease in this caption is due to the drop in the volume of activities of the CCS division. Receivables for projects under Law no. 808/85 include the present value of government assistance to be collected from the Ministry of Economic Development for projects under Law no. 808/85 concerning national security and similar matters for which collection is deferred. The portion expected to be collected after one year is classified under other non-current assets (see 5.5 Other non-current Current financial assets 2014/2015 2013/2014 - 2.967.000 In the previous year, this caption comprised a loan entered into on 30 September 2014 which became effective on 1 October 2014. MAG | Annual Report 2015 2014/2015 2013/2014 Bank deposits 14.314.997 14.367.453 Cash 7.178 6.906 Total cash and cash equivalents 14.322.175 14.374.359 The company factors trade receivables, usually every quarter. However, the factoring does not alter the nature of collection times in terms of method or amounts. These transactions are legally and substantially considered without recourse, as they do not provide for any guarantees, repurchase or buy-back clauses. 5.15 Cash and cash equivalents related parties This caption reflects the balance of bank deposits. It is calculated as the nominal amount of current accounts held with banks that are related parties (Credito Valtellinese group – see also 7.2 Related party transactions). The carrying amount is in line with fair value. Total cash and cash equivalents 2014/2015 2013/2014 1.595.809 1.033.771 for shareholders and guarantee accessibility to outside sources of funding, including the achievement of adequate credit ratings. The company constantly monitors developments in its debt to equity ratio and, in particular, the level of net debt and the generation of cash flows from operating activities. To achieve these objectives, the company looks to constantly improve the profitability of its businesses. The board of directors can make proposals to the shareholders to increase share capital or, if legally permitted, distribute reserves. In this way, the company may repurchase treasury shares within the limits authorised by the shareholders, with the same aims of creating value while achieving financial balance and improving the company’s rating. Equity means the value contributed by shareholders (share capital and share premium reserve totalling €18,701,684) and the value generated by the company through the results of operations (retained earnings and other reserves, before the profit for the year, totalling €30,810,264). The profit for the year includes unrealised exchange rate gains, since the company recognised net unrealised exchange rate gains of approximately €354 thousand during the year. Under IAS 21, unrealised exchange rate gains accumulated in equity are not subject to restrictions. 5.17 Employee benefits - postemployment benefits 5.16 Equity At 30 September 2015, paid-up and subscribed share capital amounts to €13,138 thousand, divided into 13,138 thousand shares with a nominal amount of €1 (one Euro) each. No treasury shares are held directly or indirectly via trustees or nominees. The carrying amount is in line with fair value. They are due within one year. 204 assets). For information on changes and an analysis of equity, reference should be made to the statement of changes in equity (see Statement of changes in equity). At the reporting date, other comprehensive expense recognised in equity (profits and losses arising from the application of IAS 19) totals €137 thousand. No dividends have been distributed to the owners during the last two years. The company’s capital management objectives are to create value for shareholders, safeguard business continuity and support the company’s development. Accordingly, MAG seeks to maintain an adequate level of market capitalisation, at the same time enabling it to realise sound returns The company grants post-employment benefits to its employees both directly and by contributing to third-party funds. These benefits are granted in a variety of ways, depending on the legal, tax and economic conditions of each country in which the company operates. In particular, the pension reform under Law no. 296/2006 has been considered (see 3.5 Employee benefits - Post-employment benefits). The benefits are usually based on remuneration and years of employee service. The company grants post-employment benefits through defined contribution and defined benefit plans. Under defined contribution plans, the company pays contributions to public or private insurance companies on the basis of a legal or contractual obligation, or voluntarily. When the company pays the contributions, it fully meets its obligations. The cost of the period is accrued on the basis of employee service and is recognised by function under personnel expense. MAG | Annual Report 2015 205 Defined benefit plans include the post-employment benefits, which reflect accruals for all employees in service at the reporting date, calculated using the projected unit credit method using actuarial techniques. The techniques used for these calculations are shown in the following tables.125126 Amounts taken to other comprehensive income in the two consecutive years are detailed in the following table. 2013/2014 8.648 48.717 Personnel expense Financial expense Other comprehensive income (expense) parametri economico finanziari 2014/2015 2014/2015 (124.076) 217.214 (115.428) 265.931 2013/2014 Discount rate a125 1,46 % 1,23 % Inflation rate i 2,00 % 2,00 % Annual rate of increase in postemployment benefits r 3,00% 3,00% Annual rate of salary increase is126 1,00 % 1,00 % 5.18 Provisions The following tables provide an analysis of the composition of and changes in this caption. 2014/2015 Parametri tecnico-demografici 2013/2014 RG 48 Tables127 Provision for product warranties 1.272.683 1.387.470 Inability INPS tables by age and gender Early retirement provision - 166.000 Retirement age Achievement of requirements for mandatory general insurance Provision for litigation 178.381 162.513 Other provisions 1.006.027 268.945 Total provisions for risks and charges 2.457.091 1.984.927 Mortality Annual employee turnover and advances on post-employment benefits 2014/2015 2013/2014 Advances 2,0 % 2,0 % Turnover 3,0 % 3,0 % Post-employment benefits at 30 September 2015 and 2014 are analysed below.127 Post-employment benefits 2014/2015 2013/2014 1.791.329 2.200.018 Changes in net liabilities for defined benefit obligations are summarised in the following table. Liabilities for defined benefit plans at 30.09.2014 2.200.018 Current service cost and interest 8.648 Actuarial losses (124.076) Plan benefits paid (293.261) Liabilities for defined benefit plans at 30.09.2015 1.791.329 Changes in net liabilities for defined benefit obligations are summarised in the following table. 2014/2015 2013/2014 8.648 48.717 Current service cost Interest cost Curtailment Actuarial (gains)/losses (OCI) (124.076) 217.214 (115.428) 265.931 Provisions for risks and charges at 30.09.2014 1.984.927 Accruals 1.101.027 Utilisation/reversal (628.863) Provisions for risks and charges at 30.09.2015 2.457.091 The €114,787 reversal of the provision for product warranties is based on the consistent application of a statistical approach to turnover for the year, adjusting the average warranty costs weighted by the average impact of claims over the contractual warranty period. The provision for litigation has been accrued specifically to cover litigation pending with former company employees. 5.21 Other non-current liabilities The following table provides a breakdown of deferred tax liabilities. This caption is entirely comprised of “Other liabilities under Law no. 808/85” which include the difference between assistance received or to be received under Law no. 808/85, relating to projects considered relevant to “National security and similar”, and the portion of subsidised costs classified under intangible assets as development costs, the difference between royalties charged to the projects on a straightline basis and the liability actually accrued at the rates for which payment is provided for, as well as assistance under Law no. 808/85 for projects not considered relevant to “National security and similar” (see 4.2 Development costs 2014/2015 2013/2014 Research and development costs 7.778.852 7.983.596 Allowance for impairment 166.412 166.412 Unrealised exchange rate gains 185.943 255.951 Amortisation of goodwill 119.792 107.551 Leases 27.007 45.013 Accelerated depreciation 3.479 7.473 Total deferred tax liabilities 8.281.485 8.565.996 Deferred tax liabilities for research and development costs arise from the temporary differences relating to the tax deduction of these costs in the year in which they were incurred. This creates a reversal effect related to amortisation and, in the case of certain projects benefitting from Law no. 808/85, royalties (see also 6.18 Income taxes). 5.20 Loans and borrowings Loans and borrowings at 30 September 2015 are analysed below, in comparison with those at the previous year end, with indication of those that are current and non-current. The carrying amount is in line with fair value. Other provisions include the €801 thousand accrual covering the expense to be incurred for retrofit activities involving a specific element of the E550 aircraft landing gear whose tolerances were redefined by the engineering. This expense mainly comprises the estimated costs to rework a component (trunion assy) and the costs for the disassembly and inspection activities carried out by the aircraft maker during aircraft scheduled maintenance. The estimate of said expense is based on an agreement reached with the customer and a statistical analysis of the inspections carried out starting from August 2015. MAG | Annual Report 2015 2014/2015 2013/2014 Bank facilities and current loans Bank loans 16.804.446 24.922.668 Other loans 935.090 1.347.149 Total current loans and borrowings 17.739.536 26.269.817 including: related parties - 2014/2015 2013/2014 Bank loans 26.333.931 23.807.195 Other loans 313.004 282.233 Total non-current loans and borrowings 26.646.935 24.089.428 Non-current loans including: related parties 5.22 Advances from customers The caption, whose carrying amount is in line with fair value, includes advances from customers for the provision of assets. The decrease on the previous year end is related to the fact that, in the previous year, the balance was significantly affected by the performance of interiors production activities. 5.23 Trade payables This caption, whose carrying amount is in line with fair value, is comprised of payables to suppliers of goods and services. The balance decreased on the previous year end, due to the fall in production volumes. 2014/2015 2013/2014 21.821.403 31.256.750 26.269.817 663.709 third parties and government assistance pursuant to law no. 808/85). Total trade payables third parties 17.075.827 Details are not provided as this could weaken the company’s position in the litigation. 125 Rate indexed to the 7 to 10-year Iboxx Eurozone Corporate AA index. 126 Following the new pension reform for companies with more than 49 employees, the future portions accruing no longer remain with the company. Instead, they are transferred to a supplementary pension fund or the INPS treasury fund. Accordingly, the Italian companies are no longer required to project future salaries using specific growth rates by professional position. 127 RG 48 mortality tables published by the government’s general accounting department. 206 5.19 Deferred tax liabilities 23.810.644 24.089.428 2.836.291 - At the reporting date, trade payables may be analysed by geographical segment as follows. Geographical segment Europe – Eurozone Amount 20.127.515 Europe - Non-Europe 817.984 North America 694.799 Rest of the world Total trade payables 181.105 21.821.403 Information on the main terms and conditions of bank loans in place are provided in the notes to financial risk management (see 4.3.5 Liquidity risk). Financial debt is detailed in the notes to the company’s net financial debt (see 7.1 Net financial debt). MAG | Annual Report 2015 207 5.24 Current financial liabilities related parties 2014/2015 2013/2014 Mecaer America Inc. 1.726.085 2.882.923 Mecaer Aviation Group Inc. 885.490 804.953 SAT S.p.A. - 1.000 S.B.I. S.p.A. 258.169 - Unrealised exchange rate gains on foreign currency receivables 96.733 51.784 Total current financial liabilities - related parties 2.966.477 3.740.660 This caption is comprised of payables to North America subsidiaries and arise exclusively from trading transactions. The carrying amount is in line with fair value. sis and accrued additional month pay and untaken holidays. Social security charges payable are consistently proportionate to personnel expense. The caption does not include overdue amounts. Deferred income mainly refers to revenue on sales relating to contract work in progress for product development and interiors contracts that has been deferred using the percentage of completion method. Other liabilities under Law no. 808/85 include royalties charged to profit or loss, which are expected to be paid within one year (see 4.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to law no. 808/85). Additional information is provided in paragraph 7.2 Related party transactions (see). 6. Notes to the statement of comprehensive income 6.1 5.25 Tax liabilities Tax liabilities include balances due for accrued income taxes, net of payments on account. 2014/2015 2013/2014 IRES 665.583 468.838 IRAP 3.519 - Total tax liabilities 669.102 468.838 Overall changes in current taxes are presented in more detail in the note to INCOME TAXES. The caption does not include overdue amounts. 5.26 Other current liabilities Other current liabilities, whose carrying amount is in line with fair value, are analysed in the following table. 2014/2015 2013/2014 Current and deferred remuneration 3.549.713 3.043.827 Social security charges payable 1.172.306 1.293.261 Deferred income 544.012 753.145 Directors’ fees and expenses 79.286 69.678 Statutory auditors’ fees 106.312 96.213 Other liabilities under Law no. 808/85 238.072 121.988 Withholdings to be paid 2.471 15.462 Other financial liabilities 100.514 90.420 Total other current liabilities 5.792.686 5.483.994 Net revenue Revenue from sales fell, especially in the business lines comprising the Aircraft Services segment and the CCS division of the Integrated Aircraft Systems segment. In the first part of the year, the latter division recorded the residual volumes of Yeovil (UK) foreign site. The overall decrease approximated €16,506 thousand, down by 15.6% over the previous year. More detailed information on trends in revenue is provided in the directors’ report (see Highlights of main consolidated companies, Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A.). 2014/2015 2013/2014 Variazione Revenue - goods and processing, repair and maintenance services 87.634.942 104.369.440 (16.734.498) Design revenue 1.526.284 1.297.962 228.322 Net revenue 89.161.226 105.667.402 (16.506.176) 6.2 Net revenue - related parties 2014/2015 2013/2014 Variazione Revenue - goods and processing, repair and maintenance services 2.805.031 3.822.719 (1.017.688) Design revenue 1.586.475 99.473 1.487.002 Net revenue 4.391.506 3.922.192 469.314 Current and deferred remuneration shows the variable components of remuneration recognised on an accruals ba- 208 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 209 6.3 Other revenue and income with the mix of products and services, as demonstrated by the breakdown of production revenue. The caption mainly comprises grants related to income (€102,480 thousand), social security cuts on personnel bonuses paid in prior years (€62,628 thousand), smaller personnel leaving incentives compared to 2013/2014 (€135,362 thousand) and the release of the provision for legal disputes with employees (€90,000 thousand). . Raw materials, consumables and supplies 6.9 6.4 Other revenue and income related parties This caption includes contractual considerations of €20 thousand from SBI S.p.A. and €3 thousand from S.A.T. S.p.A. for administrative management services. 6.5 Variation in finished products, work in progress and semi-finished goods This caption was directly affected by the factors described in the notes to the statement of financial position (see 5.7 Inventories). 6.6 Increase in internal work capitalised 6.7 Raw materials, consumables and supplies The use of raw materials, consumables and supplies is, overall, consistent with the mix of products and services. Production values are up considerably in absolute terms. 2.459.572 3.983.070 Services The following table provides an analysis of services. Sub-contracting and third-party processing relate to outsourced production, the extent of which varies depending on production volumes. In any case, the use of these services is for non-strategic industrial processes. The decrease over the previous year is due to the reduction in production volumes and insourcing. The cost of temporary staff and contractors fell mainly as a consequence of the closing of the Yeovil (UK) site, where the customised interiors for the AW10 line were mostly produced using temporary staff. The cost of advisory services is a significant caption, specifically with respect to the engineering and technical consultancies services which are mostly managed on an outsourcing basis, complementing internal structures. Travel expenses had a significant impact, principally due to the fact that operating units are located in different geographical. Third party processing and subcontracting 2014/2015 2013/2014 12.393.087 13.854.313 Temporary staff, consultants and contractors 1.845.429 4.717.173 Advisory and sundry assistance services 4.518.274 4.816.156 Transport costs 1.135.655 1.335.609 Electricity, telephone, canteen and utilities 1.471.786 1.614.814 Travel expenses 1.167.998 1.289.422 Royalties on Law no. 808/85 projects include the accrued benefits under this law on projects that are eligible for “National security” or “European interest” assistance. They are calculated on a straight-line basis in proportion to the relevant sales for the year (see also above 4. Significant matters, 44.2 Development costs and government assistance pursuant to law no. 808/85 and 5.21 Other non-current liabilities). Royalties are those due to UTAS (Goodrich Landing Gear) for the AW139 LGS project, the Woodward group for assistance with certain types of hydraulic flight controls and AgustaWestland for maintenance activities on some hydraulic products (dampers). 6.10 Services-related parties 2014/2015 Use of related party assets 2014/2015 2013/2014 1.541.201 1.539.689 The minimum future payments due for the main leases broken down by residual annual payment over the minimum contractual term are summarised in the following table. 2015/2016 2016/2017 2017/2018 2018/2019 2019/2020 1.107.789 822.868 808.918 202.229 - 6.13 Personnel expense 2014/2015 2013/2014 Wages and salaries 15.813.485 15.575.663 Social security contributions 4.820.087 4.542.656 Third party processing and subcontracting - Mecaer America Inc. 3,894,171 3,662,832 Service station fees 546,622 456,124 Post-employment benefits and pension funds 1.031.154 993.508 Cooperation agreement fees 354,259 302,385 Other 87.799 310.220 Other services - 26,443 Total personnel expense 21.752.525 21.422.047 Total services 4,795,052 4,447,784 Fees of €546,622 relate to the service centre agreement with the subsidiary Mecaer America Inc., whereby the latter carries out overhaul and maintenance services on MAG’s proprietary products in the North American market. The Canadian subsidiary, which holds valid airworthiness certification for that service, pays MAG a royalty proportionate to its service station business revenue. Fees of €354,259 relate to the cooperation agreement with the subsidiary Mecaer Aviation Group Inc. for business development services in the North American market, especially the US. These services are carried out by a special unit of MAG Inc. based in the aerospace industrial district of Dallas – Fortworth (Texas). Maintenance, repairs and technical assistance 945.916 1.173.060 28.505.832 29.790.297 Insurance 931.082 841.080 Plant services and security 667.024 594.974 Directors’ fees 479.345 694.111 Royalties on Law no. 808/85 projects 346.973 423.992 6.11 Use of third party assets Participation in conferences and trade fairs 341.512 387.954 It mainly includes rent for cars, equipment and software. Royalties 308.541 1.281.329 Statutory auditors’ fees 101.312 91.213 Other 339.699 562.367 Total services 26.993.633 33.677.567 MAG | Annual Report 2015 This caption includes operating lease payments to the related party SBI S.p.A. for the company’s industrial sites at Borgomanero (NO) and Monteprandone (AP), totalling €1,386 thousand. It also includes €155 thousand relating to the outsourcing agreement for airport services with S.A.T. S.p.A. (unchanged compared to the previous year end). 2013/2014 2013/2014 The use of raw materials, consumables and supplies purchased from related parties - usually Mecaer America Inc. and Mecaer Aviation Group Inc., is again, overall, consistent 6.12 Use of related party assets This caption is in line with the previous year given the substantially stable average headcount. 2014/2015 6.8 Raw materials, consumables and supplies - related parties 210 2013/2014 Transport costs remain high as activities take place at several operating sites. This caption mainly relates to internal and external costs incurred for long-term investment programmes to develop new products. These costs are recognised under intangible assets when they meet capitalisation requirements (see 5.1 Intangible assets). Raw materials, consumables and supplies 2014/2015 Insurance mainly relates to the cost of covering aerospace risks, both in terms of third party liability on products and the many risks arising from the inspection and maintenance of aircraft and parts mainly by the AS division. In this respect, the company has always pursued a prudent risk coverage policy by agreeing adequate policies with leading insurance companies. Use of third party assets 2014/2015 2013/2014 763.176 819.503 The following table summarises the average headcount during the year and the total at year end by category. Headcount Year end 30/09/2015 Average 30/09/2014 2014/2015 2013/2014 Managers 17 17 17,0 17,5 Junior managers and white collars 162 164 163,0 166,5 Blue collars 184 182 183,0 183,0 Total 363 363 363,0 367,0 6.14 Amortisation, depreciation, accruals and impairment losses For information on captions relating to amortisation, depreciation, accruals and impairment losses, reference should be made to the tables on changes in property, plant and equipment (see 5.2 Property, plant and equipment), in intangible assets (see 5.1 Intangible assets) and the provisions for risks and charges (see 5.18 Provisions) in the notes to the statement of financial position. MAG | Annual Report 2015 211 The following table summarises this caption. Amortisation of intangible assets Depreciation of property, plant and equipment 2014/2015 2013/2014 1.597.768 1.377.606 1.319.816 1.442.652 Total amortisation and depreciation 2.917.584 2.820.258 Impairment losses on intangible assets 235.671 - Impairment losses on property, plant and equipment - - Impairment losses on trade receivables - - Accruals for risks 1.021.027 416.944 Other accruals (114.786) 154.740 Impairment losses on equity investments - - Total amortisation and depreciation, accruals and impairment losses 4.059.496 2014/2015 2013/2014 Financial income and interest income on discounting 522.225 352.572 Interest income on deposits with banks 2.893 63.767 Net exchange rate gains 1.189.435 535.136 Total financial income 1.714.553 951.475 including: third parties related parties 2013/2014 Prior year expense 303.829 503.336 Membership dues 112.060 120.708 Indirect taxes and duties 61.393 82.713 Books, publications, texts, databases 49.558 50.895 Other 163.674 96.126 Total other operating costs 690.514 853.778 Prior year expense includes approximately €47 thousand of charges for variable remuneration disbursed in excess of the amount accrued in 2013/2014 and the reversal of prior year income. 47.859 2014/2015 2013/2014 46.582 Current account interest expense 494.764 782.086 Interest expense on loans 1.370.570 1.282.845 Bank fees and commissions 477.064 369.264 Other 6.055 221.992 Total financial expense 2.371.378 2.702.769 2.229.219 2.533.716 142.159 169.053 including: related parties 2014/2015 227.046 22.925 third parties The following table provides an analysis of other operating costs. 903.616 Financial expense and interest expense on discounting 3.391.942 6.15 Other operating costs 1.487.507 Further details of the breakdown of financial expense compared with prior year figures are set out in the directors’ report to which reference is made (see Mecaer Aviation Group S.p.A.). The following table provides an analysis of the net exchange rate gains and losses shown above: 2014/2015 2013/2014 Exchange rate gains 3.747.666 1.796.789 Exchange rate losses (2.558.231) (1.261.653) Total net exchange rate gains 1.189.435 535.136 The caption includes unrealised exchange rate gains and losses of €695,316 thousand and €340,994 thousand, respectively. 6.18 Income taxes 6.16 Other operating costs - related parties This caption was nil. This caption includes income taxes and similar amounts accrued for the tax period of these financial statements, along with amounts arising from the adjustment of deferred tax assets and liabilities, which are detailed in the notes to the related statement of financial position captions (see 5.4 Deferred tax assets and 5.19 Deferred tax liabilities). 6.17 Financial income and expense The following table provides a breakdown of financial income and expense, with indication of amounts relating to transactions with related parties. For additional information on related parties, reference should be made to the specific paragraph 7.2 Related party transactions (see). 212 MAG | Annual Report 2015 The following table provides an analysis of total tax expense . 2014/2015 2013/2014 Current tax expense 3.929.903 3.533.980 Income taxes relative to prior years (40.610) 51.268 Deferred tax income (181.206) (433.901) Deferred tax expense (284.511) (117.940) Total taxes of the year 3.423.576 3.033.407 With respect to current taxes, starting from the year ended 2011/2012, MAG has applied the specific and complex tax rules provided for by domestic regulations for IFRS adopters. Considering that the transition to IFRS for separate financial statements occurred after 2007/2008, which is when the “substantial neutrality” scheme (provided for by Legislative decree no. 38/2005) was replaced by the “derivazione rafforzata” scheme (introduced by Law no. 244/2007), MAG is required to apply a complex system requiring the adoption of interim rules to “prior year” transactions, identified as such on a qualification, classification and accruals basis. In addition to Presidential decree no. 917/86, the reference legislative framework includes Ministerial decree no. 49/2009 (the “IFRS regulation”), while the main interpretation sources are tax authorities’ circulars no. 33/E/2009, which provided clarifications about possibly bringing carrying amounts into line with tax bases, and no. 7/E/2011, which clarified how to calculate the taxable base of IFRS adopters. Research and development costs, which are regularly expensed when incurred and give rise to the caption “Increase in internal work capitalised”, were considered a decrease in the year when incurred and a related increase in the year when the relevant amortisation/depreciation was recognised in profit or loss up until 2010/2011. That treatment was based on a systematic interpretation of articles 108.1 and 109 of Presidential decree no. 917/86 and was supported by an authoritative professional opinion and best practices (Assonime circular no. 69 of 23 December 2005). Since it was not an off-the-books deduction, which had been temporarily allowed for development costs by the previous wording of article 109.4.b of Presidential decree no. 917/86, it was not affected by the subsequent changes made to article 109 by Law no. 244/2007, which eliminated the possibility of off-the-books deductions. account the reversal of differences generated in previous tax years. As from the tax year 2011/2012, due to the application of the different and specific tax scheme applicable to IFRS adopters, capitalised research and development costs incurred during the year have become non-deductible, as no departures from the “derivazione rafforzata” scheme are allowed in this case. The interim rules set out in tax authorities’ circular no. 7/E of 28 February 2011 apply to development projects for new products that, based on the criteria established in article 15 of Legislative decree no. 158/2008 and clarified by tax authorities’ circular no. 33/E of 10 July 2009, qualify as “prior year transactions”. This scheme is substantially in line with the ruling tax regime in accordance with the allocation principle. Royalties recognised in profit or loss in respect of development projects that benefit from Law no. 808/85 and are relevant to “National security” or are of “European interest”, whose capitalised costs are stated net of the related assistance, are added to the taxable base over the year to the extent of the offset cost which, at the transition date, makes up the taxable temporary difference. The following table provides a reconciliation of the theoretical and effective tax expense. The more significant items giving rise to non-deductible permanent differences for IRES purposes comprise car expenses (€282 thousand) and prior year income and expense (€342 thousand). The non-taxable permanent difference arises from one-off and analytical deductions of IRAP from the IRES taxable base under the changes introduced by Legislative decree no. 201/2011, converted into Law no. 214/2011, which the company did not apply to the previous tax year. The permanent differences for IRAP purposes are mainly related to: ◊ as non-deductible differences, items of remuneration covered by article 11.1 of Legislative decree no. 446/97 (€1,455 thousand) and temporary staff (€1,662 thousand); ◊ as non-taxable differences, various deductions (personnel expenses relative to trainees and disabled workers, research and development costs and tax wedge). Moreover, with reference to the changes made by the above-mentioned law to IRAP legislation set out in article 5 of Legislative decree no. 446/97, establishing its separation from IRES legislation, and changes made for the purposes of that tax, with effect from 2007/2008, the IRAP tax base was calculated on the basis of carrying amounts, taking into MAG | Annual Report 2015 213 IRES Profit before tax/irap taxable base U IRAP 8.711.731 Total 32.138.862 Income taxes Average current national tax rate (ires, irap) Theoretical tax expense Taxable temporary differences q T=Uxq A Unrealised exchange rate gains 4,2% 1.352.013 (713.939) 3.747.739 (37.781) (676.158) Amortisation of goodwill Deductible temporary differences 27,5% 2.395.726 B Other cash-deductible expenses (37.781) (37.781) 2.115.314 497.418 47.559 Accruals to provisions and other allowances 1.518.445 497.418 Other impairment losses Employee benefits and expenses Expenses relative to more than one year 142.843 Lease surplus prior to fta 65.473 Unrealised exchange rate losses Reversals of prior year temporary differences 55.166 Prior year items taxed in the year 858.550 Prior year depreciation and amortisation and royalties to be taxed 782.232 (506.139) Reversal of taxed provisions/allowances (757.394) (270.468) Prior year items deducted in the year (828.223) (235.671) Permanent differences D Non-deductible items Untaxed items Total temporary and permanent differences Taxable base Effective current tax expense Income taxes relative to prior years 7. Assets classified as held for sale and directly associated liabilities 340.994 C (82.146) (4.607.726) 1.001.017 3.760.331 (1.083.162) (8.368.058) F= Σ (A:D) 1.374.395 (4.654.229) G= U+F 10.086.127 27.484.635 T’ = G x q The company does not have assets classified as held for sale or directly associated liabilities at the reporting date. 2.773.685 1.156.218 7.1 (40.610) Deferred tax income I’’ (181.206) Deferred tax expense I’’’ (284.511) T’’= T’+I+I’ 3.423.576 Total tax expense of the year The following table analyses net financial debt in accordance with the recommendations of Consob communication of 28 July 2006, using the format provided for in the CESR recommendation of 10 February 2005 “Recommendations for the consistent implementation of the European Commission regulation on prospectuses”. 3.929.903 I’ Net financial debt Current taxes paid during the year are summarised below. (in Euros) 2014/2015 Captions IRES (2013/2014 balance, 2014/2015 payments on account) 1.970.831 A IRAP (2013/2014 balance, 2014/2015 payments on account) 1.104.672 B Cash equivalents Line offsetting (700.000) C Securities held for trading Net payments of the year 2.375.503 D Cash and cash equivalents (a)+(b)+(c) 6.19 Earnings per share Basic earnings per share, calculated using the profit for the year ended 30 September 2015 of €5,164,079 and the 13,138,000 ordinary shares of the year, amount to €0.39.At 30 September 2014, basic earnings per share amounted to €0.32, calculated using the profit for the year of €4,203,937, consisting of the same number of ordinary shares. 214 MAG | Annual Report 2015 2014/2015 Cash on hand E Financial assets F Current bank loans and borrowings G Current portion of non-current financial debt H Other current loans and borrowings I Current financial debt (f)+(g)+(h) J Net current financial debt (i)-(e)-(d) K Non-current bank loans and borrowings L Bonds M Other non-current loans and borrowings N O 2013/2014 7.178 6.906 15.910.820 15.401.224 - - 15.917.998 15.408.130 - 2.967.000 6.425.839 15.525.738 10.378.606 9.396.930 935.090 1.347.148 17.739.535 23.302.817 1.821.537 7.894.687 26.333.931 23.807.195 - - 313.004 282.233 Non-current financial debt (k)+(l)+(m) 26.646.935 24.089.428 Net financial debt (j)+(n) 28.468.472 31.984.115 MAG | Annual Report 2015 215 7.2 Related party transactions In accordance with IAS 24, the following information is provided on transactions and balances with other related parties. The details provided relate to directors and statutory auditors. There are no other positions that fall under the definition of key management personnel per the relevant accounting standard. Non-monetary benefits have not been included in the analysis as they are immaterial. The following data refer to 1 October 2014 – 30 September 2015 (in Euros). Name Position Fixed fees Variables fees Other fees Total Alberto Ribolla Chairman 108.333 - 8.500 116.833 Valter Pasqua Deputy chairman 145.850 - 8.500 154.350 Corrado Monti Deputy chairman 104.167 - 8.500 112.667 Claudio Brun Managing director 30.000 - 8.500 38.500 Massimiliano Boschini Director 5.397 - 4.579 9.976 Emanuele Vignoli Director 4.301 - 6.055 10.356 Ruggero Manciati Director 10.000 - 8.500 18.500 Enrico Ricotta Director 10.000 - 8.000 18.000 Rocco Di Leo Chairman of the board of stat. Auditors 48.245 - 5.500 53.745 Luisa Marzoli Standing stat. Auditor 22.772 - 2.500 25.272 Guido Riccardi Standing stat. Auditor 30.294 - 2.500 32.794 Related parties include: ◊ S.B.I. S.p.A., which owns the industrial properties in which MAG has its operating offices. Since 11 June 2008, it has held 60.37% of MAG; ◊ The Credito Valtellinese Group, whose subsidiaries Credito Artigiano and Mediocredito Centrale carry out transactions with MAG and share one director with MAG. The following table summarises figures (in Euros) relating to related party transactions and balances matched with the respective consolidated financial statements captions. All transactions with related parties are contractually governed on an arm’s length basis.(in Euros) SBI Credito Valtellinese Current loans and receivables - related parties 24.664 - Other non-current assets 205.993 - Cash and cash equivalents - related parties 1.595.809 Non-current loans and borrowings - related parties 2.836.291 Current loans and borrowings - related parties 663.709 Current financial liabilities - related parties 258.169 - Other revenue and income 20.000 - Use of related party assets 1.541.201 - Financial income - related parties - 22 Financial expense - related parties - 142.159 7.3 Directors’, statutory auditors’ and independent auditors’ fees The Directors’ fees total €457 thousand.The Statutory Auditors’ fees for the year total €101 thousand.The Independent auditors’ fees total €90 thousand. On behalf of the board of directors 7.4 Claudio Brun - Managing Director (signed on the original) Events after the reporting date There are no other significant events to report. 216 MAG | Annual Report 2015 MAG | Annual Report 2015 217